IBM Computer Hardware Version 830 User Manual

ꢀꢁꢂ  
IBM Systems  
ServeRAID Manager  
Installation and User's Guide  
Version 8.30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ꢀꢁꢂ  
IBM Systems  
ServeRAID Manager  
Installation and User's Guide  
Version 8.30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Note  
Before using this information and the product it supports, read the information in Appendix D,  
"Notices."  
Fourth Edition (June 2006)  
This edition applies to version 8.30 of IBM Director and to all subsequent releases and modifications until otherwise  
indicated in new editions.  
© Copyright International Business Machines Corporation 1999, 2006. All rights reserved.  
US Government Users Restricted Rights – Use, duplication or disclosure restricted by GSA ADP Schedule Contract  
with IBM Corp.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
© Copyright IBM Corp. 1999, 2006  
iii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
iv ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
v
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
vi ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Figures  
© Copyright IBM Corp. 1999, 2006  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
vii  
 
viii ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tables  
© Copyright IBM Corp. 1999, 2006  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ix  
 
x
ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
About this book  
This book provides instructions for using IBM® Director 4.20 for  
systems-management tasks. IBM Director consists of the following tools to meet  
your systems-management needs:  
v IBM Director Console is the graphical user interface (GUI) for IBM Director  
Server. Using IBM Director Console, you can conduct comprehensive systems  
management using either a drop-and-drag action or a single click.  
v IBM Director command-line interface (dircli) is the command-line interface for  
IBM Director Server. You can use a command-line prompt to access, control, and  
gather information from IBM Director Server.  
This documentation also provides planning and implementation information for  
event management.  
Conventions and terminology  
These notices are designed to highlight key information:  
Note: These notices provide important tips, guidance, or advice.  
Important: These notices provide information or advice that might help you avoid  
inconvenient or difficult situations.  
Attention: These notices indicate possible damage to programs, devices, or data.  
An attention notice appears before the instruction or situation in which damage  
can occur.  
Related information  
Besides this documentation, there is additional information related to IBM Director.  
IBM Director resources on the World Wide Web  
The following Web pages provide resources for understanding, using, and  
troubleshooting IBM Director and other system-management tools.  
IBM Director information center  
Updated periodically, the IBM Director information center contains the  
most recent documentation available on a wide range of topics.  
IBM Director Web site on ibm.com®  
The IBM Director Web site on ibm.com has links to downloads and  
documentation for all currently supported versions of IBM Director.  
Information on this site includes:  
v Downloads and documentation for the following IBM Director releases:  
– IBM Director 5.10 Update 3 (5.10.3)  
© Copyright IBM Corp. 1999, 2006  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
xi  
 
– IBM Director 5.10 Update 2 (5.10.2)  
– IBM Director 5.10 Update 1 (5.10.1)  
– IBM Director 5.10  
– IBM Director 4.22  
– IBM Director 4.22 Upward Integration Modules (UIMs)  
– IBM Director 4.21  
– IBM Director 4.20  
v IBM Director Hardware and Software Support Guide document, which lists  
supported IBM systems and all supported operating systems. It is  
updated every 6 to 8 weeks.  
v Printable documentation for IBM Director available in Portable  
Document Format (PDF) in several languages  
IBM Director Software Developers Kit information center  
The IBM Director Software Developers Kit (SDK) information center  
provides information about the IBM Director SDK – a set of tools and  
documentation to help extend the capabilities of IBM Director by using the  
APIs and CLIs, creating tasks, and launching tools from the IBM Director  
user interface.  
IBM Systems Software information center  
This Web page provides information about IBM Virtualization Engine,  
IBM Director, External Application Launch Wizard, Virtual System  
Manager, and other topics.  
IBM ServerProven® page  
This Web page provides information about IBM System x, BladeCenter®,  
and IntelliStation® hardware compatibility with IBM Director.  
IBM Servers  
This Web page on ibm.com links to information, downloads, and IBM  
Director extensions such as Remote Deployment Manager, Capacity  
Manager, Systems Availability and Software Distribution (Premium  
Edition) for the following IBM products:  
v IBM BladeCenter  
v IBM System i™  
v IBM System p™  
v IBM System x  
v IBM System z™  
IBM Virtualization Engine systems services fixes  
This Web page provides information about the required fixes for the  
Virtualization Engine system services. The fixes include operating system  
fixes that are required for each system service as well as application-level  
fixes that are required for each system service to function correctly.  
IBM forums  
xii ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
This Web page on ibm.com links to several forums, available as Web pages  
or using rich site summary (RSS) feeds, in which users can discuss  
technology issues relating to IBM servers.  
Three of these forums are of particular interest to IBM Director users:  
System x IBM Director forum  
A forum for discussing any IBM Director topics. This Web page  
includes a link for obtaining the forum using an RSS feed.  
System x Server forum  
A forum for discussing System x server topics, including questions  
related to drivers, firmware, operating systems, clustering, and  
storage. This Web page includes a link for obtaining the forum  
using an RSS feed.  
IBM Director SDK forum  
A forum for discussing how to use the IBM Director SDK to extend  
the functionality of IBM Director to meet your specific needs. This  
Web page includes a link for obtaining the forum using an RSS  
feed.  
IBM Redbookspublications  
You can download the following documents from the IBM Redbooks Web page.  
You can also search this Web page for documents that focus on specific IBM  
hardware; such documents often contain systems-management material.  
Note: Be sure to note the date of publication and to determine the level of IBM  
Director software to which the Redbooks publication refers.  
v IBM Director Security (REDP-0417)  
v Managing IBM TotalStorage® NAS with IBM Director (SG24-6830)  
(REDP-3827)  
Remote Supervisor Adapter  
Remote Supervisor Adapter overview  
This Web page includes links to the Remote Supervisor Adapter User’s Guide  
and the Remote Supervisor Adapter Installation Guide.  
About this book xiii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Remote Supervisor Adapter II overview  
This Web page includes information about the Remote Supervisor Adapter  
II.  
Other documents  
For planning purposes, the following documents might be of interest:  
How to send your comments  
Your feedback is important in helping to provide the most accurate and highest  
quality information. If you have any comments about this book or any other IBM  
Director publication, use the form for reader’s comments is provided at the back of  
this publication. If the form has been removed, you may address your comments  
to:  
International Business Machines Corporation  
Design & Information Development  
Department CGFA  
PO Box 12195  
Research Triangle Park, NC 27709-9990  
U.S.A.  
xiv ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 1. Getting started  
Introducing IBM Director  
This topic provides an overview of IBM Director.  
IBM Director is an integrated suite of tools that provide you with comprehensive  
system-management capabilities to maximize system availability and lower IT  
costs. Its open, industry-standard design supports the management of a variety of  
hardware and operating systems, including most Intel® microprocessor-based  
systems and certain IBM System i, System p, System x, and System z servers.  
IBM Director automates many of the processes that are required to manage  
systems proactively, including capacity planning, asset tracking, preventive  
maintenance, diagnostic monitoring, troubleshooting, and more. It has a graphical  
user interface that provides easy access to both local and remote systems.  
IBM Director can be used in environments with multiple operating systems and  
integrated with robust workgroup and enterprise management software from IBM  
(such as Tivoli® software), Computer Associates, Hewlett-Packard, Microsoft®,  
NetIQ, and BMC Software.  
IBM Director environment  
IBM Director is designed to manage a complex environment that contains  
numerous servers, desktop computers, workstations, mobile computers (notebook  
computers), and assorted devices. IBM Director can manage up to 5000 Level-2  
systems.  
An IBM Director environment contains the following groups of hardware:  
v One or more servers on which IBM Director Server is installed. Such servers are  
called management servers.  
v Servers, workstations, desktop computers, and mobile computers that are  
managed by IBM Director. Such systems are called managed systems.  
v Network devices, printers, or computers that have Simple Network Management  
Protocol (SNMP) agents installed or embedded. Such devices are called SNMP  
devices.  
v Additional managed objects such as platforms and chassis. Collectively, all  
managed systems, devices, and objects are referred to as managed objects.  
Figure 1 on page 2 shows the hardware in an IBM Director environment.  
© Copyright IBM Corp. 1999, 2006  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1
 
Figure 1. Hardware in an IBM Director environment  
Using IBM Director Console  
You can use IBM Director Console to group managed objects, view associations,  
start tasks, and set IBM Director options and preferences.  
The IBM Director Console interface  
This topic describes the main components of the IBM Director Console interface.  
Before you begin using IBM Director Console, review the layout of its interface.  
Figure 2. IBM Director Console  
Along the top of the IBM Director Console interface is both a menu and a toolbar.  
2
ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Below the menu and toolbar, one, two, or three panes will be visible. From left to  
right, these are:  
v Groups  
v Group contents (pane title indicates selected group)  
v Tasks  
Below the panes is the marquee area and hardware-status alert display. The  
ticker-tape messages scroll across the marquee area. The hardware-status alert  
display is located in the bottom-right corner of the interface.  
At the bottom of the IBM Director Console interface is a status bar indicating the  
ready or busy status of IBM Director, the host and login information for IBM  
Director Server, and the number of managed objects in the Group Contents pane.  
IBM Director Console is usually accessed on the management server. On  
Windows® management servers, an additional, and separate, Server Status icon  
displays the ready or busy status of IBM Director Server in the Windows system  
tray.  
Note: Icons in the Windows tray, including the IBM Director Server Status icon,  
may disappear when a user selects the Windows High Contrast display. To  
enable display of the Server Status icon after selecting the high contrast  
display, select All Programs Startup Server Status from the Start menu.  
IBM Director Console toolbar  
This topic describes each of the icons on the IBM Director Console.  
Along the top of the IBM Director Console interface is a toolbar containing nine  
icons.  
Figure 3. IBM Director Console toolbar  
From left to right, the icons are briefly described below:  
Discover  
Clicking the button for this icon starts discovery of all systems and  
devices. Clicking the menu arrow for this icon allows you to select a type  
of system or device to discover.  
Message Browser  
Clicking the button for this icon opens the Message Browser window.  
User Administration  
Clicking the button for this icon opens the User Administration window.  
Event Action Plans  
Clicking the button for this icon opens the Event Action Plan Builder  
window. Clicking the menu arrow for this icon allows you to select the  
Event Action Plan Wizard, event logging options, or help for event action  
plans.  
Scheduler  
Clicking the button for this icon opens the Scheduler window. Clicking the  
menu arrow for this icon allows you to open help for scheduler.  
Chapter 1. Getting started  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Inventory  
Clicking the button for this icon opens the Inventory Query Browser  
window. Clicking the menu arrow for this icon allows you to build a  
custom query, edit the software dictionary, collect inventory, create custom  
collections, create or view inventory monitors, or open help for inventory.  
Resource Monitors  
Clicking the button for this icon opens the Resource Monitors window.  
Clicking the menu arrow for this icon allows you to import a plan file,  
open the All Available Recordings or All Available Thresholds window, or  
open help for resource monitors.  
Software Distribution  
Clicking the button for this icon opens the Software Distribution Manager  
window. Clicking the menu arrow for this icon allows you to manage file  
distribution servers, view package history, create a package category, open  
a software distribution package, or open help for software distribution.  
Remote Control  
Clicking the button for this icon opens the Remote Control window.  
Clicking the menu arrow for this icon allows you to open help for remote  
control.  
Panes in IBM Director Console  
The IBM Director Console interface includes three panes: Groups, Group Contents,  
and Tasks.  
You can resize the panes by dragging the borders between them. You can hide  
either the Groups or Tasks pane by clicking on the border between that pane and  
the Group Contents pane.  
Note: The Group Contents pane may not be hidden.  
Groups  
The Groups pane lists all the groups available, including the default  
groups and any groups you have defined.  
v Clicking a group selects that group for certain tasks performed from the  
toolbar or the menu. It also selects that group in the Group Contents  
pane.  
v Right-clicking some groups also displays a context menu allowing tasks  
to be performed on the group.  
Group Contents  
The Group Contents pane lists the managed objects included in the group  
selected in the Groups pane. The title of the Group Contents pane indicates  
which group is selected.  
v Clicking the title opens a menu from which you can select a group to  
display.  
v Clicking a listed object selects that object for certain tasks performed  
from the toolbar or the menu.  
v Right-clicking an object selects that object and displays a context menu  
allowing tasks to be performed on the object.  
The icon for each managed object indicates both the type of managed  
object and its online status: icons for online objects appear in color, while  
icons for offline objects appear in gray.  
4
ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
A padlock icon beside a managed object indicates that the object is secured  
and inventory information about the object cannot be collected. To request  
access to the object, right-click the managed object and click Request  
Access. By providing a valid user name that has local administrative rights  
to that managed object and password, you can access the system.  
Notes:  
1. (BladeCenter chassis and physical platforms only) The padlock  
icon is displayed if a valid login profile does not exist for the  
service processor. You can access the system using the Request  
Access action as above.  
2. (ISMP systems only) You cannot log in to an ISMP directly, as it  
lacks a userid and password. Instead, connect out-of-band to an  
ISMP installed on an ASM interconnect network through a  
Remote Supervisor Adapter or Remote Supervisor Adapter II  
serving as the ASM gateway.  
3. (ASM processor systems only) Use the Management Processor  
Assistant to configure an out-of-band path to the ASM  
processor system, then change the userid and password to  
request access the physical platform using IBM Director  
Console.  
Tasks The Tasks pane lists tasks which can be performed in IBM Director.  
Note: Although the list of tasks in the Task pane is static, not all tasks are  
available for all groups or managed objects.  
Right-clicking blank space in any pane displays a context menu from which you  
can change the pane’s appearance or sorting, or perform tasks specific to that pane.  
For example, in the Group Contents pane you can create new managed objects  
manually, find and view objects, or perform actions on the selected group.  
Working with tables  
This topic describes general procedures for viewing tabular information in IBM  
Director Console.  
In IBM Director Console, information is often displayed in tables. You can  
customize the display of data in many of these tables in several ways.  
Note: Not all of these actions may be available for all tabular views. These actions  
must be performed with a mouse or other pointing device, and are not  
available through the keyboard.  
Sort table data on a column  
Click a column header to sort the data in the table by the values in that  
column. Click the header again to change the sort order.  
v An upward-pointing triangle symbol indicates the column is sorted in  
ascending order  
v A downward-pointing triangle symbol indicates the column is sorted in  
descending order  
v Some columns may have additional sort options that are displayed as  
parenthetical text in the column header  
Resize table columns  
Drag the border of a table column heading to resize it.  
Chapter 1. Getting started  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Rearrange table columns  
Drag a table column heading left or right to a new column location to  
rearrange table columns.  
In addition, the details view of the Group contents pane in the main IBM Director  
Console window may be customized by selecting what columns are displayed.  
Right-click a column heading and select Customize columns. The Console  
Preferences window opens to the Details View Preferences page. Select the  
columns you wish to view, then click OK.  
Starting tasks  
This topic describes how to start tasks in IBM Director.  
You can start most tasks in IBM Director in four ways:  
v Dragging a task from the tasks pane onto a managed object (or a managed  
group, in some cases)  
v Dragging a managed object (or a managed group, in some cases) onto a task in  
the tasks pane  
v Right-clicking a managed object (or managed group, in some cases)  
v Selecting the managed object or group, then selecting a task from the menu bar  
Throughout this documentation, only dragging a task onto a managed object or  
group is explained as the method of starting tasks, although you can use any of  
the methods.  
Some IBM Director functions, such as the Event Action Plan Builder and Scheduler,  
may be started either from the menu bar or from the toolbar.  
Note: When IBM Director Console is processing a task, the hourglass is displayed  
for that window and you cannot use the mouse to work with the window.  
Although it might be possible to work with the window using key strokes,  
do not do so.  
ServeRAID Manager  
Use the ServeRAIDManager task to configure, monitor, and maintain ServeRAID  
adapters or controllers that are installed locally or remotely on servers. You can  
view information that is related to controllers, arrays, logical drives, hot-spare  
drives, and hard disk drives. Also, you can view configuration settings and events  
(which are called notifications in the ServeRAID Manager task) and locate defunct  
hard disk drives.  
Note: The ServeRAID Manager task for IBM Director is not the same program as  
the ServeRAID Manager (Standalone Edition) that is provided with the  
ServeRAID hardware option. It is recommended that you not install both  
versions on the same system.  
Icon  
Supported IBM  
Director objects  
Level-2 managed systems  
6
ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Supported operating  
systems  
For detailed operating-system support information, see the IBM  
Director information center on the Web at  
Availability  
Extension to the IBM Director product. You can download the  
extension from the IBM Support Web site at www.ibm.com/  
Required hardware or Designed specifically for use on System x, xSeries®, and  
hardware limitations  
Netfinity® servers. The following adapters or controllers must be  
installed locally or remotely on these servers:  
v ServeRAID adapters  
v Integrated SCSI controllers with RAID capabilities  
v Serial ATA controllers with integrated RAID  
v Ultra320 SCSI controllers with integrated RAID  
Required software  
Required protocols  
None  
None  
Required device  
drivers  
Applicable ServeRAID device drivers that support ServeRAID  
hardware.  
Mass Configuration  
support  
No  
Scheduler support  
No  
Files associated with  
this task  
None  
Events associated with The ServeRAID Manager task for IBM Director generates the  
this task  
following events:  
v CIM > System > ServeRAID  
v (SNMP events under iso) The iBMServeRAID events that are  
contained under the ibmSystemMIB event type.  
v Storage > ServeRAID Controller  
Note: The ServeRAID Manager (Standalone Edition) generates the  
events that are contained under the SNMP > Hardware > Storage  
> RAID event type.  
For detailed events information, see in the IBM Director  
information center on the Web at publib.boulder.ibm.com/  
Operating systems supported by ServeRAID Manager  
This topic provides information about the operating systems supported by the  
ServeRAID Manager task.  
Management-server support  
This task is supported by IBM Director Server when installed on servers running  
the following operating systems:  
v Linux® on System x  
v Windows  
Managed-object support  
The following tables list the operating systems that this task supports for managed  
objects. Managed objects can include IBM System x, System i, System p, and  
Chapter 1. Getting started  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
System z hardware. Managed systems are a subset of managed objects that use  
different levels of IBM Director support. This task can be used on Level-2 managed  
systems only. These systems must be System x, xSeries, and Netfinity servers.  
Table 1. Operating systems supported by System x servers and third-party Intel-based  
systems  
Operating system  
Level 2  
Editions of Windows for 32-bit systems:  
v Windows 2000, Advanced Server and Server Editions  
v Windows Server 2003 Standard Edition  
Yes  
v Windows Server 2003 Enterprise Edition  
v Windows 2000 Professional Edition  
v Windows 2000 Datacenter Edition  
v Windows XP Professional Edition  
v Windows Server 2003 Web Edition  
v Windows Server 2003 Datacenter Edition  
No  
Editions of Windows for 64-bit systems:  
v Windows Server 2003 Standard x64 Edition  
v Windows Server 2003 Enterprise x64 Edition  
Yes  
No  
v Windows XP Professional x64 Edition  
v Windows Server 2003 Web x64 Edition  
v Windows Server 2003 Datacenter x64 Edition  
v Windows Server 2003, Datacenter and Enterprise 64-bit Itanium® Editions  
Versions of Linux for 32-bit systems:  
v Red Hat Enterprise Linux AS, ES, and WS, version 3.0  
v Red Hat Enterprise Linux AS, ES, and WS, version 4.0  
v SUSE Linux Enterprise Server 8 for x86  
Yes  
v SUSE Linux Enterprise Server 9 for x86  
v VMware ESX Server, versions 2.1, 2.5, 2.5.1 and 2.5.2, Console  
v VMware ESX Server, versions 2.1, 2.5, 2.5.1 and 2.5.2, guest operating systems  
v VMware GSX Server, versions 3.1 and 3.2, Console  
No  
Yes  
v VMware GSX Server, versions 3.1 and 3.2, guest operating systems  
Versions of Linux for 64-bit systems:  
v Red Hat Enterprise Linux AS, ES, and WS, version 3.0, for AMD64 and  
EM64T  
v Red Hat Enterprise Linux AS, ES, and WS, version 4.0, for AMD64 and  
EM64T  
v SUSE Linux Enterprise Server 8 for AMD64  
v SUSE Linux Enterprise Server 9 for AMD64 and EM64T  
v Red Hat Enterprise Linux AS, version 3.0, for Intel Itanium  
v Red Hat Enterprise Linux AS, version 4.0, for Intel Itanium  
v SUSE Linux Enterprise Server 8 for Itanium Processor Family  
v SUSE Linux Enterprise Server 9 for Itanium Processor Family  
No  
Other operating systems supported by System x servers:  
Microsoft Virtual Server (guest operating system)  
NetWare, version 6.5  
No  
Yes  
8
ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Table 2. Operating systems supported by System i platforms and System p servers  
Operating system  
Level 2  
v AIX 5L, Version 5.2  
No  
v AIX 5L, Version 5.3  
v i5/OS®, Version 5 Release 3  
v i5/OS, Version 5 Release 4  
v Red Hat Enterprise Linux AS, version 3.0, for IBM POWER™  
Note: System p servers require Red Hat Enterprise Linux AS, version 3.3 or  
later, for IBM POWER.  
v Red Hat Enterprise Linux AS, version 4.0, for IBM POWER  
v SUSE Linux Enterprise Server 8 for IBM POWER  
v SUSE Linux Enterprise Server 9 for IBM POWER  
Table 3. Operating systems supported by System z servers  
Operating system  
Level 2  
v Red Hat Enterprise Linux AS, version 4.0, for IBM System z  
v SUSE Linux Enterprise Server 9 for IBM System z  
No  
Chapter 1. Getting started  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
10 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 2. Installing ServeRAID Manager  
This topic describes the general procedure for installing the ServeRAID Manager  
extension for IBM Director 5.10.  
ServeRAID Manager may be installed on both Windows and Linux platforms.  
Installing ServeRAID Manager is performed in several steps, each of which is  
described in a topic in this section.  
1. Download the ServeRAID Manager extension.  
a. In a Web browser, navigate to the following Web site: www.ibm.com/pc/  
b. Navigate to the ServeRAID Manager extension for your operating system,  
and download the extension files to a temporary directory.  
2. Install ServeRAID Manager on the management server.  
Option  
Description  
Windows server  
Linux server  
3. Optional: Install ServeRAID Manager user-interface components for IBM  
Director Console on remote management consoles.  
Option  
Description  
Windows console  
Linux console  
Note: ServeRAID Manager user-interface components for IBM Director Console  
are automatically installed on the management server when the  
ServeRAID Manager server components are installed. It is not necessary  
or possible to separately install ServeRAID Manager console components  
on a management server.  
4. Install ServeRAID Manager components for IBM Director Agent on managed  
systems.  
Option  
Description  
Windows systems  
Linux systems  
NetWare systems  
Note: ServeRAID Manager agent components are automatically installed on the  
management server when the ServeRAID Manager server components  
© Copyright IBM Corp. 1999, 2006  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11  
 
are installed. It is not necessary or possible to separately install  
ServeRAID Manager agent components on a management server.  
Installing the ServeRAID Manager extension on a Windows server  
This topic describes the procedure for installing the ServeRAID Manager extension  
for IBM Director on a Windows management server.  
Complete the following steps to install ServeRAID Manager on a Windows  
management server:  
1. Copy the downloaded installation files to a temporary directory on the  
machine on which you will be performing the installation.  
2. Close all applications, including any command-prompt windows.  
3. Click Start Run.  
4. In the Run dialog, type the following command in the Open field and press  
Enter:  
download\raid\server\windows\serveraid_5.10_server_windows.exe  
download represents the location to which the ServeRAID Manager download  
package was unzipped.  
5. In the first panel of the ServeRAID Manager Server InstallShield Wizard, click  
Next.  
6. In the second panel of the ServeRAID Manager Server InstallShield Wizard,  
complete the following steps:  
a. Ensure that the hard disk drive icon  
appears to the left of ServeRAID  
Manager Server in the list box. If a different icon appears, click the icon  
and select This feature, and all subfeatures, will be installed on local  
hard drive from the menu.  
b. Ensure that the hard disk drive icon  
appears to the left of each of the  
other features you wish to install. You can install the ServeRAID Manager  
Agent, ServeRAID Manager Console, and IBM Management Station along  
with ServeRAID Manager Server.  
c. Click Next.  
7. (Only if Management Station is being installed) In the next panel of the  
ServeRAID Manager Server InstallShield Wizard, complete the following  
steps:  
a. Type the user name and password (enter twice for confirmation) for the  
user for the ServeRAID Management Station service.  
b. Click Next.  
8. In the next panel of the ServeRAID Manager Server InstallShield Wizard, click  
Install. A new panel displays the installation progress.  
9. When installation has completed, click Finish.  
10. In the dialog that appears, respond to the prompt to reboot the management  
server. Click Yes to reboot immediately, or click No if you will reboot the  
management server yourself.  
The management server must be rebooted before the ServeRAID Manager  
extension will operate. After installing the server components of the ServeRAID  
Manager extension, you need to install the console components.  
12 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Installing the ServeRAID Manager extension on a Linux server  
This topic describes the procedure for installing ServeRAID Manager on a Linux  
management server.  
Complete the following steps to install ServeRAID Manager on a Linux  
management server:  
1. Copy the downloaded installation files to a temporary directory on the machine  
on which you will be performing the installation. The downloaded installation  
files are contained in a tar file. Use the tar -x command to extract the contents  
to a temporary directory.  
2. Stop IBM Director. From a command prompt, type the following command and  
press Enter:  
/opt/ibm/director/bin/twgstop  
3. Change to the directory in which the installation package is located. Type the  
following command and press Enter:  
cd /download/raid/server/linux/  
download represents the location into which the ServeRAID Manager download  
package was extracted.  
4. Optional: To install the management station service on the Linux management  
server, perform the following substeps.  
The management station is used to administer IBM System StorageDS300  
and IBM System Storage DS400 devices. This step is only necessary if both of  
the following conditions are true:  
v You wish to manage IBM System Storage DS300 and IBM System Storage  
DS400 devices using IBM Director  
v You do not have the standalone version of ServeRAID Manager installed  
If either of these conditions is not met, there is no need to install the  
management station service.  
Note: Although it is possible to install the management station service on a  
system other than that on which IBM Director Server is installed, this is  
not a recommended configuration, and is not documented here. To use  
the standalone version of ServeRAID Manager, or for instructions for  
installing the management station service on a different system than the  
management server on which IBM Director Server is installed, refer to  
the documentation and downloads available on the ServeRAID Web site  
a. List the directory contents. There should be several files named  
serveraid-mgmt-version-build.os.i586.rpm, with version, build, and os  
indicating the version number, build number, and operating system for the  
package. Note the version and build numbers for the following step.  
b. Type one of the following commands (substituting the actual values for  
version and build) and press Enter:  
Installation scenario  
Command  
Performing a new  
rpm -ivh serveraid-mgmt-version-build.rhel33.i586.rpm  
installation on Red Hat  
Enterprise Linux AS, ES, and  
WS, version 3.0 (Update 3  
required)  
Chapter 2. ServeRAID Manager 13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Installation scenario  
Command  
Upgrading from a previous  
version on Red Hat  
rpm -Uvh --relocate /opt/ibm/director=/opt/IBM/  
director serveraid-mgmt-version-build.rhel33.i586.rpm  
Enterprise Linux AS, ES, and  
WS, version 3.0 (Update 3  
required)  
Performing a new  
rpm -ivh serveraid-mgmt-version-build.rhel4.i586.rpm  
installation on Red Hat  
Enterprise Linux AS, ES, and  
WS, version 4.0  
Upgrading from a previous  
version on Red Hat  
rpm -Uvh --relocate /opt/ibm/director=/opt/IBM/  
director serveraid-mgmt-version-build.rhel4.i586.rpm  
Enterprise Linux AS, ES, and  
WS, version 4.0  
Performing a new  
rpm -ivh serveraid-mgmt-version-build.sles8.i586.rpm  
installation on SUSE Linux  
Enterprise Server 8  
Upgrading from a previous  
version on SUSE Linux  
Enterprise Server 8  
rpm -Uvh --relocate /opt/ibm/director=/opt/IBM/  
director serveraid-mgmt-version-build.sles8.i586.rpm  
Performing a new  
rpm -ivh serveraid-mgmt-version-build.sles9.i586.rpm  
installation on SUSE Linux  
Enterprise Server 9  
Upgrading from a previous  
version on SUSE Linux  
Enterprise Server 9  
rpm -Uvh --relocate /opt/ibm/director=/opt/IBM/  
director serveraid-mgmt-version-build.sles9.i586.rpm  
The installation progress is displayed.  
5. Type one of the following commands and press Enter:  
Installation scenario  
Command  
Performing a new  
installation  
rpm -ivh RAIDLxServer-5.10-1.i386.rpm  
Upgrading from a previous  
version  
rpm -Uvh --relocate /opt/ibm/director=/opt/IBM/  
director RAIDLxServer-5.10-1.i386.rpm  
The installation progress is displayed.  
6. Restart IBM Director Server. From a command prompt, type the following  
command and press Enter:  
/opt/ibm/director/bin/twgstart  
The IBM Director ServeRAID Manager Server installation process installs the  
server, console, and agent components of ServeRAID Manager on the management  
server.  
The management server must be rebooted before the ServeRAID Manager  
extension will operate. After installing the server components of the ServeRAID  
Manager extension, you need to install the console components.  
Installing the ServeRAID Manager extension on a Windows console  
This topic describes the procedure for installing the ServeRAID Manager extension  
on a Windows management console.  
14 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
The ServeRAID Manager extension should be installed on the management server  
before installing the console components of ServeRAID Manager.  
Complete the following steps to install the ServeRAID Manager extension on a  
Windows management console:  
1. Copy the downloaded installation files to a temporary directory on the machine  
on which you will be performing the installation.  
2. Close IBM Director Console.  
3. Click Start Run.  
4. In the Run dialog, type the following command in the Open field and press  
Enter:  
download\raid\console\windows\serveraid_5.10_console_windows.exe  
download represents the location into which the ServeRAID Manager download  
package was unzipped.  
5. In the first panel of the ServeRAID Manager Console InstallShield Wizard, click  
Next.  
6. In the second panel of the ServeRAID Manager Console InstallShield Wizard,  
complete the following steps:  
a. Ensure that the hard disk drive icon  
appears to the left of ServeRAID  
Manager Console in the list box. If a different icon appears, click the icon  
and select This feature, and all subfeatures, will be installed on local hard  
drive from the menu.  
b. Click Next.  
7. In the third panel of the ServeRAID Manager Console InstallShield Wizard,  
click Install. A new panel displays the installation progress.  
8. When installation has completed, click Finish.  
9. Restart IBM Director Console.  
After installing the console components of the extension, you need to install the  
ServeRAID Manager Agent components on your managed systems.  
Installing the ServeRAID Manager extension on a Linux console  
This topic describes the procedure for installing ServeRAID Manager on a Linux  
management console.  
The ServeRAID Manager extension should be installed on the management server  
before installing the console components of ServeRAID Manager.  
Note: ServeRAID Manager user-interface components for IBM Director Console are  
automatically installed on the management server when the ServeRAID  
Manager server components are installed. It is not necessary or possible to  
separately install ServeRAID Manager console components on a  
management server.  
Complete the following steps to install ServeRAID Manager on a Linux console:  
1. Copy the downloaded installation files to a temporary directory on the machine  
on which you will be performing the installation.  
2. Close IBM Director Console.  
3. Change to the directory in which the installation package is located. Type the  
following command and press Enter:  
Chapter 2. ServeRAID Manager 15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
cd /download/raid/console/linux/  
download represents the location to which the ServeRAID Manager download  
package was extracted.  
4. Type one of the following commands and press Enter:  
Installation scenario  
Command  
Performing a new  
installation  
rpm -ivh RAIDLxConsole-5.10-1.i386.rpm  
Upgrading from a previous  
version  
rpm -Uvh --relocate /opt/ibm/director=/opt/IBM/  
director RAIDLxConsole-5.10-1.i386.rpm  
The installation progress is displayed.  
5. Restart IBM Director Console.  
6. Remove the CD from the CD-ROM drive.  
After installing the console components of the extension, you need to install the  
ServeRAID Manager Agent components on your managed systems.  
Installing the ServeRAID Manager extension on a managed Windows  
system  
This topic describes the procedure for installing ServeRAID Manager on a  
Windows managed system.  
The following prerequisites apply to this installation:  
v ServeRAID Manager should be installed on the management server and  
management console before installing the agent components of ServeRAID  
Manager on managed systems.  
v IBM Director Agent should be installed on the managed system before installing  
ServeRAID Manager.  
Note: An alternative installation method is to use Update Assistant and Software  
Distribution. For more information, refer to the Creating software packages  
to distributesection of the IBM Director Systems Management Guide.  
Complete the following steps to install ServeRAID Manager on a Windows  
managed system:  
1. Copy the downloaded installation files to a temporary directory on the machine  
on which you will be performing the installation. The downloaded installation  
files are contained in a zip file. Use the unzip command to extract the contents  
to a temporary directory.  
2. Click Start Run.  
3. In the Run dialog, type the following command in the Open field and press  
Enter:  
download\raid\agent\windows\serveraid_5.10_agent_windows.exe  
download represents the location to which the ServeRAID Manager download  
package was extracted.  
4. In the first panel of the ServeRAID Manager Agent InstallShield Wizard, click  
Next.  
5. In the second panel of the ServeRAID Manager Agent InstallShield Wizard,  
complete the following steps:  
16 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
a. Ensure that the hard disk drive icon  
appears to the left of ServeRAID  
Manager Agent in the list box. If a different icon appears, click the icon and  
select This feature, and all subfeatures, will be installed on local hard  
drive from the menu.  
b. Click Next.  
6. In the third panel of the ServeRAID Manager Agent InstallShield Wizard, click  
Install. A new panel displays the installation progress.  
7. When installation has completed, click Finish.  
8. In the dialog that appears, respond to the prompt to reboot the managed  
system. Click Yes to reboot immediately, or click No if you will reboot the  
managed system yourself.  
You must reboot the managed system before the ServeRAID Manager Agent will  
operate.  
Installing the ServeRAID Manager extension on a managed Linux  
system  
This topic describes the procedure for installing ServeRAID Manager on a Linux  
managed system.  
The following prerequisites apply to this installation:  
v ServeRAID Manager should be installed on the management server and  
management console before installing the agent components of ServeRAID  
Manager on managed systems.  
v IBM Director Agent should be installed on the managed system before installing  
ServeRAID Manager.  
Note: An alternative installation method is to use Update Assistant and Software  
Distribution. For more information, refer to the Creating software packages  
to distributesection of the IBM Director Systems Management Guide.  
Complete the following steps to install ServeRAID Manager on a Linux managed  
system:  
1. Copy the downloaded installation files to a temporary directory on the machine  
on which you will be performing the installation. The downloaded installation  
files are contained in a tar file. Use the tar -x command to extract the contents  
to a temporary directory.  
2. Change to the directory in which the installation package is located. Type the  
following command and press Enter:  
cd /download/raid/agent/linux/  
download represents the location to which the ServeRAID Manager download  
package was extracted.  
3. Type one of the following commands and press Enter:  
Installation scenario  
Command  
Performing a new  
rpm -ivh RAIDLxAg-5.10-1.i386.rpm  
installation (32-bit agent)  
Performing a new  
rpm -ivh RAIDLxAg-5.10-1.x86_64.rpm  
installation (64-bit agent for  
Opteron or EM64T)  
Chapter 2. ServeRAID Manager 17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Installation scenario  
Command  
Upgrading from a previous  
version (32-bit agent)  
rpm -Uvh --relocate /opt/ibm/director=/opt/IBM/  
director RAIDLxAg-5.10-1.i386.rpm  
Upgrading from a previous  
version (64-bit agent for  
Opteron or EM64T)  
rpm -Uvh --relocate /opt/ibm/director=/opt/IBM/  
director RAIDLxAg-5.10-1.x86_64.rpm  
The installation progress is displayed.  
You must reboot the managed system before the ServeRAID Manager Agent will  
operate.  
Installing the ServeRAID Manager extension on a managed NetWare  
system  
This topic describes the procedure for installing the ServeRAID Manager extension  
on a NetWare managed system.  
v The ServeRAID Manager extension should be installed on the management  
server and management console before installing the agent components of the  
ServeRAID Manager extension on managed systems.  
v IBM Director Agent should be installed on the managed system before installing  
the ServeRAID Manager extension.  
Note: To install the ServeRAID Manager extension, you must log on to the  
NetWare server from a Windows workstation running the NetWare Client  
for Windows. The SYS volume must be mapped as a drive to the system  
running Windows. Also, you must have administrator or supervisor access  
on the NetWare server.  
Complete the following steps on the Windows workstation running NetWare Client  
for Windows to install the ServeRAID Manager extension on a NetWare managed  
system:  
1. Copy the downloaded installation files to a temporary directory on the  
Windows workstation on which you will be performing the installation.  
2. Click Start Run.  
3. In the Run dialog, type the following command in the Open field and press  
Enter:  
download\raid\agent\windows\serveraid_5.10_agent_netware.exe  
download represents the location to which the ServeRAID Manager extension  
download package was saved.  
4. If prompted for the language, select a language from the dropdown list and  
click OK.  
5. In the first panel of the IBM ServeRAID Manager Agent 5.10 Setup Wizard,  
click Next.  
6. In the second panel of the IBM ServeRAID Manager Agent 5.10 Setup Wizard,  
complete the following steps:  
a. Select the mapped NetWare drive on which to install ServeRAID Manager  
extension Agent.  
b. Click Next.  
7. In the third panel of the ServeRAID Manager extension Agent InstallShield  
Wizard, click Install.  
18 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Note: ServeRAID Manager Agent is the only component in the list of  
components to be installed, and should already be selected.  
A new panel displays the installation progress.  
8. When installation has completed, click Finish.  
Chapter 2. ServeRAID Manager 19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
20 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 3. Using ServeRAID Manager  
Introducing the ServeRAID Manager  
You might want to review the following information before using the ServeRAID  
Manager:  
v
v
v
v
v
You can use the ServeRAID Manager to configure, administer, and monitor  
controllers that are installed locally or remotely in your IBM xSeries servers.  
The first time you start the ServeRAID Manager, it will display only your local  
system. The local system is displayed in the Enterprise view treeand information  
about the system is displayed in the right pane, in the Physical and Logical device  
views.  
Whenever you start the ServeRAID Manager after the first time, it will display an  
unknown system icon  
for any remote systems that you have added. When the  
ServeRAID Manager connects with the remote systems, it will update the status in  
the tree.  
For additional information, see the IBM ServeRAID publications on the IBM  
ServeRAID Support CD.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
What’s new in the ServeRAID TM Manager  
This release of the ServeRAID Manager has the following new features:  
v Ability to manage FlashCopy backups of logical drive data in external storage  
enclosures  
About ServeRAID Manager  
ServeRAID software features  
You can use the ServeRAID software with the following controllers. Most advanced  
features are available only with ServeRAID controllers.  
ServeRAID features  
HostRAID  
controller  
ServeRAID-  
8i/8k/8k-l  
ServeRAID-  
7K  
ServeRAID- 7t ServeRAID-  
6i/6i+  
ServeRAID-  
6M  
ServeRAID- 5i  
ROM Update Wizard  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
ServeRAID Manager  
BIOS Configuration program  
© Copyright IBM Corp. 1999, 2006  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
21  
 
ServeRAID features  
HostRAID  
controller  
ServeRAID-  
8i/8k/8k-l  
ServeRAID-  
7K  
ServeRAID- 7t ServeRAID-  
6i/6i+  
ServeRAID-  
6M  
ServeRAID- 5i  
Comand-Line Tool  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
IPSSEND FlashCopy function No  
(Windows XP Professional,  
Windows 2000, Windows  
Server 2003, and Windows  
NT only)  
IPSMON (NetWare only)  
Copy Back  
No  
No  
No  
No  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
No  
No  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
No  
Clustering (Windows 2000  
and Windows NT only)  
Failover (Windows 2000 and  
Windows NT only)  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
Yes (Windows No  
2000 only)  
RAID level-1, RAID level-1E  
RAID level-0, RAID level-5  
RAID level-5E  
Yes (1 only)  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Yes (1 only)  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
No  
No  
Yes  
Yes (0 only)  
Yes  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
RAID level-5EE  
No  
RAID level-6  
No  
RAID level-x0  
Yes (10 only)  
Integrated RAID  
controller  
ServeRAID features  
ServeRAID-4  
ServeRAID-3  
ServeRAID-II  
ServeRAID ROM Update Wizard  
ServeRAID Manager  
No  
Yes  
No  
No  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
ServeRAID Mini-Configuration program  
IPSSEND  
IPSSEND FlashCopy function (Windows XP  
Professional, Windows 2000, Windows Server  
2003, and Windows NT only)  
IPSMON (NetWare only)  
Copy Back  
No  
No  
No  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Clustering (Windows 2000 and Windows NT  
only)  
Failover (Windows 2000 and Windows NT  
only)  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
RAID level-1, RAID level-1E  
RAID level-0, RAID level-5  
RAID level-5E  
Yes (1 only)  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
No  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
RAID level-5EE  
Yes ( except 4H)  
RAID level-6  
No  
Yes  
RAID level-x0  
IBM ServeRAID-3 hardware features: The following table lists the hardware  
features for the IBM ServeRAID-3 controllers:  
Feature  
ServeRAID-3HB  
ServeRAID-3H  
ServeRAID-3L  
Arrays (max.)  
8
8
8
Battery-backup cache Yes  
Optional  
32 MB  
45  
No  
4 MB  
15  
Cache memory  
32 MB  
Hard disk drives  
(max.)  
45  
Logical drives (max.)  
Microprocessor  
8
8
8
40 MHz  
40 MHz  
25 MHz  
22 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Feature  
ServeRAID-3HB  
3
ServeRAID-3H  
3
ServeRAID-3L  
1
SCSI channels  
SCSI transfer speed  
(max.)  
80 MB per sec.  
80 MB per sec.  
80 MB per sec.  
Supported RAID  
levels  
0, 1, 5, Enhanced-1  
(1E), and Enhanced-5 (1E), and Enhanced-5 (1E), and Enhanced-5  
0, 1, 5, Enhanced-1  
0, 1, 5, Enhanced-1  
(5E)  
(5E)  
(5E)  
System PCI data bus 64 bit  
64 bit  
32 bit  
IBM ServeRAID-4 hardware features: The following tables list the hardware  
features for the IBM ServeRAID-4 controllers:  
Feature  
ServeRAID-4H  
ServeRAID-4Mx  
ServeRAID-4Lx  
Arrays (max.)  
8
8
8
Battery-backup cache Yes  
Yes  
64 MB  
30  
No  
32 MB  
15  
Cache memory  
128 MB  
Hard disk drives  
(max.)  
60  
Logical drives (max.)  
Microprocessor  
8
8
8
266 MHz  
100 MHz  
100 MHz  
SCSI channels  
4
2
1
SCSI transfer speed  
(max.)  
160 MB per sec.  
160 MB per sec.  
160 MB per sec.  
Supported RAID  
levels  
0, 1, 5, Enhanced-1  
(1E), and Enhanced-5 (1E), and Enhanced-5 (1E), and Enhanced-5  
0, 1, 5, Enhanced-1  
0, 1, 5, Enhanced-1  
(5E), 00, 10, 1E0, 50  
(5E), 00, 10, 1E0, 50  
(5E), 00, 10, 1E0, 50  
System PCI data bus 64 bit at 33 MHz  
64 bit at 33 to 66  
MHz  
64 bit at 33 to 66  
MHz  
Feature  
ServeRAID-4M  
ServeRAID-4L  
Arrays (max.)  
8
8
Battery-backup cache  
Cache memory  
Yes  
No  
16 MB  
15  
64 MB  
Hard disk drives (max.)  
Logical drives (max.)  
Microprocessor  
30  
8
8
100 MHz  
100 MHz  
SCSI channels  
2
1
SCSI transfer speed (max.)  
Supported RAID levels  
160 MB per sec.  
160 MB per sec.  
0, 1, 5, Enhanced-1 (1E), and 0, 1, 5, Enhanced-1 (1E), and  
Enhanced-5 (5E), 00, 10, 1E0, Enhanced-5 (5E), 00, 10, 1E0,  
50  
50  
System PCI data bus  
64 bit at 33 MHz  
64 bit at 33 MHz  
IBM ServeRAID-5i hardware features: The following tables list the hardware  
features for the IBM ServeRAID-5i controller:  
Chapter 3. Using ServeRAID Manager 23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Feature  
ServeRAID-5i  
Arrays (max.)  
8
Battery-backup cache  
Cache memory  
Yes  
128 MB  
Hard disk drives (max.)  
Logical drives (max.)  
Microprocessor  
30  
8
100 MHz  
SCSI channels  
0
SCSI transfer speed (max.)  
Supported RAID levels  
System PCI data bus  
320 MB per sec.  
0, 1, 5, Enhanced-1 (1E), 00, 10, 1E0, 50  
64 bit at 66 MHz  
Using the ServeRAID Manager interface  
Before you begin using the ServeRAID Manager, take some time to review the  
layout of its user interface.  
v
v
v
v
v
v
You can work with the ServeRAID Manager interface by doing any of the  
following:  
v Select actions from the menubar.  
v Click an item on the toolbar.  
v Right-click an object in the Enterprise view, the Physical devices view, or Logical  
devices view.  
v Drag and drop objects in the Configuration wizard.  
v Double-click objects and events.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
v
Using ServeRAID Manager Assist, hints, and tips: Use ServeRAID Manager  
Assist to tour and familiarize yourself with objects in the ServeRAID Manager  
Enterprise view and the Physical and Logical device views. Click an object to view  
information about that object.  
Tip: If you right-click an object, you can select Hints and tips to view information  
about the object and the valid actions for that object.  
24 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Click  
(Back) and  
(Forward) to review pages already presented during  
your current ServeRAID Manager Assist session.  
If the ServeRAID Manager is installed on a server that is connected to a printer  
and its operating system supports printing in the ServeRAID Manager, the  
(Print) is displayed on the ServeRAID Manager Assist toolbar. Click this icon to  
print the current page.  
Note:  
1. The ServeRAID Manager might print some pages with overlapping text.  
2. You cannot print in bootable-CD mode.  
To search for terms in the ServeRAID Manager Assist pages, type one or more  
words in the entry field and click  
(Search). Search will list any page that  
contains all the words you typed (it is a Boolean AND search). To search for a  
specific phrase, surround the phrase with double quotes. For example,  
logical-drive migration.″  
Note: The search is not case sensitive.  
To exit the ServeRAID Manager Assist window, click  
the ServeRAID Manager.  
(Exit) and you return to  
More information  
v
v
v
Finding information in ServeRAID Manager:  
Tip: If you want to learn more about objects in the Enterprise view or the Physical  
and Logical devices views, right-click  
If you want to learn more about the ServeRAID Manager interface, use the  
tool tips that are displayed when you hover the mouse over a window  
element.  
Note: If tool tips are not displayed when you hover over a window, verify that  
tool tips are enabled. Click View Tool tips to enable or disable tool tips.  
If you want context-sensitive information about the current window (for example,  
Creating logical drivesin the Configuration wizard), click Help Information  
about this window or the Help push-button.  
Chapter 3. Using ServeRAID Manager 25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
The following items on the Help menu provide additional information resources:  
v
v
v
v
Search lets you search for terms in the ServeRAID Assist pages.  
ServeRAID publications lists IBM publications and where to find them.  
IBM online support lists IBM Web sites and available online support.  
What’s new in the ServeRAID Manager lists the new features delivered in this  
version of the ServeRAID Manager program.  
v About ServeRAID Manager reports the ServeRAID Manager version number,  
copyright, and legal information.  
More information  
v
v
v
Using hints and tips: Use this action to view information about objects in the  
1. In the Enterprise view, Physical devices view, or Logical devices view, click an  
object.  
2. Right-click Hints and tips. The ServeRAID Manager Assist window opens.  
To exit the ServeRAID Manager Assist window, click  
ServeRAID Manager.  
to return to the  
More information  
v
Searching for information in ServeRAID Manager Assist: Use this action to search the  
ServeRAID Manager Assist pages.  
1. Click Help Search. The Search window opens.  
2. Type one or more words in the entry field of the topic that you want to find.  
Search looks for any page that contains all the words you typed (that is, it is a  
Boolean AND search). To search for a specific phrase, surround the phrase with  
double quotes. For example, logical-drive migration.″  
Note: The search is not case sensitive.  
3. Click OK. The Search window opens listing all the pages that contain all the  
words you typed.  
4. Click a topic to view its information.  
5. Click  
(Back) on the toolbar to view the Search listing again.  
ServeRAID Manager accessibility features: Successful access to information and  
use of information technology by people who have disabilities is known as  
accessibility.″  
The ServeRAID Manager provides keyboard accessibility for its supported  
operating systems.  
On Microsoft Windows, the ServeRAID Manager works with the types of assistive  
technologies used by people who have disabilities and also supports high-contrast  
screen colors.  
26 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
If you require accessibility, use the ServeRAID Manager on a Microsoft Windows  
operating system. If you need to work with systems that are installed with other  
operating systems, connect to these systems through the network using a Microsoft  
Windows system.  
More information  
v
v
v
Setting your preferences in the ServeRAID Manager: You can change some  
settings in the ServeRAID Manager to match your preferences.  
You can turn the repeating alarm on and off, change the amount of time between  
each repeating alarm, and change the duration of the alarm.  
You can choose to hide the toolbar, the status bar, and the tool tips. To do so, click  
View in the menubar and click the item you want to turn off.  
Also, you can refresh the ServeRAID Manager, including the Enterprise view. Click  
View Refresh.  
Additionally, you can adjust the size of the ServeRAID Manager viewing areas to  
make it easier to see information in which you are interested. Just drag the  
horizontal and vertical bars that separate the ServeRAID Manager panes.  
More information  
v
v
Using ServeRAID in a cluster environment  
Note: This action is not supported when using the following:  
v Integrated RAID controller  
v ServeRAID-5i controller  
v ServeRAID-6i/6i+ controller  
v ServeRAID-7k controller  
v ServeRAID-7t controller  
v ServeRAID-8i controller  
v ServeRAID-8k/8k-l controller  
v HostRAID controller  
A cluster is a group of independent computer systems that work together as a  
single logical system. A client interacts with a cluster as though it is a single server.  
In other words, a cluster is a group of computers linked together in such a way  
that they share and manage a set of resources that can support a number of users  
at the same time.  
The ServeRAID high-availability clustering solution is based on a two-server  
cluster, where both servers can access the same storage devices, but only one  
server at a time controls the storage devices shared by both servers. If one of the  
two running servers fails, the remaining server automatically assumes control of  
the shared resources managed by the failed server while still controlling its own  
resources at the same time. The failed server can then be repaired offline without  
Chapter 3. Using ServeRAID Manager 27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
the loss of time or work efficiency because the shared data and applications earlier  
managed by the failed server are still online to the clients.  
When the failed server is operational again, it can be placed back into the cluster;  
the resources are reallocated between the two servers and the cluster resumes  
normal operation.  
You will need clustering hardware and software to configure a cluster. You can  
install IBM ServeRAID Cluster Solution by using one of the following software  
applications:  
v Microsoft Cluster Server, which is part of Windows NT Server Enterprise  
Edition.  
v Microsoft Cluster Server using Windows 2000, which is part of Windows 2000  
Advanced Server Edition.  
Important: Be sure to review Installing the IBM ServeRAID Cluster Solution.  
Using Active PCI features  
Note: This action is not supported when using the following:  
v
Integrated RAID controller  
v ServeRAID-5i controller  
v ServeRAID-6i/6i+ controller  
v ServeRAID-6M controller under Windows operating systems  
Some IBM servers support Active PCI (also called hot-plug PCI) features. You can  
use these features to install or remove PCI controllers without turning off the  
server. The following table summarizes which operating systems support these  
features.  
Windows NT Windows  
Windows  
Feature  
4.0  
2000  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Server 2003  
NetWare 4.x NetWare 5.x  
Hot add  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
No  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Hot remove  
Hot replace  
You can use the hot-add feature to add a controller to a running server, thus  
expanding its capacity.  
Note: If you are not using the hot-add feature, restore the controller to the  
factory-default settings before configuring arrays and logical drives.  
Use the hot-remove feature to remove a controller from a running server. If a  
controller fails, use the hot-replace feature to replace a controller with an identical  
controller.  
Attention: Do not attempt a hot-replace operation on Windows 2000, Windows  
Server 2003, or NetWare by hot-removing a failed controller and then hot-adding a  
new controller. Loss of data can occur. If a controller fails on these operating  
systems, you must shut down the server to replace the controller.  
More information  
v
v
28 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v
v
v
v
Using Windows NT 4.0 with Active PCI features: To use Active PCI with  
Windows NT 4.0 and a ServeRAID-4 controller, you must install the following  
software components in this order:  
1. DMI Service provider. A free version is included on the IBM ServeRAID  
Support CD in the following directory:  
e:\WINNT\DMISP\setup.exe  
where e is the CD-ROM drive.  
Note: This version is sufficient for most users’ needs, but a Y2K compliant  
version is available at the following Web site:  
http://www.enablers.com  
2. IBM Hot Plug for Windows NT 4.0 Package, version 4.2 or later. This package  
is available from the IBM Support Web site.  
Note: Be sure to read the instructions and restrictions for this software  
program.  
3. ServeRAID Active PCI DMI component. This is component is installed  
automatically when you install the ServeRAID Manager program.  
To perform a hot-replace operation, start the IBM ServeRAID Hot Replace Wizard.  
You can start this program from within either the IBM Hot Plug for Windows NT  
4.0 program or the ServeRAID Manager program. You can use the ServeRAID  
Manager program to start the wizard either on the server with the failed controller,  
or across the network from a remote installation of the ServeRAID Manager.  
Note: It is useful to start the IBM ServeRAID Hot Replace Wizard from a remote  
installation when the server with the failed controller does not have a  
monitor.  
More information  
v
v
Understanding unattended mode  
Unattended mode is a setting that alters how the ServeRAID Manager startup code  
(that is, BIOS) handles failures during a system startup. Examples of possible  
failures during the startup are the following:  
v The BIOS cannot communicate with the controller.  
v A physical drive state has changed.  
v A logical drive state has changed.  
You can set unattended mode: either Disabled or Enabled. The default is Disabled.  
When unattended mode is disabled and the BIOS detects a failure, the system  
remains at the recovery option screen and waits for the user to respond.  
When unattended mode is enabled and the BIOS detects a failure, the system waits  
for 30 seconds for the user to respond to the recovery options screen. If no user  
Chapter 3. Using ServeRAID Manager 29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
responds, the BIOS automatically selects the first recovery option in the list and  
continues the system startup process. This mode is useful for remote systems  
where a user is not present for system startups.  
Consider carefully whether to enable unattended mode. Depending on how you  
use the system, unattended mode might be undesirable.  
For example, consider a system that includes an enclosure of multiple physical  
drives. If the enclosure is turned off when you start the system, the BIOS reports a  
drive failure. If unattended mode is enabled, the BIOS accepts a recovery option  
that changes the configuration. When the system restarts with the enclosure turned  
on, the configuration is no longer correct and the system no longer works as  
originally configured.  
You can change unattended mode with the ServeRAID Manager in bootable-CD  
mode only.  
Note: If you are configuring your system for clustering, you must enable  
unattended mode. If you use the ServeRAID Manager to enable your system  
for clustering, the ServeRAID Manager automatically enables unattended  
mode.  
More information  
v
v
v
Using the ServeRAID Manager interface  
Before you begin using the ServeRAID Manager, take some time to review the  
layout of its user interface.  
v
v
v
v
v
v
You can work with the ServeRAID Manager interface by doing any of the  
following:  
v Select actions from the menubar.  
v Click an item on the toolbar.  
v Right-click an object in the Enterprise view, the Physical devices view, or Logical  
devices view.  
v Drag and drop objects in the Configuration wizard.  
v Double-click objects and events.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
30 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v
v
Finding information on the World Wide Web  
IBM home page http://www.ibm.com/pc/  
IBM support page http://www.ibm.com/pc/support/  
Complete the following steps to access ServeRAID and Clustering support:  
1. From the Browse the support site list box, select Servers. The IBM xSeries,  
Netfinity, and PC Server Support page opens.  
2. From the Family list box, select ServeRAID or Clustering. The ServeRAID or  
Clustering Support page opens.  
3. Click one of the following options that appear in the left margin:  
Downloadable files  
Download the latest versions of Clustering software, the ServeRAID  
Manager program, BIOS and firmware code, device-driver updates, and  
other important information.  
Hints and tips  
Obtain useful information about IBM Clustering and ServeRAID  
products, as well as tips for troubleshooting potential problems.  
Online publications  
Download the installation and user’s guides, references, white papers,  
and other IBM publications.  
Note: All IBM ServeRAID publications are available on the IBM  
ServeRAID Support CD.  
4. From the . . . by Category list box, select RAID; a list of downloadable files  
appears below the list box.  
IBM ServerProven compatibility page http://www.ibm.com/PC/us/compat/  
Detailed information about server compatibility issues.  
IBM ServeRAID publications  
The following publications are available in Portable Data Format (PDF) on the  
IBM ServeRAID Support CD in the /BOOKS directory:  
v
v
v
IBM ServeRAID User’s Reference (SRAID.PDF)  
IBM ServeRAID Installation Guide (series 4, 5, 6, and 7 controllers) (INSTALL.PDF)  
IBM ServeRAID Device Driver Installation Instructions (DEVDRV.PDF)  
Note: Use Adobe Acrobat Reader to view these publications. The IBM ServeRAID  
Support CD contains the Acrobat Readers for Microsoft Windows, IBM OS/2,  
and Linux in the /BOOKS/READERS directory.  
If you are installing the IBM ServeRAID Cluster Solution, you might need to refer  
to the IBM Shared Disk Clustering Hardware Reference. This publication provides  
general information about planning and configuring a shared-disk cluster using  
IBM server products. It contains illustrations, descriptions, and parts listings for  
various high-availability, shared-disk cluster examples.  
Note: You can obtain this publication from the IBM Support Web site.  
Chapter 3. Using ServeRAID Manager 31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
In addition, the following IBM Redbooks might be of interest:  
v
v
Implementing Netfinity Disk Subsystems: ServeRAID SCSI, Fibre Channel, and SSA  
Tuning Netfinity Server for Performance: Getting the most out of Windows 2000 and  
Windows NT 4.0  
v
v
Netfinity Director: Integration and Tools  
Netfinity Clustering Planning Guide  
You can download these publications from the IBM Web site: www.ibm.com/  
redbooks  
Understanding RAID technology  
Redundant array of independent disk (RAID) is the technology of grouping several  
physical drives in a computer into an array that you can define as one or more  
logical drives. Each logical drive appears to the operating system as a single drive.  
This grouping technique greatly enhances logical-drive capacity and performance  
beyond the physical limitations of a single physical drive.  
When you group multiple physical drives into a logical drive, the ServeRAID  
controller can transfer data in parallel from the multiple drives in the array. This  
parallel transfer yields data-transfer rates that are many times higher than with  
nonarrayed drives. This increased speed makes the system better able to meet the  
throughput (the amount of data processed in a given amount of time) or  
productivity needs of the multiple-user network environment.  
The ability to respond to multiple data requests provides not only an increase in  
throughput, but also a decrease in response time. The combination of parallel  
transfers and simultaneous responses to multiple requests enables disk arrays to  
provide a high level of performance in network environments.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Understanding stripe-unit size  
With RAID technology, data is striped across an array of physical drives. This  
data-distribution scheme complements the way the operating system requests data.  
The granularity at which data is stored on one drive of the array before subsequent  
data is stored on the next drive of the array is called the stripe-unit size .  
You can set the stripe-unit size to 8 KB, 16 KB, 32 KB, or 64 KB. You can maximize  
the performance of your ServeRAID controller by setting the stripe-unit size to a  
32 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
value that is close to the size of the system I/O requests. For example,  
performance in transaction-based environments, which typically involve large  
blocks of data, might be optimal when the stripe-unit size is set to 32 KB or 64 KB.  
However, performance in file and print environments, which typically involve  
multiple small blocks of data, might be optimal when the stripe-unit size is set to  
8 KB or 16 KB.  
The ServeRAID-7t, ServeRAID-8i, ServeRAID-8k/8k-l, and  
HostRAID controllers do not support an 8 KB stripe-unit size. The ServeRAID-7t  
ServeRAID-8i, and ServeRAID-8k/8k-l controllers support these additional  
stripe-unit sizes: 128 KB, 256 KB, 512 KB, and 1024 KB.  
The collection of stripe units, from the first drive of the array to the last drive of  
the array, is called a stripe.  
After you configure an array and store data on the logical drives, you  
cannot change the stripe-unit size without destroying data in the logical drives.  
You can set the stripe-unit size to 8 KB, 16 KB, 32 KB, or 64 KB. The default setting  
is 8 KB data bytes.  
v When the stripe-unit size is 8 KB or 16 KB, the maximum number of physical  
drives in an array is 16.  
v If you have a ServeRAID-3H or ServeRAID-3HB controller using ServeRAID  
firmware (version 4.0, or later) and the stripe-unit size is 32 KB or 64 KB, the  
maximum number of physical drives in an array is 16. Otherwise, when the  
stripe-unit size is 32 KB or 64 KB, the maximum number of physical drives in an  
array is 8.  
v If you have a ServeRAID-4 controller and the stripe-unit size is set to 32 KB or  
64 KB, the maximum number of physical drives in an array is 16.  
More information  
v
v
Understanding RAID level-0  
RAID level-0 stripes the data across all the drives in the array. This offers  
substantial speed enhancement, but provides no data redundancy. RAID level-0  
provides the largest storage capacity of the RAID levels that are offered, because  
no room is taken for redundant data or data-parity storage.  
RAID level-0 requires a minimum of one drive and, depending upon the level of  
firmware and the stripe-unit size, supports a maximum of 8 or 16 drives.  
For ServeRAID-8i, ServeRAID-8k/8k-l, ServeRAID-7t, and  
HostRAID controllers, RAID level-0 requires a minimum of two drives.  
The following illustration shows an example of a RAID level-0 logical drive.  
Chapter 3. Using ServeRAID Manager 33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
RAID level-0 example  
Start with two physical drives.  
Create an array using the two physical drives.  
Then create a logical drive within that array.  
The data is striped across the drives, creating blocks. Notice that the data is striped  
across all the drives in the array, but no redundant data is stored.  
A physical drive failure within the array results in loss of data in the logical drive  
assigned RAID level-0, but only in that logical drive. If you have logical drives  
assigned RAID level-1, 1E, 5, or 5E in the same array, they will not lose data.  
Note: If you have an array that contains only one physical drive, you can assign  
only RAID level-0 to the logical drive in that array.  
When you replace a failed drive, the controller can rebuild all the RAID level-1, 1E,  
5, 5E, and 5EE logical drives automatically onto the replacement physical drive.  
However, any data stored in a failed RAID level-0 logical drive is lost.  
Although the risk of data loss is present, you might want to assign RAID level-0 to  
one of the logical drives to take advantage of the speed this RAID level offers. You  
can use this logical drive to store data that you back up each day and can re-create  
easily. You also might want to use a RAID level-0 logical drive when you require  
maximum capacity.  
34 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advantages and disadvantages  
RAID level-0 offers the following advantages and disadvantages.  
Advantages  
Disadvantages  
No data redundancy, resulting in data loss  
in the event that a physical drive fails  
v Substantial speed enhancement  
v Maximum utilization of physical drive  
storage capacity, because no room is taken  
for redundant data or data-parity storage  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Understanding RAID level-1  
RAID level-1 uses data mirroring. Two physical drives are combined into an array,  
and data is striped across the array. The first half of a stripe is the original data;  
the second half of a stripe is a mirror (that is, a copy) of the data, but it is written  
to the other drive in the RAID level-1 array.  
RAID level-1 provides data redundancy and high levels of performance, but the  
storage capacity is diminished. Because the data is mirrored, the capacity of the  
logical drive when assigned RAID level-1 is 50% of the array capacity.  
RAID level-1 requires two physical drives.  
The following illustration shows an example of a RAID level-1 logical drive.  
RAID level-1 example  
Start with two physical drives.  
Create an array using the two physical drives.  
Chapter 3. Using ServeRAID Manager 35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Then create a logical drive within that array.  
The data is striped across the drives, creating blocks. Notice that the data on the  
drive on the right is a copy of the data on the drive on the left.  
With RAID level-1, if one of the physical drives fails, the controller switches read  
and write requests to the remaining functional drive in the RAID level-1 array.  
Advantages and disadvantages  
RAID level-1 offers the following advantages and disadvantages.  
Advantages  
Disadvantages  
Allows only 50% of the physical drive  
storage capacity to be used  
v 100% data redundancy  
v High performance  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Understanding RAID level-1 Enhanced  
RAID level-1 Enhanced (RAID level-1E) combines mirroring and data striping. This  
RAID level stripes data and copies of the data across all of the drives in the array.  
As with the standard RAID level-1, the data is mirrored, and the capacity of the  
logical drive is 50% of the array capacity.  
RAID level-1E has a similar profile to RAID level-1; it provides data redundancy  
and high levels of performance, but the storage capacity is diminished. However,  
RAID level-1E allows a larger number of physical drives to be used.  
RAID level-1E requires a minimum of three drives and, depending upon the level  
of firmware and the stripe-unit size, supports a maximum of 8 or 16 drives.  
36 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
The following illustration is an example of a RAID level-1E logical drive.  
RAID level-1 Enhanced example  
Start with three physical drives.  
Create an array using the physical drives.  
Then create a logical drive within that array.  
The data is striped across the drives, creating blocks. Notice that the stripe labeled  
* is the data stripe and the stripe labeled ** is the copy of the preceding data  
stripe. Also, notice that each block on the mirror stripe is shifted one drive.  
With RAID level-1E, if one of the physical drives fails, the controller switches read  
and write requests to the remaining functional drives in the RAID level-1E array.  
Advantages and disadvantages  
RAID level-1E offers the following advantages and disadvantages:  
Advantages  
Disadvantages  
Allows only 50% of the physical drive  
storage capacity to be used  
v 100% data redundancy  
v High performance  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
v
Chapter 3. Using ServeRAID Manager 37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
v
v
v
v
v
Understanding RAID level-5  
RAID level-5 stripes data and parity across all drives in the array.  
RAID level-5 offers both data protection and increased throughput. When you  
assign RAID level-5 to an array, the capacity of the array is reduced by the  
capacity of one drive (for data-parity storage). RAID level-5 gives you higher  
capacity than RAID level-1, but RAID level-1 offers better performance.  
RAID level-5 requires a minimum of three drives and, depending upon the level of  
firmware and the stripe-unit size, supports a maximum of 8 or 16 drives.  
The following illustration is an example of a RAID level-5 logical drive.  
RAID level-5 example  
Start with four physical drives.  
Create an array using three of the physical drives, leaving the fourth as a hot-spare  
drive.  
Then create a logical drive within that array.  
The data is striped across the drives, creating blocks.  
Notice that the storage of the data parity (denoted by *) also is striped, and it  
shifts from drive to drive.  
A parity block ( *) contains a representation of the data from the other blocks in  
the same stripe. For example, the parity block in the first stripe contains data  
representation of blocks 1 and 2.  
38 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
If a physical drive fails in the array, the data from the failed physical drive is  
reconstructed onto the hot-spare drive.  
Advantages and disadvantages  
RAID level-5 offers the following advantages and disadvantages.  
Advantages  
Disadvantages  
Lower performance than RAID level-1 and  
level-1E  
v 100% data protection  
v Offers more physical drive storage  
capacity than RAID level-1 or level-1E  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Understanding RAID level-5 Enhanced  
Note: This RAID level is not available on all controllers.  
RAID level-5E is the same as RAID level-5 with a built-in spare drive. Like RAID  
level-5, this RAID level stripes data and parity across all of the drives in the array.  
RAID level-5E offers both data protection and increased throughput. When an  
array is assigned RAID level-5E, the capacity of the logical drive is reduced by the  
capacity of two physical drives in the array (one for parity and one for the spare).  
Reading from and writing to four physical drives is more efficient than reading  
from and writing to three physical drives and an idle hot spare. Therefore, RAID  
level-5E provides a higher level of performance than RAID level-5.  
Chapter 3. Using ServeRAID Manager 39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
The spare drive is actually part of the RAID level-5E array, as shown in the  
following example. With such a configuration, you cannot share the spare drive  
with other arrays. If you want a spare drive for any other array, you must have  
another spare drive for those arrays.  
RAID level-5E requires a minimum of four drives and, depending upon the level  
of firmware and the stripe-unit size, supports a maximum of 8 or 16 drives. RAID  
level-5E is also firmware-specific.  
Note: For RAID level-5E, you can have only one logical drive in an array. When  
using RAID level-5E, you can have a maximum of seven logical drives on  
the controller.  
The following illustration is an example of a RAID level-5E logical drive.  
RAID level-5 Enhanced example  
Start with four physical drives.  
Create an array using all four physical drives.  
Then create a logical drive (labeled as 1) within the array. Notice that the  
distributed spare drive is the free space (labeled as 2) shown below the logical  
drive.  
The data is striped across the drives, creating blocks in the logical drive. The  
storage of the data parity (denoted by * ) is striped, and it shifts from drive to  
drive as it does in RAID level-5. Notice that the spare drive is not striped.  
If a physical drive fails in the array, the data from the failed drive is reconstructed.  
The array undergoes compression, and the distributed spare drive becomes part of  
the array. The logical drive remains RAID level-5E.  
When you replace the failed drive, the data for the logical drive decompresses and  
returns to the original striping scheme.  
40 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If you use a RAID level-5E logical drive in a failover or cluster configuration, the  
RAID level-5E logical drive will not failover while undergoing compression or  
decompression.  
Advantages and disadvantages  
RAID level-5E offers the following advantages and disadvantages.  
Advantages  
Disadvantages  
v 100% data protection  
v Lower performance than RAID level-1  
and level-1E  
v Offers more physical drive storage  
capacity than RAID level-1 or level-1E  
v Supports only one logical drive per array  
v Higher performance than RAID level-5  
v Cannot share a hot-spare drive with other  
arrays  
v Not supported on all controllers  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Understanding RAID level-5EE  
Note: This feature is not supported on all controllers.  
RAID level-5EE is similar to RAID level-5E but with a more efficient distributed  
spare and faster rebuild times. Like RAID level-5E, this RAID level stripes data  
and parity across all of the drives in the array.  
RAID level-5EE offers both data protection and increased throughput. When an  
array is assigned RAID level-5EE, the capacity of the logical drive is reduced by  
the capacity of two physical drives in the array: one for parity and one for the  
spare.  
The spare drive is part of the RAID level-5EE array. However, unlike RAID  
level-5E, which uses contiguous free space for the spare, a RAID level-5EE spare is  
interleaved with the parity blocks, as shown in the following example. This allows  
Chapter 3. Using ServeRAID Manager 41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
data to be reconstructed more quickly if a physical drive in the array fails. With  
such a configuration, you cannot share the spare drive with other arrays. If you  
want a spare drive for any other array, you must have another spare drive for  
those arrays.  
RAID level-5EE requires a minimum of four drives and, depending upon the level  
of firmware and the stripe-unit size, supports a maximum of 8 or 16 drives. RAID  
level-5EE is also firmware-specific.  
Note: For RAID level-5EE, you can have only one logical drive in an array.  
The following illustration is an example of a RAID level-5EE logical drive.  
RAID level-5EE example  
Start with four physical drives.  
Create an array using all four physical drives.  
Then create a logical drive within the array.  
The data is striped across the drives, creating blocks in the logical drive. The  
storage of the data parity (denoted by *) is striped, and it shifts from drive to  
drive as it does in RAID level-5E. The spare drive (denoted by S) is interleaved  
with the parity blocks, and it also shifts from drive to drive.  
If a physical drive fails in the array, the data from the failed drive is reconstructed.  
The array undergoes compaction, and the distributed spare drive becomes part of  
the array. The logical drive remains RAID level-5EE.  
42 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When you replace the failed drive, the data for the logical drive undergoes  
expansion and returns to the original striping scheme.  
Advantages and disadvantages  
RAID level-5EE offers the following advantages and disadvantages.  
Advantages  
v 100% data protection  
v Offers more physical drive storage capacity than RAID level-1 or  
level-1E  
v Higher performance than RAID level-5  
v Faster rebuild than RAID level-5E  
Disadvantages  
v Lower performance than RAID level-1 and level-1E  
v Supports only one logical drive per array  
v Cannot share a hot-spare drive with other arrays  
v Not supported on all controllers  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Understanding RAID level-6  
RAID level-6 is similar to RAID level-5 but with two sets of parity information  
instead of one. RAID level-6 stripes blocks of data and parity across all drives in  
the array like RAID level-5, but adds a second set of parity information for each  
block of data.  
When you assign RAID level-6 to an array, the capacity of the array is reduced for  
data-parity storage (the exact amount depends on the size of the drives in the  
array). The second set of parity information is added to improve fault tolerance.  
RAID level-6 can handle two simultaneous drive failures, where other single RAID  
levels can handle, at most, only one.  
RAID level-6 requires a minimum of four drives and supports a maximum of 16  
drives. The maximum stripe-unit size depends on the number of drives in the  
array.  
The following illustration is an example of a RAID level-6 logical drive.  
Chapter 3. Using ServeRAID Manager 43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
RAID level-6 example  
Start with six physical drives.  
Create a logical drive using four physical drives, leaving two for hot spare drives.  
The data is striped across the drives, creating blocks in the logical drive. The  
storage of the data parity (denoted by * and **) is striped, and it shifts from drive  
to drive as it does in RAID level-5.  
If a physical drive fails in the array, the logical drive is degraded but remains fault  
tolerant.  
If a second physical drive fails in the array, the data from the failed drives are  
reconstructed onto the hot-spare drives, and the data for the logical drive return to  
the original striping scheme.  
44 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Advantages and disadvantages  
RAID level-6 offers the following advantages and disadvantages.  
Advantages  
Disadvantages  
v 100% data protection  
v Lower performance than RAID level-5  
because of two parity drives  
v Not supported on all controllers  
v Extremely high data fault tolerance  
v Can sustain two simultaneous drive  
failures  
v Good solution for mission critical  
applications  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Understanding RAID level-x0  
Note: RAID level-x0 is not available on all controllers.  
RAID level-x0 refers to RAID level-00, 10, 1E0, 50 and 60. RAID level-x0 uses an  
array of arrays, or a spanned array. The operating system uses the spanned array  
logical drive in the same way as a regular array logical drive.  
RAID level-x0 allows more physical drives in an array. The benefits of doing so are  
larger logical drives, increased performance, and increased reliability. RAID level-0,  
10, 1E, 5, 5E, and 6 cannot use more than 16 physical drives in an array; however,  
RAID level-1E0, 50, and 60 support 60 to 128 drives.  
RAID level-x0 requires a minimum of two drives and supports a maximum of 60  
to 128 drives, depending on the controller.  
The following illustration is an example of a RAID level-10 logical drive.  
Chapter 3. Using ServeRAID Manager 45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
RAID level-10 example  
Start with six physical drives.  
Create three arrays (labeled A, B, and C), each array using two physical drives.  
Then create a spanned array (labeled as *) that spans the three arrays.  
A sub-logical drive is created within each array (A, B, and C). Then the data is  
striped across the physical drives in the array, creating blocks.  
Notice that, in each array, the data on the drive on the right is a copy of the data  
on the drive on the left. This is because the sub-logical drives (A, B, and C) are  
RAID level-1 in a RAID level-10 implementation (see the following table).  
Then create a logical drive within the spanned array (*).  
The data is striped across this logical drive, creating blocks ( 1- 12). Notice that  
none of these blocks are redundant. This is because the logical drive is RAID  
level-0 in a RAID level-x0 implementation (see the following table).  
RAID level  
Sub-logical drive  
RAID level-0  
RAID level-1  
RAID level-1E  
RAID level-5  
Spanned array logical drive  
RAID level-0  
00  
10  
RAID level-0  
1E0  
50  
RAID level-0  
RAID level-0  
46 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
RAID level  
Sub-logical drive  
Spanned array logical drive  
60  
RAID level-6  
RAID level-0  
With RAID level-10, 1E0, and 50, if one of the physical drives fails in a sub-logical  
drive, the ServeRAID controller switches read and write requests to the remaining  
functional drives in the sub-logical drive. With RAID level-60, if one or two of the  
physical drives fails in a sub-logical drive, the ServeRAID controller switches read  
and write requests to the remaining functional drives in the sub-logical drive. With  
RAID level-00, a physical drive failure within the sub-logical drive results in loss of  
data.  
Advantages and disadvantages  
RAID level-x0 offers the following advantages and disadvantages.  
Advantages  
Disadvantages  
v Not available on all controllers  
v Supports up to 60 physical drives on SCSI  
v No data redundancy for RAID level-00  
controllers  
v Supports up to 128 physical drives on  
SAS and SATA controllers  
v 100% data redundancy (except for RAID  
level-00)  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Understanding RAID volumes  
Note: HostRAID controllers do not support RAID volumes.  
For ServeRAID SAS controllers (8i/8k/8k-l) and the ServeRAID-7t SATA controller,  
the ServeRAID Manager supports the following RAID volume types:  
v
v
Simple Volume - a single disk drive or segment; not redundant.  
Spanned Volume - two or more disk drives or segment with the same or  
different capacity, connected end-to-end. A spanned volume offers no  
redundancy or performance advantage over a single drive.  
v
RAID Volume - two or more logical drives with the same RAID level,  
connected end-to-end. The logical drives may have the same or different  
capacity and are not striped together; they may be redundant, depending on the  
RAID level.  
Notes:  
Chapter 3. Using ServeRAID Manager 47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
You must create the individual logical drives before you create a  
RAID Volume. Use the Configuration wizard to create the logical  
drives; then, run the Configuration wizard again to create the RAID  
Volume.  
– When you create a RAID Volume, the ServeRAID Manager replaces  
the individual logical drives with a single RAID Volume icon in the  
Logical devices view; then, it reports the logical drives as deleted in  
the event viewer. The event message is normal and does not indicate a  
loss of data.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Creating a simple volume  
Use this action to create a simple volume. A simple volume is a single disk drive  
or segment used for storage in a RAID system; it is not redundant.  
Complete the following steps to create a simple volume:  
1. In the Physical devices view, click  
2. Right-click Create simple volume.  
3. Click Yes to confirm.  
(online physical drive).  
More information  
v
Selecting a RAID level and tuning performance  
Disk arrays are used to improve performance and reliability. The amount of  
improvement depends on the application programs that you run on the server and  
the RAID levels that you assign to the logical drive.  
Each RAID level provides different levels of fault-tolerance (data redundancy),  
utilization of physical drive capacity, and read and write performance. In addition,  
the RAID levels differ in regard to the minimum and maximum number of  
physical drives that are supported.  
When selecting a RAID level for your system, consider the following factors.  
Note: Not all RAID levels are supported by all ServeRAID controllers.  
Physical  
drive  
Min.  
Max.  
Data redun- capacity  
Read perfor- Write perfor- Built-in  
number of  
drives  
number of  
drives  
RAID level dancy  
utili- zation mance  
mance  
spare drive  
100% Superior  
Superior  
No  
1
16  
48 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Physical  
drive  
Min.  
Max.  
Data redun- capacity  
Read perfor- Write perfor- Built-in  
number of  
drives  
number of  
drives  
RAID level dancy  
utili- zation mance  
mance  
spare drive  
50%  
50%  
Very high  
Very high  
Very high  
Very high  
No  
No  
2
3
2
Yes  
16  
67% to 94% Superior  
50% to 88% Superior  
High  
High  
No  
Yes  
3
4
16  
16  
Yes  
Yes  
50% to 88% Superior  
High  
Yes  
4
16  
50% to 88% Very High  
High  
No  
No  
4
2
16  
60  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
No  
100%  
50%  
50%  
Superior  
Very high  
Very high  
Superior  
Very high  
Very high  
High  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
4
6
6
8
2
4
16  
60  
67% to 94% Superior  
50% to 88% Very High  
60 (SCSI) 128  
(SAS, SATA)  
High  
128  
100%  
Superior  
Superior  
Superior  
48  
50% to 100% Superior  
48  
Physical drive utilization, read performance, and write performance depend on the  
number of drives in the array. Generally, the more drives in the array, the better  
the performance.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Chapter 3. Using ServeRAID Manager 49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Selecting the RAID level by array capacity  
Note: Not all RAID levels are supported by all ServeRAID controllers.  
If your array has...  
Consider this RAID level...  
One or more physical drives in an array.  
Notes:  
v This is the only choice if the array  
contains only one physical drive.  
v You can select RAID level-0 for any  
logical drive.  
Two physical drives. The default for two  
physical drives is RAID level-1.  
Three or more physical drives.  
Three or more physical drives.  
Four or more physical drives.  
Four or more physical drives.  
Four or more physical drives.  
Two or more physical drives.  
Four or more physical drives.  
Six or more physical drives.  
Six or more physical drives.  
Eight or more physical drives.  
More information  
v
Example: Total disk capacity  
Physical drives in an array can be of different capacities (1 GB, or 2 GB, for  
example). The sum of the physical drives’ capacity grouped in an array is the total  
disk capacity.  
For example, if you group two 2 GB drives and one 3 GB drive into an array, the  
total disk capacity is the 7 GB physically available.  
2 GB  
2 GB  
3 GB  
50 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Similarly, if you group three 2 GB drives and 1 GB drive into an array, the total  
disk capacity is the 7 GB physically available.  
More information  
v
Example: Usable and unusable capacity  
Physical drive capacities influence the way you create arrays and logical drives.  
Drives in an array can be of different capacities (1 GB, or 2 GB, for example), but  
RAID controllers treat them as if they all have the capacity of the smallest physical  
drive.  
For example, if you group two 2 GB drives and one 3 GB drive into an array, the  
usable capacity of the array is 2 GB times 3, or 6 GB, not the 7 GB physically  
available. The 7 GB is the total disk capacity. In the following diagram, usable  
capacity is labeled as 1 and unusable capacity is labeled as 2.  
2 GB  
2 GB  
3 GB  
Similarly, if you group three 2 GB drives and 1 GB drive into an array, the usable  
capacity of that array is 4 GB, not the 7 GB physically available. The 7 GB is the  
total disk capacity. The remaining capacity left on the three 2 GB drive is unusable  
capacity.  
The optimal way to create arrays is to use physical drives that have the same  
capacity. Doing so avoids unusable capacity  
For the ServeRAID-8i, ServeRAID-8k/8k-l, and ServeRAID-7t controllers, usable  
capacity is the same as the total disk capacity. That is, you can use the remaining  
space to define another logical drive. The segments that make up the logical drive  
must be the same size on each physical drive. For example, you can group two 1  
GB segments with the remaining space from the previous example to define a 3 GB  
logical drive. In the following diagram, the new logical drive is labeled 2; 4 GB of  
usable capacity remain, 2 GB on each drive, labeled 3.  
Chapter 3. Using ServeRAID Manager 51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2 GB  
2 GB  
3GB  
3 GB  
3 GB  
More information  
v
v
Software and hardware support of RAID levels  
RAID level  
ServeRAID software*  
release that supports the  
RAID level  
Hardware levels that  
support the RAID level  
0
All  
ServeRAID on the board,  
ServeRAID, ServeRAID-II,  
ServeRAID-3 family,  
ServeRAID-4 family,  
ServeRAID-5i,  
ServeRAID-6M,  
ServeRAID-6i/6i+,  
ServeRAID-7k,  
ServeRAID-7t,  
ServeRAID-8i/8k/8k-l  
1
All  
ServeRAID on the board,  
ServeRAID, ServeRAID-II,  
ServeRAID-3 family,  
ServeRAID-4 family,  
ServeRAID-5i,  
ServeRAID-6M,  
ServeRAID-6i/6i+,  
ServeRAID-7k,  
ServeRAID-7t,  
ServeRAID-8i/8k/8k-l,  
integrated RAID controller  
1E  
All  
ServeRAID on the board,  
ServeRAID, ServeRAID-II,  
ServeRAID-3 family,  
ServeRAID-4 family,  
ServeRAID-5i,  
ServeRAID-6M,  
ServeRAID-6i/6i+,  
ServeRAID-7k,  
ServeRAID-8i/8k/8k-l  
52 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
RAID level  
ServeRAID software*  
release that supports the  
RAID level  
Hardware levels that  
support the RAID level  
5
All  
ServeRAID on the board,  
ServeRAID, ServeRAID-II,  
ServeRAID-3 family,  
ServeRAID-4 family,  
ServeRAID-5i,  
ServeRAID-6M,  
ServeRAID-6i/6i+,  
ServeRAID-7k,  
ServeRAID-7t,  
ServeRAID-8i/8k/8k-l  
5E  
ServeRAID 3.50 or later  
ServeRAID 6.00 or later  
ServeRAID-3 and  
ServeRAID-4 families.  
5EE  
ServeRAID-4 family except  
ServeRAID-4H,  
ServeRAID-6M,  
ServeRAID-6i/6i+,  
ServeRAID-7k,  
ServeRAID-8i/8k/8k-l  
6
ServeRAID 7.30 or later  
ServeRAID 4.00 or later  
ServeRAID-8i/8k/8k-l  
x0  
ServeRAID-4 family,  
ServeRAID-5i,  
ServeRAID-6M,  
ServeRAID-6i/6i+,  
ServeRAID-7k,  
ServeRAID-7t,  
ServeRAID-8i/8k/8k-l  
* ServeRAID software refers to BIOS, firmware, device drivers, programs, and so  
forth.  
RAID levels that can use a hot-spare or standby hot-spare  
drive  
Hot-spare and standby hot-spare drives supply additional protection to a RAID  
configuration. When you select the RAID level for your configuration, consider the  
following:  
RAID level  
Can use a hot spare?  
Can use a standby hot  
spare?  
0
1
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
1E  
5
5E *  
5EE *  
6
00  
10  
1E0  
Chapter 3. Using ServeRAID Manager 53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
RAID level  
Can use a hot spare?  
Can use a standby hot  
spare?  
50  
60  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
* RAID level-5E and RAID level-5EE integrate a distributed hot-spare drive, but  
also can use traditional hot-spare and standby hot-spare drives. If a physical drive  
fails in a RAID level-5E or level-5EE logical drive and the configuration includes a  
hot-spare or standby hot-spare drive, the data is rebuilt on the hot-spare or  
standby hot-spare drive. A RAID level-5E compression or RAID level-5EE  
compaction does not occur. If a second physical drive fails in the RAID level-5E or  
level-5EE logical drive, a data compression or compaction will take place on the  
distributed hot-spare drive.  
More information  
v
v
Selecting the RAID level in the migration wizard  
To select a new RAID level for the array:  
1. Click the RAID level radio button. Only the most common choices appear in  
the list.  
2. To choose a different RAID level, click Advanced settings; then, choose a RAID  
level from the available options.  
Note: Only valid RAID level migrations appear in the list. Migration  
requirements for each RAID level are described here.  
3. When you are ready to continue, click Next. The Modify Array window opens.  
More information  
v
v
Starting the ServeRAID Manager task  
This topic describes how to start ServeRAID Manager in IBM Director.  
To start ServeRAID Manager, in the IBM Director Console Tasks pane, drag the  
ServeRAID Manager task onto a managed system that supports ServeRAID.  
The left pane is the Enterprise view pane, and the right pane is the Physical and  
Logical devices pane. The bottom pane is the event viewer.  
54 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
You can use ServeRAID Manager to view information about RAID controllers and  
the RAID subsystem, which includes arrays, logical drives, hot-spare drives, and  
physical drives.  
Logging in to the ServeRAID Manager  
Use this action log into the ServeRAID Manager. You must log in when you first  
start the ServeRAID Manager, or if you are logged out.  
You can log into the ServeRAID Manager as:  
v
v
v
Administrator: The Administrator log in allows you to view and modify the  
RAID configuration. You can create and delete logical drives, synchronize logical  
drives, perform migrations, add and remove hot-spare drives, and verify logical  
drives. To log in as Administrator, you must be a member of the Administrator  
group for your operating system. Use the Administrator user name and  
password or your own user name and password if you are a member of the  
Administrator group.  
User: The User log in allows you to view the RAID configuration, verify logical  
drives, and add and remove hot-spares. You cannot create or delete logical  
drives or perform migrations. To log in as User, use your normal network user  
name and password.  
Note: On Linux systems, the user name and password is defined in  
/etc/pam.d/storman.  
Guest: The Guest log in allows you to view the RAID configuration only. You  
cannot change or modify any information. To log in as Guest, simply click  
Cancel when the ServeRAID Manager Log In window opens.  
Logging in at ServeRAID Manager startup  
1. In the User Name field, type your user name.  
2. In the Password field, type your password.  
Note: The password is case sensitive.  
3. Click Connect. (To log in as Guest, click Cancel.)  
Logging in if you are currently logged out or logged in as Guest  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(system).  
2. Click Action Log in. The ServeRAID Manager Log In window opens.  
3. In the User Name field, type your user name.  
4. In the Password field, type your password.  
Note: The password is case sensitive.  
5. Click Connect.  
More information  
v
v
Chapter 3. Using ServeRAID Manager 55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Logging out of the ServeRAID Manager  
Use this action to log out of the ServeRAID Manager.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click (system).  
2. From Action menu, click Action Log out.  
Note: After log out, you can still use the ServeRAID Manager Guest account.  
The Guest account allows you to view the RAID configuration but not  
change it.  
More information  
v
Using the ServeRAID Manager from the command line  
You can use the following command-line parameters when starting the ServeRAID  
Manager:  
–h | –? | help  
Displays basic help for the ServeRAID Manager.  
–l  
Starts the ServeRAID Manager in local-only mode.  
The ServeRAID Manager does not obtain TCP/IP information and the  
remote actions are disabled. The only system appearing in the Enterprise  
view is the local system.  
If you have remote systems defined in the Enterprise view when you run  
in nonlocal-only mode (that is, not using the -l flag), they do not appear in  
the Enterprise view when you run in local-only mode.  
Note: Starting in local-only mode does not change any remote systems you  
have defined. The next time you start the ServeRAID Manager in  
nonlocal-only mode, your remote systems will appear in the  
Enterprise view again.  
–r  
Resets the Enterprise view. That is, it removes all remote systems from the  
Enterprise view tree.  
Note: This command does not remove remote systems from the remote  
notification list.  
Using the ServeRAID Manager with screen-reading software  
To use the ServeRAID Manager with screen-reading software, follow these  
steps:</>  
1. Download and install the Java 2 Platform for Microsoft Windows Operating  
System:  
2.  
a. Go to http://java.sun.com/j2se/1.4.2/download.html and download the  
Java 2 Platform Standard Edition Java Runtime Environment Version 1.4.2.  
An executable is available for installation.  
56 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
b. Follow the instructions provided by the installation program, accepting all  
defaults.  
3. Download and install the Java Access Bridge for Microsoft Windows Operating  
System:  
4.  
a. Go to http://java.sun.com/developer/earlyAccess/accessbridge/ and  
download the compressed zip file. An older version is available at  
http://java.sun.com/products/accessbridge/.  
b. Extract the zip file and navigate to the Installer folder. Execute the file  
Install.exe.  
c. Make sure that the installation program detects the Java Virtual Machine  
you just installed.  
d. Follow the instructions provided by the installation program.  
5. Install the screen reader software (ie, JAWS).  
6. Double click the RaidManAcc.bat file to start the ServeRAID Manager program.  
7.  
Note: Be sure that the java command is in your classpath. This should occur  
automatically when you install the Java Virtual Machine. If not, edit the  
batch file to explicitly point to the java.exe file found in the bin directory  
of the Java installation.  
More information  
v
Using the ServeRAID Manager in bootable-CD mode  
The ServeRAID Manager program operates in two ways:  
v bootable-CD mode  
v As an installed software program.  
When you run the ServeRAID Manager program from the IBM ServeRAID Support  
CD, you are using bootable-CD mode. The bootable-CD mode allows you to  
configure your ServeRAID controller before you install your operating system. After  
you have configured the ServeRAID controller and installed the operating system,  
you also can use bootable-CD mode to fine-tune specific ServeRAID controller  
To run the ServeRAID Manager program in bootable-CD mode, turn on the server;  
then, insert the IBM ServeRAID Support CD (or the CD that contains the  
ServeRAID Manager program that came with your server) into the CD-ROM drive.  
If the ServeRAID Manager program detects unconfigured ServeRAID controllers  
and ready drives, the program automatically starts the Configuration wizard.  
These are the actions that are available in bootable-CD mode only:  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Chapter 3. Using ServeRAID Manager 57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v
v
Accessing the ServeRAID Manager using the keyboard  
Use the following key combinations to navigate in windows, tables, text areas, and  
the ServeRAID Manager tree.  
Navigating in windows  
Action  
Key Combination  
Tab  
Navigate out forward  
Navigate out backward  
Activate  
Shift + Tab  
Enter  
Spacebar  
Alt + character accelerator key, if defined  
Navigate within group  
Check / Uncheck  
Arrow keys  
Spacebar  
Home  
To beginning of list  
To end of list  
End  
Select all entries in list  
Select additional item in list  
Ctrl + A  
Ctrl + Spacebar  
Esc  
Navigate out of menu, toolbar and tool tip  
components  
Open or post menu  
Up arrow, Down arrow  
Enter  
Spacebar  
Alt + character accelerator key, if defined  
Retract menu  
Esc  
Activate menu item  
Enter  
Spacebar  
Alt + character accelerator key, if defined  
Open submenu  
Retract submenu  
Right arrow  
Left arrow  
Esc  
Toggle drop-down list  
Alt + Up arrow  
Alt + Down arrow  
Ctrl + T  
Move to next link in Web page  
Activate link in Web page  
Ctrl + Spacebar  
58 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Navigating in tables or text areas  
Action  
Key Combination  
Navigate out forward in table or text area  
Ctrl + Tab  
Navigate out backward in table or text area Ctrl + Shift + Tab  
Move to next cell  
Tab  
(wrap to next row)  
(Right arrow)  
Shift + Tab  
Move to previous cell  
(wrap to previous row)  
Move to cell above  
Move to cell below  
(Left arrow)  
Up  
Down  
Accessing and navigating in the tree  
Action  
Key Combination  
Accessing the tree pane  
Expand entry  
Collapse entry  
Single select  
Ctrl + Tab  
Right  
Left  
Ctrl + Spacebar  
Other keyboard navigation shortcuts  
Action  
Key Combination  
Close active window  
Alt + F4  
Enter  
Display context menu for selected object  
Select controller, channel, or drive object  
Display selected object properties  
Open Help window  
Spacebar  
Alt + Enter  
F1  
Expand/collapse physical and logical  
devices  
Up arrow  
Down arrow  
Display event detail window (focus in event Spacebar  
viewer)  
More information  
v
v
Verifying that the ServeRAID Manager agent is running  
Use the following procedure to verify that the ServeRAID Manager agent is  
running on your system.  
Chapter 3. Using ServeRAID Manager 59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Windows 2000, Windows XP, Windows Server 2003  
1. In the lower-left corner of the desktop, click Start All Programs →  
Administrative Tools Services. The Services window opens.  
2. In the Services table, verify that the ServeRAID Manager Agentis listed and  
started.  
Windows NT  
1. In the lower-left corner of the desktop, click Start Settings Control Panel.  
The Control Panel window opens.  
2. Double-click Services. The Services window opens.  
3. In the Services table, verify that the ServeRAID Manager Agentis listed and  
started.  
OS/2  
1. Press Ctrl + Esc. The OS/2 Window List opens.  
2. Verify that the ServeRAID Manager Agentis listed.  
NetWare  
1. Press Alt + Esc to cycle through the NetWare consoles.  
2. Verify that ServeRAID Manageris displayed on the first line of a console  
screen. If none of the console screens display ServeRAID Manager,the agent  
is not running.  
Linux, OpenServer, UnixWare and Open UNIX  
1. Open a shell window.  
2. At the command prompt, type the following:  
ps -ef | grep RaidAgnt.sh  
3. If the agent is running, the process is listed as the following: sh RaidAgnt.sh.  
More information  
v
v
v
ServeRAID Manager and LED flash states  
The amber and blue LEDs are controlled by the backplane (for internal physical  
drives) or enclosure (for external physical drives). Controllers send commands to  
the backplane or enclosure processor to set a logical state for the LED, and the  
subsystem translates that LED state into the following flash states:  
Controller device state  
defunct  
Slot state  
LED flash state  
On  
Device is faulty  
Device is rebuilding  
Identify the device  
No error  
Rebuilding  
Identify  
Slow flash  
Fast flash  
Off  
Other  
The green LED is an activity indicator for the physical drive and is controlled by  
the physical drive.  
60 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
More information  
v
v
Chapter 3. Using ServeRAID Manager 61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
62 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices  
Configuring ServeRAID controllers and enclosures in the  
Configuration wizard  
Configuring an enclosure: the basic steps  
The following steps are an overview of the enclosure configuration process:  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(enclosure) that you want to configure.  
; or click on the toolbar. The  
2. In the Logical devices view, click  
Configuration wizard opens.  
3. Select the physical drives that you want to include in your arrays or create as  
hot-spare drives.  
4. Define the logical drives for your arrays.  
5. Define the authentication method for each logical drive (iSCSI initiators only).  
6. Define the initiators that can access the enclosure.  
9. Click Apply. The ServeRAID Manager will configure the controller and  
synchronize the logical drives.  
More information  
v
Configuring ServeRAID SCSI controllers (ServeRAID series 3,  
4, 5, 6, and 7K)  
Choosing between Express and Custom configuration  
Note: If you intend to use your ServeRAID controllers in a Microsoft Windows  
failover or clustering environment, review the ServeRAID publications  
before configuring ServeRAID.  
In the Configuration wizard, you can choose from two paths to configure your  
ServeRAID subsystem:  
v Click Express configuration for a quick and easy path for you to automatically  
configure your ServeRAID controller. This path creates the most efficient  
ServeRAID configuration based on the number and capacity of the ready  
physical drives available in your system. If four or more ready drives of the  
same capacity are available, this choice also will define a hot-spare drive.  
Express configuration does the following:  
– Creates arrays by grouping together same-sized physical drives.  
– Creates one logical drive per array up to 2 terabytes (TB) maximum.  
– Assigns a RAID level based on the number of physical drives in an array:  
- An array with a single physical drive is assigned RAID level-0.  
- An array with two physical drives is assigned RAID level-1.  
- An array with three or more physical drives is assigned RAID level-5.  
© Copyright IBM Corp. 1999, 2006  
63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Note: If the physical drive size exceeds 2TB, Express configuration removes  
drives until the size is less than 2 TB. It creates an additional array  
with the left-over drive(s).  
– Designates a hot-spare drive for the controller. If one or more arrays has four  
or more physical drives, the largest-sized drive from those arrays will be  
designated the hot-spare drive.  
Note: When you choose Express configuration, you have the opportunity to  
review and approve the configuration before the ServeRAID Manager  
applies the configuration. If you need to modify the configuration, you  
can do it from the configuration summary.  
v Click Custom configuration for a path that lets you manually configure your  
ServeRAID controller. Choose this path to do any of the following:  
– Configure your controller manually.  
– Assign RAID level-1E, RAID level-5E, RAID level-5EE, or RAID level-x0 to a  
logical drive.  
– Create more than one logical drive per array.  
Using the Custom path, you can:  
Click Automatically initialize new logical drives. Initializing a logical drive erases  
the first 1024 sectors on the drive and prevents access to any data previously  
stored on the drive. You can initialize the drive later if you do not choose  
automatic initialization.  
When you are ready to continue, click Next.  
More information  
v
v
v
Creating arrays and hot-spare drives  
Complete the following steps to create arrays:  
2. Click the appropriate Array tab in the right pane:  
3. Then, from the list of ready drives, select the drives you want to add to the  
array:  
4. Click  
>> (Add selected drives) to add the drives to the array. You can  
click  
>> (Add all drives) to move all ready drives to an array.  
64 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5. Repeat steps 2 and 3 for each additional array or hot-spare drive that you want  
to configure.  
6. If you do not want to create a spanned array, skip to step 6. Otherwise, select  
the Span arrays check box  
. Then, click Next. If you created two  
arrays only, the ServeRAID Manager uses those arrays to create the spanned  
array; continue to step 6. Otherwise, the Create Spanned Arrays window opens.  
Note: To create a spanned array, each array must have the same number of  
physical drives.  
7. After you select the ready drives for your arrays and hot-spare drive, click  
Next. The Create Logical Drives window opens.  
To return to the Express and Custom Configuration window, click Back. To leave  
the Configuration wizard, click Cancel.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
Creating spanned arrays  
If you want to assign RAID level-x0 to an array, you must create a spanned array.  
Note: Spanned arrays are supported only by IBM ServeRAID-4 Ultra160,  
ServeRAID-5i Ultra320, ServeRAID-6M Ultra320, and ServeRAID-6i/6i+  
Ultra320 SCSI controllers.  
Complete the following steps to create one or more identical spanned arrays:  
2. In the list of arrays, click the arrays that you want to add to your spanned  
array.  
3. Click  
can click  
>> (Add selected arrays) to add the arrays to the spanned array. You  
>> (Add all arrays) to move all arrays to the spanned array.  
4. To create additional spanned arrays, click the New spanned array tab in the  
right pane.  
Then, repeat steps 2 and 3.  
5. Click Next; the Create Logical Drives window opens.  
To return to the Create Arrays window, click Back. To leave the Configuration  
wizard, click Cancel.  
More information  
v
v
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Creating logical drives  
Complete the following steps to create logical drives:  
2. Click the appropriate Array tab.  
3. Select a RAID level from the drop-down list.  
Note:  
a. RAID level-5E and RAID level-5EE allow only one logical drive per  
array.  
b. If you are configuring a spanned array, you can set the RAID level  
only for the first logical drive you create.  
c. If you plan to use Change RAID level,you must assign the same  
RAID level to all logical drives within a single array.  
Attention: Before assigning a logical drive RAID level-5E or RAID level-5EE,  
consider the following. If a physical drive fails during a post-failover  
resynchronization, the logical drive will enter the blocked state. Data might be  
lost or damaged.  
4. If you do not want to use the maximum size for the logical drive, type the size  
in the Data (MB) field.  
Note:  
a. You can define up to eight logical drives per controller. There are two  
exceptions:  
v If an array contains a logical drive assigned RAID level-5E  
v If you want to use the logical-drive migration feature  
In these cases, one logical drive slot must be left free; therefore, you  
must define no more than seven logical drives.  
b. Some operating systems have size limitations for logical drives.  
Before you save the configuration, verify that the size of the logical  
drive is appropriate for your operating system. For more detailed  
information, see your operating-system documentation.  
c. A logical drive cannot exceed 2048 GB (2 terabytes); the minimum  
size is nMB, where n equals the number of drives in the array.  
d. Typically, the first logical drive defined on the first ServeRAID  
controller found by system BIOS during startup will be your startup  
(boot) drive.  
e. The actual logical-drive size might be slightly different from what  
you select. The RAID level and the number of physical drives  
66 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
determine the size of the logical drive. For example, an array  
consisting of three, 1 GB physical drives with a requested RAID  
level-0 logical drive of 1000 MB will actually contain only 999 MB  
because the data is striped across all three drives, with 333 MB on  
each drive.  
5. If you have free space available and want to create additional logical drives,  
click  
.
6. Repeat steps 3 through 5 for each logical drive that you want to define in this  
array.  
7. Repeat steps 2 through 6 for each additional array that you want to configure.  
8. Click Next. The Configuration Summary window opens.  
To return to the Create Arrays window, click Back. To leave the Configuration  
wizard, click Cancel.  
More information  
v
v
v
Confirming your express system configuration  
Use the configuration summary to review all the changes that the ServeRAID  
Manager will apply to your configuration:  
1. Review the information that is displayed in the Configuration Summary  
window. To change the configuration, click  
.
or  
Notes:  
a. Additional notes and attentions regarding the configuration appear  
b. Some operating systems have size limitations for logical drives.  
Before you save the configuration, verify that the size of the logical  
drive is appropriate for your operating system. For more detailed  
information, see your operating-system documentation.  
2. Click Apply; then, click Yes when asked if you want to apply the new  
configuration. The configuration is saved in the ServeRAID controller and in  
the physical drives.  
Note: If you clicked Automatically initialize new logical drives, the ServeRAID  
Manager will initialize the logical drives automatically.  
3. When you have completed configuring your controllers, you can change certain  
controller settings to fine-tune your configuration.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
Confirming your custom system configuration  
Use the configuration summary to review all the changes that the ServeRAID  
Manager will apply to your configuration:  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1. Review the information that is displayed in the Configuration Summary  
window. To change the configuration, click Back.  
Note: Additional notes and attentions regarding the configuration appear in  
2. Click Apply; then, click Yes when asked if you want to apply the new  
configuration. The configuration is saved in the ServeRAID controller and in  
the physical drives.  
Note: If you clicked Automatically initialize new logical drives, the ServeRAID  
Manager will initialize the logical drives automatically.  
3. When you have completed configuring your controller, you can change certain  
controller settings to fine-tune your configuration.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
Configuring ServeRAID SAS, SATA, and HostRAID controllers  
(ServeRAID-7t, ServeRAID-8i, HostRAID)  
Choosing between Express and Custom configuration  
In the Configuration wizard, you can choose from two paths to configure your  
ServeRAID-8i, ServeRAID-8k/8k-l, ServeRAID-7t, or HostRAID controller:  
v lick Express configuration for a quick and easy path for you to automatically  
configure your controller. This path creates the most efficient configuration based  
on the number and capacity of the ready physical drives available in your  
system. If four or more ready drives of the same capacity are available, this  
choice also will define a hot-spare drive.  
Express configuration does the following:  
– Creates one logical drive, up to 2 terabytes (TB) maximum, by grouping  
together same-sized physical drives.  
Note: If the physical drive size exceeds 2 terabytes (TB), Express  
configuration removes drives until the size is less than 2 terabytes (TB).  
It creates an additional logical drive with the left-over drive(s).  
– Assigns a RAID level based on the number of available physical drives:  
- A logical drive with a single physical drive is assigned RAID level-0.  
- A logical drive with two physical drives is assigned RAID level-1.  
- A logical drive with three physical drives is assigned RAID level-5.  
For HostRAID controllers, Express configuration creates a RAID level-1  
logical drive.  
– Designates a hot-spare drive for the controller. If four or more ready drives  
are available, the largest drive will be designated the hot-spare drive.  
Note: When you choose Express configuration, you have the opportunity to  
review and approve the configuration before the ServeRAID Manager  
applies the configuration. If you need to modify the configuration, you  
can do it from the configuration summary.  
68 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v Click Custom configuration for a path that lets you manually configure your  
controller. Choose this path to do any of the following:  
Define the RAID level of the logical drives.  
Fine tune your configuration for optimal performance  
When you are ready to continue, click Next.  
More information  
v
v
v
Choosing between Express and Custom configuration  
In the Configuration wizard, you can choose from two paths to configure your  
integrated RAID controller subsystem:  
v Click Express configuration for a quick and easy path for you to automatically  
configure your integrated RAID controller.  
Express configuration does the following:  
– Creates an array by grouping the first two physical drives that appear in the  
– Creates a RAID level-1 logical drive.  
Note: If you click Express, you will have the opportunity to review and approve  
the configuration before the ServeRAID Manager applies the  
configuration. If you need to modify the configuration, you can do so  
v Click Custom configuration for a path that lets you to manually configure your  
integrated RAID controller. Choose this path to do any of the following:  
– Configure your controller manually.  
– Select the two physical drives that you want to configure.  
– Create a hot-spare drive.  
– Preserve data on a mirror primary drive .  
Using this path, you can:  
To initialize the new logical drives, click Automatically initialize new logical  
drives. Initializing a logical drive erases the first 1024 sectors on the drive and  
prevents access to any data previously stored on the drive. You can initialize the  
drive later if you do not choose automatic initialization.  
When you are ready to continue, click Next.  
More information  
v
v
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Example: Express configuration: If your server contains the following:  
v One 1024 MB ready drive,  
v Two 2150 MB ready drives,  
v And four 4300 MB ready drives,  
Express configuration will create three arrays and one hot-spare drive as follows:  
Array A:  
The total capacity of this array is 1024 MB (1 x 1024 MB) and it contains  
one, 1024 MB RAID level-0 logical drive.  
Array B:  
The total capacity of this array is 4300 MB (2 x 2150 MB) and it contains  
one, 2150 MB RAID level-1 logical drive.  
Array C:  
The total capacity of this array is 12900 MB (3 x 4300 MB) and it contains  
one, 8600 MB RAID level-5 logical drive.  
Hot Spare:  
Express configuration defines one of the four 4300 MB drives as a  
hot-spare drive.  
Notes:  
1. When there are four or more ready drives of the same capacity, Express  
configuration groups three of the drives into one array (as in Array C)  
and defines one of the drives as a hot spare.  
2. A hot-spare drive must be of equal or greater capacity than the drive  
that it is intended to replace. In this configuration, the 4300 MB drive  
can replace any failed drives in Array B or Array C. Array A is not  
redundant, therefore a hot-spare drive is not used.  
More information  
v
v
v
Choosing the RAID Level  
Complete the following steps to choose the RAID level for the logical drive:  
1. Click the RAID level radio button to choose the RAID level for the logical  
drive. Only the most common choices appear in the list.  
2. To choose a different RAID level, click Advanced settings; then, choose a RAID  
level from the available options.  
70 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Note: Not all RAID levels are available on all controllers.  
In addition to RAID Level-1E, 5EE, 6 and x0, the ServeRAID  
Manager supports the following RAID types for the ServeRAID-8i,  
ServeRAID-8k/8k-l, and ServeRAID-7t controllers:  
3.  
v
v
Simple Volume - a single disk drive or segment; not redundant.  
Spanned Volume - two or more disk drives or segments with the same or  
different capacity, connected end-to-end. A spanned volume offers no  
redundancy or performance advantage over a single drive.  
v
RAID Volume - - two or more logical drives with the same RAID level,  
connected end-to-end. The logical drives may have the same or different  
capacity and are not striped together; they may be redundant, depending on  
the RAID level.  
Notes:  
a. You must create the individual logical drives before you create a  
RAID Volume. Use the Configuration wizard to create the logical  
drives; then, run the Configuration wizard again to create the  
RAID Volume.  
b. When you create a RAID Volume, the ServeRAID Manager  
replaces the individual logical drives with a single RAID Volume  
icon in the Logical devices view; then, it reports the logical drives  
as deleted in the event viewer. The event message is normal and  
does not indicate a loss of data.  
4. When you are ready to continue, click Next. The Create Logical Drives window  
opens.  
More information  
v
v
v
Creating logical drives  
Note: The ServeRAID-7t, ServeRAID-8i, and ServeRAID-8k/8k-l firmware supports  
a maximum of 10 logical slicesper physical drive.  
Complete the following steps to create logical drives:  
1. In the Physical devices view (on the right), click the drives you want the logical  
drive to use. To view available segments on each disk drive, switch to the  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Note: A segment shaded in light blue and outlined by a dashed line is not part  
of any logical drive.  
2. To select a hot-spare for the logical drive, or to deselect a hot-spare,  
control-click the drive.  
3. In the Name field, enter a name for the logical drive.  
4. If you do not want to use the maximum size for the logical drive, click  
Advanced settings; then, type the size in the Size (MB) field:  
For HostRAID controllers, the logical drive uses all of the space on each  
disk drive; you cannot adjust the logical drive size.  
5. To configure the logical drive for optimal performance, adjust the advanced  
settings as needed.  
Note: The default settings usually are adequate for most applications.  
6. If you have free space available and want to create additional logical drives,  
click  
; then, repeat steps 1-4.  
7. When you are ready to continue, click Next. The Configuration Summary  
window opens.  
More information  
v
Creating logical drives > advanced settings  
Note: Not all options are available for all RAID levels.  
Use the Advanced settings in the Configuration wizard to tune your logical drive  
configuration for optimal performance. You can set the following options:  
v
Write cache - Determines how data is stored in the controller’s cache memory.  
You can choose from two available settings: write-through and write-back.  
v
stripe-unit size - Determines the amount of data, in kilobytes (KB), written to  
one segment of a logical drive before the next segment is used for subsequent  
data. Depending on the controller, you can choose a stripe-unit size from 16 KB  
to 1024 KB.  
72 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notes:  
1. The default stripe size usually provides the best performance for  
typical applications.  
2. For RAID Level-6 and Level-60 logical drives, the number of choices  
for stripe-unit size decreases as the number of disks in the logical  
drive increases.  
v
v
Read cache - Enables and disables read caching. When read-caching is enabled,  
the controller monitors read access to the logical drive. If it detects a pattern, it  
pre-loads the cache with the data that seems most likely to be read next. The  
default is Enabled.  
Initialize method - Determines the method used to initialize the logical drive.  
You can choose from three available methods:  
Auto-synchronization - For RAID Level-1 logical drives, copies the data  
from the primary drive to the mirror drive. For RAID Level-5 logical drives,  
computes and writes the correct parity for the entire logical drive.  
Note: Auto-synchronization can be a lengthy operation. The ServeRAID  
Manager performs this task in the background. However, you cannot  
use the logical drive until the task is complete.  
Clear - removes pre-existing data by overwriting every block in the logical  
drive. This method is faster than auto-synchronization but the logical drive is  
not available immediately.  
For HostRAID controllers, the ServeRAID  
Manager supports the Clear initialization method only.  
Quick - makes the logical drive available immediately. It is the fastest  
method but should be used only for new physical disks.  
v
Initialize priority - Adjusts the priority of the initialization task. The default is  
High: initialize the logical drive as fast as possible.  
When you are ready to continue, click Next. The Configuration Summary window  
opens.  
More information  
v
v
v
Confirming your integrated RAID controller subsystem  
configuration  
Use the configuration summary to review all the changes that the ServeRAID  
Manager will apply to your configuration:  
1.  
Review the information that is displayed in the Configuration Summary  
window. To change the configuration, click Back.  
2. Click Apply; then, click Yes when asked if you want to apply the new  
configuration. The configuration is saved in the integrated RAID controller.  
Note: If you clicked Automatically initialize new logical drives, the ServeRAID  
Manager will initialize the logical drives automatically.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
More information  
v
v
Confirming your integrated RAID controller subsystem  
configuration  
Use the configuration summary to review all the changes that the ServeRAID  
Manager will apply to your configuration:  
1. Review the information that is displayed in the Configuration Summary  
window. To change the configuration, click  
.
Notes:  
a. Additional notes and attentions regarding the configuration appear  
b. Some operating systems have size limitations for logical drives.  
Before you save the configuration, verify that the size of the logical  
drive is appropriate for your operating system. For more detailed  
information, see your operating-system documentation.  
2. Click Apply; then, click Yes when asked if you want to apply the new  
configuration. The configuration is saved in the integrated RAID controller.  
Note: If you clicked Automatically initialize new logical drives, the ServeRAID  
Manager will initialize the logical drives automatically.  
More information  
v
v
Confirming your system configuration  
Use the configuration summary to review all the changes that the ServeRAID  
Manager will apply to your configuration:  
1. Review the information that is displayed in the Configuration Summary  
window. To change your Express configuration, click  
; to  
change your Custom configuration, click Back.  
Note: Additional notes and attentions regarding the configuration appear in  
2. Click Apply; then, click Yes when asked if you want to apply the new  
configuration. The configuration is saved in the ServeRAID controller and in  
the physical drives.  
Note: The ServeRAID Manager will initialize the logical drives automatically.  
The initialization method depends on the RAID level and controller type.  
3. After you configure your controller, you can change certain controller settings  
to fine-tune your configuration for optimal performance.  
Note: During Custom configuration, you can fine tune your configuration  
using the Advanced settings in the Configuration wizard.  
74 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Attention: After you apply the configuration, the logical drives will display as  
physical drives under your operating system. Before you can use these drives to  
store data, you must partition and format the drives using the disk management  
tools provided with your operating system. Each operating system provides its  
own disk management tools. For example, under Microsoft Windows, use the  
Computer Management tool to partition and format drives; then, assign each  
logical drive to a drive letter. For more information, see your operating system  
administrator’s guide.  
More information  
v
v
Selecting controllers to update  
To select the ServeRAID controllers or enclosures to update:  
1. In the tree, click the controller(s) or enclosure(s) you want to update. You can  
also choose the controllers or enclosures you want to omit from the update  
process.  
For direct-attached storage devices, all controllers of the same type are selected  
by default. If the controller or enclosure software is already up-to-date, it is  
grayed out. To remove a controller or enclosure from the selection, just click it.  
Note: To force a controller or enclosure to be updated, for example, if you want  
to down-level the software, press the Control key, then click the  
controller or enclosure.  
2. When you are ready to continue, click Next; the Update Summary window  
opens.  
Configuring ServeRAID enclosures  
Choosing the configuration path  
The Configuration wizard guides you through the configuration of your external  
storage enclosure. You can use the Configuation wizard to create arrays and logical  
drives for each controller in the enclosure. The Configuration wizard allows you to  
add drives to the array; choose the RAID level for each logical drive; choose an  
authentication method; and assign logical drives to users and machines (access  
control).  
Note:  
v The maximum number of arrays depends on the number of physical disks  
on the controller. You can configure one array per disk. Example: 4  
physical disks=4 arrays maximum.  
v You can create up to 64 logical drives per array.  
v You can create up to 512 logical drives for each controller.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(enclosure).  
2. Right-click Configure storage, or click  
in the Logical devices view. The  
Configuration wizard opens.  
3. In the Select a configuration option field, choose a configuration path. Click  
either:  
v Create a logical drive in a new array  
v Create a logical drive in existing array  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
4. If you choose to create a logical drive in an existing array, select the array name  
from the drop-down list.  
5. Click Next. For new arrays, the Create Arrays window opens. For existing  
arrays, the Create Logical Drives window opens.  
More information  
v
v
Creating arrays and hot-spare drives  
Complete the following steps to create arrays:  
1. Click the appropriate Array tab in the right pane:  
2. Then, from the list of ready drives, select the drives you want to add to the  
array:  
3. Click  
>> (Add selected drives) to add the drives to the array. You can  
click  
>> (Add all drives) to move all ready drives to an array.  
4. Repeat steps 1 and 2 for each additional array or hot-spare drive that you want  
to configure.  
5. If you do not want to create a spanned array, skip to step 5. Otherwise, select  
the Span arrays check box  
. Then, click Next. If you created two  
arrays only, the ServeRAID Manager uses those arrays to create the spanned  
array; continue to step 5. Otherwise, the Create Spanned Arrays window opens.  
Note: To create a spanned array, each array must have the same number of  
physical drives.  
6. After you select the ready drives for your arrays and hot-spare drive, click  
Next. The Create Logical Drives window opens.  
To return to the Configuration Path window, click Back. To leave the Configuration  
wizard, click Cancel.  
More information  
v
v
Creating spanned arrays  
If you want to assign RAID level-x0 to an array, you must create a spanned array.  
Complete the following steps to create one or more identical spanned arrays:  
1. In the list of arrays, click the arrays that you want to add to your spanned  
array.  
76 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2. Click  
can click  
>> (Add selected arrays) to add the arrays to the spanned array. You  
>> (Add all arrays) to move all arrays to the spanned arrays.  
3. To create additional spanned arrays, click the New spanned array tab in the  
right pane.  
Then, repeat steps 1 and 2.  
4. Click Next; the Create Logical Drives window opens.  
To return to the Create Arrays window, click Back. To leave the Configuration  
wizard, click Cancel.  
More information  
v
v
Creating logical drives  
Complete the following steps to create logical drives:  
1. Click the appropriate Array tab.  
2. Select a RAID level from the drop-down list.  
v If you are configuring a spanned array, you can set the RAID level only for  
the first logical drive you create.  
v In addtion to the standard RAID levels (0, 1, 5, x0), you can also create a  
simple volume: a single disk drive, non-redundant.  
3. If you do not want to use the maximum size for the logical drive, type the size  
in the Data (MB) field.  
Notes:  
a. Some operating systems have size limitations for logical drives.  
Before you save the configuration, verify that the size of the logical  
drive is appropriate for your operating system. For more detailed  
information, see your operating-system documentation.  
b. A logical drive cannot exceed 2048 GB (2 terabytes); the minimum  
size is 10MB.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
c. Typically, the first logical drive defined on the first controller found  
by system BIOS during startup will be your startup (boot) drive.  
d. The actual logical-drive size might be slightly different from what  
you select. The RAID level and the number of physical drives  
determine the size of the logical drive. For example, an array  
consisting of three, 1 GB physical drives with a requested RAID  
level-0 logical drive of 1000 MB will actually contain only 999 MB  
because the data is striped across all three drives, with 333 MB on  
each drive.  
4. From the Stripe Size drop-down list, select the stripe-unit for the logical drive.  
Note: The default stripe-unit size is usually adequate for most applications.  
5. From the Controller drop-down list, select the preferred owner for the logical  
drive, Controller A or Controller B. (For single controller configurations, this  
field is grayed out.)  
Note: You can only choose the controller for the first logical drive in the array.  
6. If you have free space available and want to create additional logical drives,  
click  
. To create a new logical drive with the same  
settings as the current logical drive, click  
; then, choose  
the number of replicas from the drop-down list.  
Attention: Use care when allocating space for new a new logical drive. You  
must leave enough space for FlashCopy backups to grow to their virtual size.  
For example, if the virtual size of a FlashCopy backup is 20 GB, you must leave  
at least 20 GB of free space in the array. Note that the Configuration wizard  
displays the actual size of the first FlashCopy backup (not the virtual size), and  
0 for all other FlashCopy backups.  
7. Repeat steps 2 through 6 for each logical drive that you want to define in this  
array.  
8. Repeat steps 1 through 7 for each additional array you want to configure.  
9. Click Next. Depending on the initiator type, the Define Authentication Method  
window opens or the Define Initiators window opens.  
To return to the Create Arrays window, click Back. To leave the Configuration  
wizard, click Cancel.  
Defining the authentication method  
Note: The ServeRAID Manager supports authentication for iSCSI initiators only.  
Use the Authentication Information window to define the authentication method  
(if any) for each user permitted to use the logical drives in the array. Optionally,  
you can enable Radius authentication (an external authentication service) and  
define the SLP (Service Location Protocol) Scope name.  
1. Select a logical drive from the list on the left.  
2. From the Authentication type list, select the method used to authenticate users  
of this logical drive. You can choose:  
v
None - Do not authenticate users  
CHAP - Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol  
v
78 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v
SRP - Secure Remote Password  
3. If you enabled authentication (by choosing CHAP or SRP), click  
; the  
Global User Name and Password Management window opens. Then, add users  
4. To enable Radius authentication for the CHAP authentication method, click  
Radius authentication; then, enter the following:  
v In the Primary server field, enter the host name or TCP/IP address of the  
authentication service; then, in the Port field, enter the server’s startup port.  
v In the Secondary server field, enter the host name or TCP/IP address of the  
authentication service; then, in the Port field, enter the server’s startup port.  
Note: Radius authentication is supported by the CHAP authentication method  
only.  
5. To modify the default SLP Scope name, click Advanced settings; then, in the  
SLP Scope Name field, type a unique scope name or choose an existing name  
from the drop-down list.  
6. Repeat steps 1 through 5 to enable authentication for additional logical drives.  
To replicate the settings for all logical drives, click  
.
7. When you are ready to continue, click Next. The Define Initiators window  
opens.  
To return to the Create Logical Drives window, click Back. To leave the  
Configuration wizard, click Cancel.  
More information  
v
Defining initiator information  
Use the Initiator Information window to define an alias, or friendlyname, for  
each initiator that can access the enclosure, including the initiator IQN (iSCSI  
Qualified Name) or fibre channel port name. An initiator represents a machine on  
the network that can access the enclosure.  
The ServeRAID Manager displays previously defined initiators in a list. The alias is  
shown on the left. Depending on the initiator type (iSCSI or fibre channel), the  
IQN or port name is shown on the right. Initiator types are not mixed. You can  
add a new initiator, modify an initiator, or delete an initiator.  
To add an initiator:  
1. Click  
. Depending on the initiator type, the Add iSCSI Initiator window opens or the  
Add Port Name window opens.  
3. When you are ready to continue, click Next. The Assign Logical Drives to  
Initiators window opens.  
To return to the previous Configuration Wizard window, click Back.  
To leave the Configuration wizard, click Cancel.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Adding an iSCSI initiator  
1. In the Initiator IQN field, type a well-formed IQN in the format:  
iqn.yyyy-mm.s1.s2[.|:]s3 where:  
v yyyy is the 4-digit year  
v mm is the 2-digit month (01-12)  
v s1 and s2 are 1-n character alphanumeric strings (for example, mydomain.com)  
v s3 is 5 or more alphanumeric characters, separated from s2 by ’.’ or ’:’  
2. In the Initiator alias filed, type a name for the initiator. The initiator alias must  
start with a letter. It can contain only letters and numbers.  
3. Optionally, click Advanced settings; then, click the check boxes to enable or  
disable the following features:  
Communications with initiator include  
separate status Protocol Data Unit (PDU).  
Communications with initiator include PDU  
alignment.  
Initiator supports iSCSI ping.  
Note: Refer to your initiator documentation for more information about these  
features.  
4. Click OK; then, repeat steps 1-3 to add additional initiators.  
5. Click Cancel to close the Add iSCSI Initiator window.  
Adding a fibre channel port name  
1. In the Port Name field, enter the 16-character Port Name. Each octet (8  
characters) can be separated by a ’:’ or ’-’.  
2. In the Initiator alias field, type a name for the initiator. The initiator alias must  
start with a letter. It can contain only letters and numbers.  
3. Click OK; then, repeat steps 1 and 2 to add additional initiators.  
Note: You can define a maximum of 255 ports (LUNs) for each fibre channel  
initiator.  
4. To automatically detect initiators on your network, click  
. The Select a Discovered Initiator window opens.  
Note: The button will be grayed out if no new initiators are detected.  
Then, select a discovered initiator from the list.  
5. Click Cancel to close the Add Port Name window.  
More information  
v
v
Selecting a discovered initiator  
Use the Select a Discovered Initiator window to add an existing fibre channel  
initiator to the list of initiators that can access the enclosure.  
80 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1.  
From the Port Name list, select an initiator.  
2. In the Initiator alias field, type a name for the initiator or accept the default.  
The initiator alias must start with a letter. It can contain only letters and  
numbers.  
3. Click OK. The Select a Discovered Initiator window closes.  
4. To select another discovered initiator, click  
. Then, repeat  
steps 1-3 to add additional initiators.  
5.  
Assigning logical drives to initiators  
Note: You can assign up to 32 initiators to each logical drive.  
Complete the following steps to assign logical drives to initiators:  
1. Click the appropriate Initiator tab in the right pane. To allow anyone to access  
the logical drive, regardless of users in the user list, click the Unrestricted tab.  
2. Then, from the list of logical drives, select the drives you want the initiator to  
access:  
3. Click  
initiator. You can click  
the initiator.  
>> (Add selected drives) to assign the logical drives to the  
>> (Add all drives) to assign all logical drives to  
4. Repeat steps 1 and 2 for each initiator.  
5. After you assign logical drives to initiators, click Next. The Configuration  
Summary window opens.  
To return to the Define Initiators window, click Back. To leave the Configuration  
wizard, click Cancel.  
Confirming your system configuration  
Use the configuration summary to review all the changes that the ServeRAID  
Manager will apply to your configuration:  
1. Review the information that is displayed in the Configuration Summary  
window. To change the configuration, click Back.  
Note: The Configuration wizard displays the actual size of the first FlashCopy  
backup (not its virtual size), and 0 for all other FlashCopy backups.  
2. Click Yes when asked if you want to apply the new configuration. A status  
window opens, displaying the progress of the operation. When finished, the  
configuration is saved in the controller and physical drives in the enclosure.  
Note: The ServeRAID Manager initializes the logical drives automatically.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
More information  
v
v
Configuring NetWare user authentication  
NetWare user authentication may be configured in one of two ways: out-of-box  
authentication and NDS authentication. The two methods are mutually exclusive.  
Out-of-box authentication  
Out-of-box authentication works as follows:  
v Administrative access is exclusively granted to the ‘Admin’ user account, which  
must be defined within the NetWare Bindery context of the server running the  
ServeRAID Manager agent.  
v User access is granted to all Bindery and NetWare Directory Services (NDS) user  
accounts. For NDS users, the user account must reside within the same tree as  
the server running the ServeRAID Manager agent.  
When logging into the ServeRAID Manager, NDS users must provide the fully  
distinguished account name.  
NDS authentication  
NDS authentication is based on NDS group membership. To set up NDS group  
membership, create and populate a NDS group for storage administration. After  
you install the ServeRAID Manager, edit the ServeRAID Manager agent properties  
file to restrict authentication to the new group.  
For example:  
1. Choose the group name .CN=StorageAdmins.O=Acme.  
Note: The group must reside within the same NDS tree as the server running  
the ServeRAID Manager agent.  
2. Using the Novell Administration utility, add the appropriate users to the new  
group.  
3. Add the following entry to the SYS:\RAIDMAN\RaidAgent.pps file:  
agent.group.NetWareStorageAdmin=< fully distinguished group name>The  
new entry should look like this :  
agent.group.NetWareStorageAdmin=.CN=StorageAdmins.O=Acme  
4. Restart the server.  
Limited user access is granted to all NDS user accounts.  
More information  
v
v
v
Novell NetWare considerations  
(NetWare 5.x only) If you are preparing to install Novell NetWare 5.x from the  
startable Novell NetWare 5.x CD, set the write-cache mode only to write-through  
mode.  
82 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Attention: Do not attempt a hot-replace operation on Windows 2000, Windows  
Server 2003, or NetWare by hot-removing a failed controller and then hot-adding a  
new controller. Loss of data can occur. If a controller fails on these operating  
systems, you must shut down the server to replace the controller.  
Copying the configuration from drives  
Note:  
1. This action is not supported on the integrated RAID controller.  
2. (Cluster environment only) Use this action to merge non-shared logical  
drives.  
Use this action to copy the configuration from all physical drives into a ServeRAID  
controller. This action is useful when replacing a controller and you want to  
reestablish the original configuration on the new controller.  
If you are replacing a controller in a cluster environment, you must first configure  
the cluster parameters by using the Configure for clusteringaction. The cluster  
parameters are the following:  
v The controller name  
v The partner controller name  
v The SCSI initiator IDs  
After you have configured these parameters, you can use Copy configuration  
from drivesto copy the configuration from only the non-shared drives into the  
new controller.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(controller).  
2. Right-click Copy configuration from drives.  
3. If clustering is not enabled, go to step 4. Otherwise, right-click one of the  
following from the menu:  
v
Non-shared 206  
Non-shared 207  
v
4. A confirmation window opens; click Yes.  
Restore the configuration to the factory-default settings  
Note: This action is not supported on the following:  
1. Integrated RAID controller  
2. ServeRAID-7t controller  
3. ServeRAID-8i controller  
4. ServeRAID-8k/8k-l controller  
5. HostRAID controller  
6. Network storage controllers  
Use this action to restore all parameters in the configuration to the factory-default  
settings:  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(controller).  
2. Right-click Restore to factory-default settings. A confirmation window opens.  
3. Click Yes.  
Attention: In the following step, the ServeRAID Manager will destroy all  
data on these logical drives.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
4. If there are logical drives defined, click Yes to delete all logical drives and  
restore all parameters in the configuration to the factory defaults. If there are  
no logical drives defined, the ServeRAID Manager automatically restores all  
parameters in the configuration to the factory-default settings.  
Saving a printable configuration and event logs  
Use this action to save a report of your configuration and event logs that you can  
print.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(server).  
2. Right-click ServeRAID Manager Actions Save printable configuration and  
event logs. The ServeRAID Manager creates one text file for each controller.  
The file name is Raid x.log where x is a number assigned to the file.  
Note: If you are in bootable-CD mode, you can save the files to a diskette in  
the A drive only.  
The ServeRAID Manager copies to each text file all configuration information for  
the following:  
v The controller in the selected system  
v Any physical drive on the controller  
v Any array on the controller  
v Any logical drive on the controller  
v Device event logs  
v defunct drive event logs  
v Software event logs  
v Hardware event logs  
The ServeRAID Manager saves all events currently in the event log, not only the  
events associated with the selected system.  
More information  
v
v
Saving a printable configuration  
Use this action to save a report of your configuration that you can print.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(system).  
2. Right-click Save printable configuration. The Save File window opens.  
3. Choose the directory and file name for your report. The default directory is the  
directory in which the ServeRAID Manager is installed. The default file name is  
RaidCfg.log.  
Note: If you are in bootable-CD mode, you can save to a diskette in the A  
drive only.  
The ServeRAID Manager copies to a text file all configuration information for the  
following:  
v Each controller in the selected system  
v All physical drives on the controller  
v All arrays on the controller  
v All logical drives on the controller  
84 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
More information  
v
v
Example: Printable configuration  
July 13, 2001 7:30:58 AM EDT  
Configuration summary  
---------------------------  
Server name.....................myserver  
ServeRAID Manager Version.......4.80.xx  
Number of controllers...........1  
Operating system................Windows 2000  
Information for controller 1  
-------------------------------------------------------  
Controller type.................ServeRAID-4Mx  
BIOS version....................4.80.xx  
Firmware version................4.80.xx  
Device driver version...........4.80.xx  
Physical slot...................4  
Battery-backup cache............Installed  
Read-ahead cache mode...........Adaptive  
stripe-unit size................8K  
Rebuild rate....................High  
Hot-swap rebuild................Enabled  
Data scrubbing..................Enabled  
Auto-synchronization............Enabled  
Clustering......................Disabled  
Unattended mode.................Disabled  
BIOS compatibility mapping......Extended  
Number of arrays................2  
Number of logical drives........2  
Number of hot-spare drives......0  
Number of ready drives..........0  
Array A  
--------------------  
Array identifier................A  
Array size in MB................4157  
Free space in MB................0  
Number of logical drives........1  
Stripe order (Channel/Device)...1/4  
Number of physical drives.......1  
Logical drives in array A  
--------------------------------  
Logical drive...................1  
Array letter....................A  
State...........................Okay  
RAID level......................0  
Data space in MB................4157  
Parity space in MB..............0  
Date created....................7/13/01  
Write-cache mode................Write back  
Merge group number..............207  
Merge group state...............Non-shared  
Physical drives in array A  
--------------------------------  
Type............................Hard disk drive  
Channel.........................1  
SCSI ID.........................4  
Vendor..........................IBM_PSG  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Product or model number.........xxxxxxxx  
Serial number...................xxxxxxxx  
Firmware level..................1.00  
Size in MB......................4157  
State...........................Online  
Array letter....................A  
PFA error.......................No  
Array B  
--------------------  
Array identifier................B  
Array size in MB................6143  
Free space in MB................2  
Number of logical drives........1  
Stripe order (Channel/Device)...1/0 1/1 1/2  
Number of physical drives.......3  
Logical drives in array B  
--------------------------------  
Logical drive...................2  
Array letter....................B  
State...........................Okay  
RAID level......................5  
Data space in MB................4094  
Parity space in MB..............2047  
Date created....................7/13/01  
Write-cache mode................Write back  
Merge group number..............207  
Merge group state...............Non-shared  
Physical drives in array B  
--------------------------------  
Type............................Hard disk drive  
Channel.........................1  
SCSI ID.........................0  
Vendor..........................IBM_PSG  
Product or model number.........xxxxxxx  
Serial number...................xxxxxxx  
Firmware level..................1.00  
Size in MB......................2047  
State...........................Online  
Array letter....................B  
PFA error.......................No  
Type............................Hard disk drive  
Channel.........................1  
SCSI ID.........................1  
Vendor..........................IBM_PSG  
Product or model number.........xxxxxxx  
Serial number...................xxxxxxx  
Firmware level..................1.00  
Size in MB......................2047  
State...........................Online  
Array letter....................B  
PFA error.......................No  
Type............................Hard disk drive  
Channel.........................1  
SCSI ID.........................2  
Vendor..........................IBM_PSG  
Product or model number.........xxxxxxx  
Serial number...................xxxxxxx  
Firmware level..................1.00  
Size in MB......................2047  
State...........................Online  
Array letter....................B  
86 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PFA error.......................No  
SCSI channel 1  
-------------------  
Type............................Hard disk drive  
Channel.........................1  
SCSI ID.........................0  
Vendor..........................IBM_PSG  
Product or model number.........xxxxxxx  
Serial number...................xxxxxxx  
Firmware level..................1.00  
Size in MB......................2047  
State...........................Online  
Array letter....................B  
PFA error.......................No  
Type............................Hard disk drive  
Channel.........................1  
SCSI ID.........................1  
Vendor..........................IBM_PSG  
Product or model number.........xxxxxxx  
Serial number...................xxxxxxx  
Firmware level..................1.00  
Size in MB......................2047  
State...........................Online  
Array letter....................B  
PFA error.......................No  
Type............................Hard disk drive  
Channel.........................1  
SCSI ID.........................2  
Vendor..........................IBM_PSG  
Product or model number.........xxxxxxx  
Serial number...................xxxxxxx  
Firmware level..................1.00  
Size in MB......................2047  
State...........................Online  
Array letter....................B  
PFA error.......................No  
Type............................Hard disk drive  
Channel.........................1  
SCSI ID.........................4  
Vendor..........................IBM_PSG  
Product or model number.........xxxxxxx  
Serial number...................xxxxxxx  
Firmware level..................1.00  
Size in MB......................4157  
State...........................Online  
Array letter....................A  
PFA error.......................No  
Type............................Enclosure  
Channel.........................1  
SCSI ID.........................14  
Vendor..........................SDR  
Product or model number.........GEM200  
Serial number...................0  
Firmware level..................2  
SCSI channel 2  
-------------------  
End of the configuration information for controller 1  
-------------------------------------------------------  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
More information  
v
v
Working with systems in the ServeRAID Manager  
You can use the ServeRAID Manager to view information about managed systems,  
ServeRAID controllers, and the ServeRAID Manager subsystem (such as arrays,  
logical drives, hot-spare drives, and physical drives).  
To view information, click an object in the Enterprise view or the Physical or  
(Properties) on the toolbar. Using  
preferences, you can sort tree objects alphabetically or chronologically.  
Note: The local system always appears first when you sort the tree alphabetically.  
To display available actions for an item, right-click the item in the Enterprise view,  
Physical devices view, or Logical devices view.  
You can use the following actions and applications in the ServeRAID Manager to  
modify or monitor other ServeRAID Manager systems in a network:  
v
v
v
v
v
Add or remove a remote system  
To configure a new ServeRAID controller with the Configuration wizard, click  
(Create) on the toolbar or  
(Create) in the Logical devices view.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
v
Using the ServeRAID Manager interface > Menubar  
In addition to using the mouse, you can use keyboard shortcuts to access the  
menubar. Selections from the Actions menu also are available when you right-click  
an object in the Enterprise view, Physical devices view, and Logical devices view.  
Note: No actions from the Actions menu are available during any of the following  
operations:  
v Rebuild  
v Foreground synchronization  
v Verification  
v Logical-drive migration  
v RAID level-5E compression or decompression  
v RAID level-5EE compaction or expansion  
88 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v FlashCopy with backup option  
v Copy back  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
v
The ServeRAID Manager menu bar: The ServeRAID Manager menu bar has the  
following functions:  
File >  
Clears the current contents of the event viewer. This option does  
not clear or delete the event logging file.  
Preferences  
Opens a window that you can use to specify the following settings:  
Close help  
Closes the Help window  
Exit  
Exits the ServeRAID Manager.  
View >  
Toolbar  
Turns the toolbar on and off. The default is on (that is, selected).  
Status bar  
Turns the status bar on and off. The default is on (that is, selected).  
Tool tips  
Turns the tool tips on and off. The default is on (that is, selected).  
Refresh  
Refreshes the display with the latest configuration information.  
Remote >  
Adds a remote system to the Enterprise view for monitoring and  
configuration. This action is disabled in bootable-CD mode and  
when the ServeRAID Manager is a plug-in to another program.  
Displays a menu of all the remote systems currently in your  
Enterprise view. You can select one remote system to remove at a  
time. This action is disabled in bootable-CD mode and when the  
ServeRAID Manager is a plug-in to another program.  
Actions >  
Display any action that is valid for the selected object in the Enterprise  
view, the Physical devices view, or Logical devices view.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Note: If there are no valid actions for the object you selected, the Actions  
menu is grayed out.  
Help >  
Information about this window  
View context-sensitive information for the current window.  
Search  
Searches for one or more specified words in ServeRAID Assist and  
displays a list of topics that include the words.  
Contents  
Presents the ServeRAID Assist contents. You can use the contents  
to acquaint yourself with ServeRAID Assist topics.  
General Concepts  
Presents ServeRAID concepts that you use with the ServeRAID  
Manager.  
Publications  
Lists IBM publications and where to find them.  
IBM online support  
Lists IBM Web sites and available online support.  
What’s new  
Lists the new features in this version of the ServeRAID Manager  
program.  
About ServeRAID Manager  
Reports the ServeRAID Manager version number, copyright, and  
legal information.  
The ServeRAID Manager toolbar: The ServeRAID Manager toolbar has the  
following functions:  
Add a remote system to the Enterprise view for monitoring and configuration.  
Note: This action is not supported when using the following:  
v ServeRAID Manager in bootable-CD mode  
v ServeRAID Manager as a plug-in application  
Create a logical drive with the Configuration wizard. Choose Express or Custom  
configuration, if there are ready drives and you have not assigned the maximum  
number of logical drives.  
Silence  
Silence the console alarm and agent alarm on all connected systems. All Warning  
and Error events produce an audible alarm every five minutes, notifying you of  
the event. You can adjust the alarm interval in the Preferences window.  
90 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Properties  
When a system, controller, or device is selected, displays system, controller, or  
device properties.  
Events  
Open the event log in a stand-alone viewer. The stand-alone viewer shows all  
ServeRAID Manager events. Use the embedded event viewer to view events for  
the current ServeRAID Manager session.  
Configure  
List tools for configuring the local or remote ServeRAID Manager agent or  
management station agent. To use a tool, select it from the drop-down list.  
Help  
View context-sensitive information for the current window.  
Using the ServeRAID Manager interface > Toolbar: The toolbar provides  
quick-access icons for common tasks.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
Using the ServeRAID Manager interface > Enterprise view: The Enterprise view  
provides an expandable treeview of the systems, controllers, and enclosures you  
are managing. It is divided into two parts:  
v Direct attached storage - managed systems with directly attached controllers  
and storage devices.  
v Networked storage - management stations with network-attached storage  
enclosures.  
You can perform most configuration and management tasks by selecting a  
controller or enclosure from the tree and working with related objects in the  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tip: You can use display groups to group related systems under single tree object.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
Using the ServeRAID Manager interface > Physical and Logical device views:  
The Physical and Logical device views show the physical devices and logical  
devices connected to the controller or enclosure.  
The Physical devices view (on the left) displays information about the drives,  
enclosures, and other devices attached to the controller. The devices are shown  
organized by the channel or port they are connected to and shown in numerical  
order. The display for each channel or port includes information on maximum  
speed capability, the number of the channel on the controller, and the number of  
devices attached to the controller.  
The Logical devices view (on the right) displays information about the arrays and  
logical drives created using the physical devices. This information includes the  
number of arrays and logical drives, the RAID level of each device, and whether a  
logical drive is protected by a hot spare drive.  
To view device information, click  
in the Enterprise view to expand a managed  
system or management station. Then, select a controller or enclosure from the tree.  
For network storage, the Physical devices view also shows the controllers in the  
enclosure. All other information is the same.  
92 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tip: You can drag the bar between the Physical devices view and Logical devices  
view to adjust the size of each pane.  
In the Physical devices view, four indicators report status of the fan, battery,  
temperature, and power modules on SAF-TE (enclosure management) devices and  
other devices that monitor these conditions. The indicator is blue for normal,  
yellow for warning, and red for error; the indicator is grayed out if none of the  
devices on the controller monitor the condition. Example: the fan indicator changes  
to yellow when one fan fails; it changes to red when a second fan fails and cooling  
is no longer adequate.  
In the Logical devices view, use the buttons to create and delete arrays and logical  
drives. The Create option (  
create a new array.  
) opens a wizard that presents the steps necessary to  
Other buttons in the Logical devices view allow you to:  
v
v
v
You can also create and delete hot-spare drives.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
Using the ServeRAID Manager interface > Event viewer: The event viewer  
provides advisory and progressive-status information and messages for your  
ServeRAID Manager system. Every event includes a severity icon, a date and time  
stamp, the host name where the event originated, and a description.  
Note: All Warning and Error events cause an audible alarm to sound, notifying  
you of the event.  
You can double-click an event in the event viewer and the Configuration Event  
Detail window opens. This window contains the same information as the event  
viewer, but in a larger, easier-to-read window. Some events have additional details  
listed in this window.  
If the ServeRAID Manager is not in bootable-CD mode, it appends each event to a  
log file, RAIDEVT.LOG. If this file exceeds 200 KB, the ServeRAID Manager copies  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
the file to RAIDEVT.OLD and creates a new RAIDEVT.LOG. If there is a  
RAIDEVT.OLD already, the ServeRAID Manager overwrites it.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
Using the ServeRAID Manager interface > Status bar: The status bar displays  
the following information from left to right. You can drag the vertical bars to the  
right and left to adjust the size of the viewing areas.  
Managed systems status icon. This icon is the same as the Managed systems  
icon displayed in the Enterprise view. The text next to the icon states whether the  
ServeRAID Manager has detected problems on any of the systems. You can see the  
text by dragging the vertical bar to the right.  
Tree path. Reports the tree path location of the selected object.  
Progress indicator (ServeRAID legacy controllers only). A labeled progress  
indicator is displayed in this pane if the currently selected system has one or more  
controllers containing a logical drive undergoing any of the following operations:  
v Rebuild  
v Migration  
v Synchronization (either foreground or background)  
v Compression or decompression (RAID level-5E only)  
v Compaction or expansion (RAID level-5EE only)  
v FlashCopy  
v Copy back  
For ServeRAID-8i, ServeRAID-8k/8k-l, ServeRAID-7t, and  
HostRAID controllers, the ServeRAID Manager displays  
Logical devices view, instead of the progress indicator.  
(in animation) in the  
If no action is in progress, this pane is empty. The progress indicator is labeled  
with the controller number and logical drive number. If more than one controller is  
undergoing one of these operations, the progress of the selected controller is  
displayed in the pane.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
Physical and Logical device views > Icons, buttons, and status indicators: The  
ServeRAID Manager displays the following icons, buttons, and status indicators in  
94 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
the Physical and Logical device views, representing the physical and logical  
devices in your system, their status, and the actions you can take to manage them.  
Icons  
Controller card  
Array with no free space  
Enclosure management device  
Array with free space  
Enclosure  
Logical drive  
Ready hard drive  
Logical drive with hot spare  
Hard drive with no free space  
Creating/modifying array or logical drive  
Hard drive with free space  
Initialize logical drive  
Hot spare drive protecting logical drive  
FlashCopy backup  
Hot spare drive not protecting logical drive  
CD-ROM drive  
defunct drive  
Removable drive  
Tape drive  
Buttons  
Use the following buttons to view physical and logical device information and to  
create and delete arrays and hot spares.  
To view physical device information in enclosure view format (visible only if  
system has an attached storage enclosure)  
To view physical device information in text format  
To view physical device information in full size capacity format  
To view physical device information in relative size capacity format  
To create or delete a hot spare drive  
To create an array or logical drive  
To delete an array or logical drive  
To expand and contract information in the Enterprise view  
To expand and contract physical and logical device information  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Status indicators  
Use the following indicators to monitor the status of controllers and SAF-TE  
enclosure management devices in your system.  
To monitor status of the fan module  
To monitor status of the battery module  
To monitor temperature status  
To monitor status of the power module  
More information  
v
v
v
Physical and Logical device views > Collapsed and expanded views: In addition  
to changing the way physical device information is displayed in the Physical  
devices view (either textual or graphical), you can also view a collapsed or  
expanded view of the system configuration information. Initially, the ServeRAID  
Manager displays a collapsed textual view of the configuration information in both  
the Logical devices view and Physical devices view.  
Click to expand and collapse information  
about arrays and logical drives. The  
expanded display shows the following  
information about each logical device:  
v Array name and capacity (if available)  
v Logical drive size  
In Logical devices view  
v Logical drive state  
v Build progress  
Click to expand and collapse information  
about physical drives. The expanded display  
shows the following information about each  
drive:  
In Physical devices view  
v Capacity of the drive  
v Drive ID  
v Drive state  
More information  
v
v
v
Physical and Logical device views > Physical device view options: You can  
choose the way information is displayed in the Physical devices view. To choose a  
view option, click the associated button in the Logical devices view.  
96 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Displays physical device information in text format. This is the default view for  
controllers with direct attached storage devices.  
Displays physical device information in full size capacity format. A full-length  
bar is displayed for each drive, regardless of capacity. A small segment on each  
drive is reserved for the RAID signature; this area is indicated by a gray capat  
the end of each bar.  
Note: A drive shaded in light blue is not part of any array.  
Displays physical device information in relative size capacity format. A full  
length bar is displayed for the largest drive. Proportionally shorter bars are  
displayed for other drives.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Displays physical device information in enclosure view format. Drives in the  
enclosure are shown in the physical slots they occupy with the proper vertical or  
horizontal orientation. Empty slots are shown as drive outlines. This is the  
default view for systems with an attached storage enclosure.  
For network storage, enclosure view also shows the controllers in the enclosure.  
Attention: The enclosure view button is visible in the Logical devices view  
only if an enclosure is attached to the system. HostRAID controllers do not  
support enclosure view. Nor do some older enclosures.  
More information  
v
v
v
Physical and Logical device views > Component views: When you click either a  
physical or logical device in the device views, the related components are  
highlighted in the other view.  
When you click an array, the associated logical drives are highlighted in the  
Logical devices view and the physical drives that are members of the array are  
highlighted in the Physical devices view.  
When you click a hot spare drive, the logical drives protected by that spare are  
highlighted.  
98 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
In the graphical views, if the logical drive uses only part of the available storage,  
only those segments are highlighted, using the following color code:  
dark blue - storage used by selected logical drive  
brown - storage used by other logical drives  
light blue - free space (not used by any logical drive)  
gray - space reserved for RAID signature  
Note: Partially filled hard drive  
and array  
icons indicate that the device  
has free space.  
More information  
v
v
v
Sending a test trap from the SNMP Trap Manager  
Use this action to send a test trap to a remote system.  
1. Click a system in the SNMP traps list.  
Note: This action is disabled if you do not select a system.  
2. Click Actions Send test trap.  
Note: The SNMP Trap Manager cannot verify that the trap was received  
successfully. You must verify that the trap was received on the remote  
system. If the test fails, verify the following and try the test send again:  
1. You typed the correct TCP/IP information when you added the system  
to the traps list.  
2. The SNMP console is running on the remote system.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
More information  
v
v
v
v
Working with objects in the Enterprise view and device views  
Use objects in the Enterprise view and the Physical and Logical device views to  
review information and to change or manage the ServeRAID configuration.  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Direct attached storage object: Use this object, in the Enterprise view, to work  
with managed systems with direct attached storage devices or to display their  
properties. When you click this object, the ServeRAID Manager displays a  
summary of managed systems in the Direct attached storage view.  
Possible subobject  
v
v
Warning and error conditions  
(warning) is displayed if any system has a warning or error condition.  
v
Actions  
Adding a remote system:  
Note: This action is not supported when using the following:  
v ServeRAID Manager in bootable-CD mode  
v ServeRAID Manager as a plug-in application  
100 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Use this action to connect to a remote system or management station and add it to  
the Enterprise view.  
Tip: Before adding a remote system, verify that the system is running the required  
software. To add a remote system with direct-attached storage, the ServeRAID  
Manager must be running on that system. To add a management station with  
a network-attached storage enclosure, the ServeRAID Manager management  
station software must be running on that system.  
1. From the Remote menu, select Remote Add or click  
(Add) on the  
toolbar. The Add managed system window opens.  
2. From the Type drop-down list, select:  
v
v
Managed System, to add a remote system with direct-attached storage  
Management Station, to add a remote management station with a  
network-attached storage enclosure  
3. Type the remote host name or TCP/IP address.  
4. (Managed system only) Type the remote system startup port number. The  
default port number is 34571.  
5. Type your user name and password.  
Note: The password is case sensitive.  
6. If you want to save the user name and password, select the Save user  
name/Password box. Once you successfully connect to the remote system, the  
ServeRAID Manager stores this information in a file along with the host name  
so you do not have to type your user name and password every time you run  
the ServeRAID Manager.  
7. Click Connect.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
Failing to add a remote system: If you fail to connect to the remote system, the  
ServeRAID Manager displays an error message and does not add the remote  
system to the Enterprise view. If the ServeRAID Manager fails to connect, verify  
the following:  
v The ServeRAID Manager is running on the remote system.  
v The remote system is using a compatible version of the ServeRAID Manager.  
v The remote system has TCP/IP installed.  
v You supplied the correct user name and password, if security is enabled on the  
remote system.  
v The remote system is turned on.  
v The host name is defined in the Domain Name Server or a Hosts file, if you are  
trying to connect using a host name.  
v The remote session is running on the appropriate port.  
More information  
v
Successfully adding a remote system: When you successfully add a remote system,  
the ServeRAID Manager updates the Enterprise view with the newly added  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
system. The next time you start the ServeRAID Manager, it automatically loads the  
systems into the Enterprise view. When you click one of these systems, the  
ServeRAID Manager either:  
v Opens the Add Managed System window and prompts for the security  
information, if the remote ServeRAID Manager has security enabled and you did  
not save the user name and password.  
v Connects to the system and retrieves the system information, if you saved the  
user name and password, or security is disabled.  
More information  
v
Specifying remote access settings:  
Note: This action is not supported when using the following:  
v ServeRAID Manager in bootable-CD mode  
v ServeRAID Manager as a plug-in application  
Local-only mode  
Complete the following steps to run the ServeRAID Manager in local-only mode:  
1. In the User Preferences window, click the Remote access settings tab.  
2. Select the Local only box.  
3. Click OK.  
4. Restart the ServeRAID Manager for this setting to take effect.  
The next time you start the ServeRAID Manager, TCP/IP networking will be  
disabled. In local-only mode, you cannot monitor any remote systems and no  
remote systems can monitor your system.  
Networking mode  
Complete the following steps to run the ServeRAID Manager in networking mode:  
1. In the User Preferences window, click the Remote access settings tab.  
2. If the Local only box is selected, deselect it.  
3. Click OK.  
4. Restart the ServeRAID Manager for this setting to take effect.  
Note: The default port numbers for remote access are 34571-34574. If you have a  
conflict with these numbers, you must configure the agent to use different  
ports.  
More information  
v
v
v
Removing a remote system:  
Note: This action is not supported when using the following:  
v ServeRAID Manager in bootable-CD mode  
v ServeRAID Manager as a plug-in application  
102 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Removing a remote system does not take a remote system offline, but only  
removes it from the ServeRAID Manager Enterprise view.  
1. From the Remote menu, click either:  
v
Remote Remove managed system and then the system name, to remove a  
remote system with direct-attached storage  
v
v
Remote Remove management station and then the system name, to  
remove a remote management station with network storage  
2. If you are removing a remote system with direct-attached storage, the Remove  
Managed System window opens; continue to step 2. Otherwise, skip to step 3.  
3. If you want to continue receiving events from the remote system after having  
removed it, click Continue to receive events from the remote systemfrom the  
drop-down list.  
4. Click OK.  
More information  
v
v
v
System object: Use this object, in the Enterprise view, to work with a local or  
remote system, or to display its properties.  
If a system object is gray, the ServeRAID agent is not available on that system.  
Note: The ServeRAID software supports a maximum of 16 ServeRAID controllers.  
Possible subobject  
v
v
Warning and error conditions  
(warning) is displayed if any controller in the system has any problem.  
v
Actions  
Note: Not all actions are supported on all controllers.  
v If the system is remote, remove remote system.  
v Agent actions:  
– Configure (not available in bootable-CD mode):  
-
-
-
-
v
v ServeRAID actions:  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v
v
Display group object: Use this object, in the Enterprise view, to work with a  
Possible subobject  
v
v
Warning and error conditions  
(warning) is displayed if any system in the display group has any problem.  
v
Actions  
v
v
ServeRAID controller object: Use this object, in the Enterprise view, to work with  
ServeRAID controllers and related objects in the Physical and Logical device views,  
or to display controller properties.  
Possible subobject  
v
v
v
v
Warning and error conditions  
v
(warning) is displayed for the following conditions:  
– Any subobject of the controller has any warning or error conditions.  
– The controller has a battery-backup cache problem.  
(error) is displayed for the following conditions:  
– The controller has failed.  
v
– The controller has a bad configuration.  
Actions  
Note: Not all actions are supported on all controllers.  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
104 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v Clustering actions  
v
The following actions are available only on the ServeRAID-7t, ServeRAID-8i,  
ServeRAID-8k/8k-l, and network-attached storage enclosures:  
v
v
The following actions are available only in bootable-CD mode:  
v
v
v
v
v
Integrated RAID controller object: Use this object, in the Enterprise view, to  
work with integrated RAID controllers and their subobjects or to display their  
properties.  
The integrated RAID controller is displayed in the ServeRAID Manager Enterprise  
view as two controller objects. However, you can configure only one array and  
RAID level-1 logical drive on an integrated RAID controller. The controller  
information in the tree lists the controller type as LSI 1030.  
Note:  
1. The integrated RAID controller provides limited function compared to  
ServeRAID controllers.  
2. The ServeRAID Manager can display a maximum of four LSI 1030  
controller objects in a system.  
3. Under Windows, LSI 1030 controller objects are not visible unless devices  
are attached to one of the LSI 1030 controller channels. If devices are  
attached to only one channel then only one controller object will be  
visible.  
Possible subobject  
v
v
v
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Warning and error conditions  
v
(warning) is displayed for the following conditions:  
– Any subobject of the controller has any warning or error conditions.  
(error) is displayed for the following conditions:  
– The controller has failed.  
v
– The controller has a bad configuration.  
Actions  
v
The following actions are available only in bootable-CD mode:  
v
v
v
Enabling and disabling unattended mode:  
Note: This action is supported in bootable-CD mode only.  
Use this action to change the unattended-mode setting. This setting determines  
how the ServeRAID Manager startup code (BIOS) handles failures during a system  
startup. The default is Disabled.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(controller).  
2. Right-click Enable or Disable unattended mode.  
3. Click Yes to confirm.  
More information  
v
Identifying devices: You can identify the devices in a server or enclosure, such as a  
physical drive, because the light associated with the device you selected is flashing.  
1. Click any object in the Physical devices view or Logical devices view, except  
the following:  
(Controller)  
(CD-ROM drive)  
(Tape drive)  
(Removable-media drive)  
2. Right-click the appropriate Identify.  
The ServeRAID Manager sends a command to the firmware (microcode) to  
start flashing one or more physical drive or enclosure lights, depending on the  
following:  
v The selected object  
v Whether the item and its subsystems are all controlled by an enclosure  
device  
Note: Identify works only on controllers with a SAF-TE processor and the  
appropriate firmware. If a device light or a series of device lights do not  
flash, it is because all or part of the subsystem is not controlled by a  
SAF-TE processor.  
106 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3. Click OK to stop the drive lights from flashing.  
More information  
v
v
Using Identify to work with your systems: When you click Identify for an object in  
the Physical devices view or Logical devices view, the ServeRAID Manager makes  
the hardware light associated with the selected object flash.  
Depending on what you clicked, you can identify the following:  
v A drive  
v All drives  
v A channel of drives  
v A logical drive  
v All logical drives  
v An array  
v A spanned array  
v All arrays  
v An enclosure  
You can make only one selection at a time. The hardware will continue flashing  
until you click OK in the message window.  
Identify works only on controllers with a SAF-TE processor and the appropriate  
firmware. The processor uses a SCSI ID; therefore, it is displayed in the Physical  
devices view as the following:  
Enclosure management device  
If a device light or a series of device lights do not flash, it is because all or part of  
the subsystem is not controlled by a SAF-TE processor.  
For example, if SCSI channel 1 has a SAF-TE processor, but SCSI channel 3 does  
not, and you select to Identify all physical drives, only SCSI channel 1 will flash.  
Identify is particularly useful for enclosures. You can use Identify to clarify which  
drives in the enclosure you need to work with, before you pull them out of the  
enclosure.  
If a SAF-TE processor is present and the controller supports device identification,  
you can identify the components by doing the following:  
Right-click:  
To Identify...  
Enclosure management device  
Enclosure  
The enclosure itself  
All physical drives in the enclosure  
All physical drives in the selected array or  
spanned array  
Array [number]  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Right-click:  
To Identify...  
All physical drives in the selected logical  
drive  
Logical drive [number]  
Physical drive [number]  
The selected physical drive.  
All physical drives in all arrays  
All physical drives in all logical drives  
All physical drives on the selected channel  
All physical drives on the selected ports  
More information  
v
v
IBM ServeRAID SCSI controllers: You can use the IBM ServeRAID Manager with  
the following:  
v IBM ServeRAID-7K Ultra320 SCSI controller  
v IBM ServeRAID-6i/6i+ Ultra320 SCSI controller  
v IBM ServeRAID-6M Ultra320 SCSI controller  
v IBM ServeRAID-5i Ultra320 SCSI controller  
v IBM ServeRAID-4H Ultra160 SCSI controller  
v IBM ServeRAID-4Mx Ultra160 SCSI controller  
v IBM ServeRAID-4Lx Ultra160 SCSI controller  
v IBM ServeRAID-4M Ultra160 SCSI controller  
v IBM ServeRAID-4L Ultra160 SCSI controller  
v IBM ServeRAID-3HB Ultra2 SCSI controller  
v IBM ServeRAID-3H Ultra2 SCSI controller  
v IBM ServeRAID-3L Ultra2 SCSI controller  
v IBM ServeRAID-II Ultra SCSI controller  
v IBM ServeRAID SCSI controller  
More information  
v
v
v
v
Integrated RAID controller: The integrated RAID controller (such as an LSI 1030) is  
a standard feature on some IBM xSeries servers. This controller has limited RAID  
capabilities. With an integrated RAID controller, you can use the ServeRAID  
Manager to:  
v Configure two physical drives into a logical drive and assign it RAID level-1.  
v Configure a ready physical drive as a hot-spare drive.  
108 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v Monitor the physical drives for PFA errors.  
v Set drive status lights for a failed physical drive or PFA error.  
The integrated RAID controller is displayed in the ServeRAID Manager Enterprise  
view as two controller objects. However, you can configure only one array and  
RAID level-1 logical drive on an integrated RAID controller. The controller  
information in the tree lists the controller type as LSI 1030.  
Attention: If you choose to install a ServeRAID controller in the server, you  
cannot migrate the data from an array configured on the integrated RAID  
controller to an array configured on the ServeRAID controller.  
For additional information about the integrated RAID controller, see the  
installation instructions and CDs provided with your IBM xSeries server.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
Configuring the ServeRAID controller for clustering:  
Note: This action is not supported when using the following:  
v
Integrated RAID controller  
v ServeRAID-5i controller  
v ServeRAID-6i/6i+ controller  
v ServeRAID-7k controller  
v ServeRAID-7t controller  
v ServeRAID-8i controller  
v ServeRAID-8k/8k-l controller  
v HostRAID controller  
Use this action to configure and view ServeRAID settings for clustering computers  
or using high-availability.  
The ServeRAID Manager configures the controller name, partner controller name,  
and SCSI initiator IDs in bootable-CD mode only; otherwise, you can view only  
this information .  
You can configure merge-group numbers for a logical drive that you have created  
during the current session of the ServeRAID Manager. If you have exited from the  
ServeRAID Manager since you created the logical drive, you cannot configure  
merge-group numbers for it. You must use the ServeRAID Manager in startable-CD  
mode to change merge-group numbers for logical drives that are not new.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(controller).  
2. Right-click Clustering actions Configure for clustering.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3. Enter the controller name and partner controller name. You can specify a name  
up to 12 characters. When you enter the partner controller name, the  
merge-group information displays in the window.  
Note: Names are case sensitive.  
4. Select the SCSI initiator IDs which can be 6 or 7.  
Note: The SCSI initiator IDs must be unique from the partner controller  
initiator IDs. The default is 7.  
5. If you want a logical drive to merge to another controller if this controller fails,  
select the Shared box. Otherwise, if you do not want a logical drive to merge to  
another controller, select the Non-shared box.  
Note:  
a. Non-shared is the default for all logical drives. The merge-group  
number is defined as [200 + the SCSI initiator ID]. You cannot change  
the merge-group number for a non-shared logical drive.  
b. If a logical drive is defined as shared, all physical drives in the  
logical drive must be on a shared channel.  
6. Enter a merge-group number for the shared logical drive. This merge-group  
number must be unique from the partner controller (that is, the merge-group  
number for any logical drive belonging to the partner controller cannot be the  
same merge-group number).  
Note: The default merge-group number is the logical-drive number.  
7. Once you have configured both controllers for clustering, you can click View  
shared drives to view the physical drives owned by a partner controller.  
More information  
v
Validating a cluster:  
Note: This action is not supported when using the following:  
v ServeRAID Manager in bootable-CD mode  
v ServeRAID Manager as a plug-in application  
v Integrated RAID controller  
v ServeRAID-5i controller  
v ServeRAID-6i/6i+ controller  
v ServeRAID-7t controller  
v ServeRAID-8i controller  
v ServeRAID-8k/8k-l controller  
v HostRAID controller  
Note: You must have the ServeRAID Manager installed and running on all servers  
in the cluster for this feature to work. You must run the Validate cluster  
feature from one of two nodes in the cluster; you cannot run it remotely.  
Use this action to determine if your cluster configuration is configured correctly.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(local system only).  
2. Right-click ServeRAID actions Validate cluster. The Validate Cluster window  
opens. The system you selected in step 1 is listed in the Node A box.  
110 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Note: You cannot change the Node A system in the Validate Cluster window.  
To select a different system, click Cancel to return to the tree.  
3. Select your second system from the Node B drop-down list.  
Note: The Node B system defaults to the first system in the Enterprise view  
other than the Node A system. If there are no remote systems in the  
Enterprise view, click Cancel to return to the Enterprise view and add a  
4. Click Start. The ServeRAID Manager scans both systems to verify the  
configuration.  
5. If you want to stop the validation before it is completed, click Cancel.  
Otherwise, if the ServeRAID Manager found problems with the configuration,  
it reports the problems in the message field. If there are no problems with the  
configuration, the message field reports only the cluster pairings found.  
6. To view the problem report events in an easy-to-read window, double-click an  
event in the message field.  
7. To save the contents of the message field, click Save. A Save As window opens.  
8. Specify the file name for the message field log and click OK.  
9. Click Done to exit the Validate Cluster window. If the configuration has  
problems, use Configure for clusteringto fix the problems; then, use  
Validate clusteragain.  
More information  
v
v
Clearing controller event logs: Use this action to clear (erase) all controller event  
logs. If you are having problems, do not clear the event logs; your service  
representative might need to reference the logs. If you must clear the logs, save the  
logs first.  
Note: The event logs are automatically cleared when you update the firmware  
(microcode) on the controller.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(system).  
2. Right-click ServeRAID Manager Actions Clear all controller event logs. The  
ServeRAID Manager clears all event logs belonging to all controllers in the  
selected server.  
More information  
v
v
Replacing a ServeRAID controller:  
Note: This action is not supported when using the following:  
v
Integrated RAID controller  
v ServeRAID-5i controller  
v ServeRAID-6i/6i+ controller  
v ServeRAID-6M controller under the Windows operating system  
Use this action to perform a hot-swap replace of a controller.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(controller).  
2. Right-click Replace controller. The IBM ServeRAID Hot-Swap Wizard opens.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3. Click Next. The wizard turns off the PCI slot.  
4. Click Next. The Replace the Controller window opens. This window lists the  
steps that you must follow to replace the controller hardware in the server.  
5. When complete, click OK. The wizard does the following:  
a. Turns on the PCI slot.  
b. Verifies that the controller is working properly.  
c. Configures the controller by importing the configuration from the physical  
drives.  
Note: Configuration can take several minutes.  
.
6. Click Next.  
7. Click Finish.  
More information  
v
v
Configuring a ServeRAID controller: the basic steps: The following steps are an  
overview of the ServeRAID configuration process:  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(controller) that you want to configure.  
2. Right-click Create logical drive, or click  
in the Logical devices view. The  
Configuration wizard opens.  
3. Click either Express configuration or Custom configuration: If you select  
Express configuration, the ServeRAID Manager automatically:  
a. Creates one or more arrays, based on the number and size of ready physical  
drives in your system.  
b. Defines a hot-spare drive, if four or more ready physical drives of the same  
size are available.  
c. Defines a logical drive for each array.  
If you select Custom configuration, the ServeRAID Manager walks you  
through:  
a. Selecting the physical drives that you want to include in your arrays or  
create as hot-spare drives.  
b. Defining the logical drives for your arrays.  
4. Click Automatically initialize new logical drives. Initializing a logical drive  
erases the first 1024 sectors on the drive and prevents access to any data  
previously stored on the drive.  
5. Click Next; then, review the configuration summary.  
6. Click Apply. The ServeRAID Manager will configure the controller and  
initialize and synchronize the logical drives.  
For HostRAID controllers, Express configuration creates a  
single logical drive. Custom configuration allows you to select the physical drives  
and segments used to define your logical drives.  
More information  
v
v
112 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v
Configuring two ServeRAID controllers in a failover environment:  
Note: This action is not supported when using the following controllers:  
v Integrated RAID controller  
v ServeRAID-5i controller  
v ServeRAID-6i/6i+ controller  
v ServeRAID-7t controller  
v ServeRAID-8i controller  
v ServeRAID-8k/8k-l controller  
v HostRAID controller  
You can configure two ServeRAID controllers in a failover environment when  
using Microsoft Windows 2000 or Microsoft Windows NT 4.0. Recent versions of  
ServeRAID device drivers utilize fault-tolerant technology. With fault tolerance,  
you can pair two controllers and connect them to the same enclosure to ensure  
access to the physical drives, even after one controller fails.  
Failover requires specific controller settings. You must set or change these settings  
by using the ServeRAID Manager in bootable-CD mode. The settings are the  
following:  
v Controller name  
v Partner controller name  
v SCSI initiator IDs  
Use Configure for Clustering to change these settings. You can use this action to  
view the settings from the installed ServeRAID Manager. To set or change these  
settings, you must use this action in bootable-CD mode.  
More information  
v
Steps for hot-replacing a ServeRAID controller: If you are hot-replacing a ServeRAID  
controller in a server that you are monitoring remotely, print these steps so you  
can refer to them while working at the server.  
1. Review the Safety Information in the ServeRAID book and the Safety  
Information book provided with your IBM server.  
2. Detach the SCSI cables from the ServeRAID controller.  
3. Open the locking handle and raise the latch.  
4. Unseat the controller from the PCI slot and remove the controller from the  
server.  
5. Insert the replacement controller in the PCI slot.  
6. Lower the latch and close the locking handle.  
7. Connect the SCSI cables to the replacement controller.  
More information  
v
v
Failing from the active to the passive controller:  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Note: This action is not supported when using the following:  
1. Integrated RAID controller  
2. ServeRAID-5i controller  
3. ServeRAID-6i/6i+ controller  
4. ServeRAID-7t controller  
5. ServeRAID-8i controller  
6. ServeRAID-8k/8k-l controller  
7. HostRAID controller  
Use this action to force a failover from the active to the passive controller for the  
following reasons:  
v To test your failover configuration.  
v If you are having problems accessing data through ServeRAID, attempt to  
failover to see if that fixes the problem.  
Note:  
1. This action is available only if clustering is enabled.  
2. Failover detects only failed controllers.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(controller).  
2. Right-click Clustering actions Fail from active to passive.  
3. Click Yes to confirm the failover.  
Networked storage object: Use this object, in the Enterprise view, to work with  
the management stations and network-attached enclosures in your configuration or  
to display their properties. When you click this object, the ServeRAID Manager  
displays a summary of management stations in the Networked storage view.  
Possible subobject  
v
v
Warning and error conditions  
(warning) is displayed if any management station has a warning or error  
condition.  
v
Actions  
v
v
v
Management station object: Use this object, in the Enterprise view, to work with  
a managment station or to display its properties.  
Possible subobject  
v
Warning and error conditions  
(warning) is displayed if any enclosure has a warning or error condition.  
v
114 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Actions  
v
v
v
v
v
Adding an agent: Use this action add a management station agent or FlashCopy  
v The management station agent is a monitoring agent for network storage. After  
you add a management station agent, you can monitor and configure the  
attached enclosures from a ServeRAID Manager console.  
v The FlashCopy agent monitors FlashCopy backups for network storage. You  
must run at least one FlashCopy agent to manage FlashCopy backups of logical  
devices on external storage enclosures.  
Adding a management station agent  
To add a management station agent:  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(management station).  
2. Right click Add agent. The Add Agent window opens.  
3. Enter the management port host name or TCP/IP address of one of the  
controllers in the enclosure. (Single controller configurations have only one  
controller in the enclosure.)  
4. Enter the administrator’s password in the password field.  
Note: The administrator’s password is established when the enclosure is  
installed on the network. It is not the same as the management station  
password.  
5. Click Add.  
Adding a FlashCopy agent  
To add a FlashCopy agent:  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(management station).  
2. Right click Add agent. The Add Agent window opens.  
3. Enter the host name or TCP/IP address of the machine on which the agent is  
running.  
Note: For the FlashCopy agent, no password is required.  
4. Click Add.  
More information  
v
v
Removing an agent: Use this action to remove a management station agent or  
FlashCopy agent for networked storage. Removing the management station agent  
deletes the enclosure from the Enterprise view, but does not take the enclosure  
offline.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
To remove an agent:  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(management station).  
2. Right click Remove agent and then the agent name. In the pull-right menu,  
management station agents are listed first, above the horizontal rule. FlashCopy  
agents are listed below the rule. The rule is visible (near the top of the panel)  
even if no management station agents are defined.  
3. Click Yes.  
More information  
v
v
Configuring a management station: Use this action to configure a management  
station. After you configure a management station, you can monitor the attached  
enclosures from a ServeRAID Manager console running on another system.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(management station).  
2. Right click Management station actions Configure. The Management Station  
Configuration window opens.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
Viewing the management station event log: Use this action to view events in the  
management station event log.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(management station).  
2. From the Actions menu, click Management station actions View event log.  
The Management Station Event Viewer window opens.  
3. If you want to save the event log to a file, click File Save as. The default is  
Events.txt.  
4. Click File Close to close the Event Viewer window.  
More information  
v
Using the management station agent: The management station agent is a monitoring  
agent for network storage. After you add an agent, you can configure the  
management station to:  
v Notify users by email when events occur on the enclosures attached to the  
management station. Use the Email Notification Manager, from the Management  
Station Configuration console, to add recipients to the email notification list.  
v Prevent unauthorized users from connecting to the management station using its  
built-in security feature. The management station checks the security list user  
name and password to ensure that only authorized users can log in. Use the  
Security Manager, from the Management Station Configuration console, to add  
users to the agent security list.  
116 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v Send SNMP traps. You can receive SNMP traps using any available SNMP  
management program. Use the SNMP Trap Manager, from the Management  
Station Configuration console, to add systems to the SNMP traps destination list.  
The agent monitors and generates events for critical or fatal problems in the  
enclosure configuration every 5 seconds. These changes include, but are not limited  
to:  
v defunct drives  
v PFA drives  
v Failed battery  
v Offline or critical logical drives  
v Failed controllers  
v Enclosure problems  
v Non-warranted drives. An event is sent at startup, console connection, and every  
30 days  
More information  
v
v
v
Enclosure object: Use this object to work with an enclosure or to display its  
properties.  
Possible subobject  
None.  
Warning and error conditions  
v
v
(warning) is displayed if the enclosure has the following conditions:  
– A fan has failed.  
– A power supply has failed.  
(error) is displayed if the enclosure has the following conditions:  
– It is not responding.  
– It is overheating.  
– Multiple fans have failed.  
– Multiple power supplies have failed.  
v
(enclosure) is displayed if the enclosure is one of the following:  
Working properly.  
– Not supported.  
– Supported, but not monitored for problems. For example, enclosures that are  
internal to a server do not have separate fans or power supplies.  
Actions  
v
v
v
v
Fail back storage (dual controller configurations only)  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v
v
v
Save support archive: Use this action to save the ServeRAID Manager configuration  
and status information in an archive file. Your ServeRAID Manager service  
representative might ask you to create this file to help diagnose a problem with  
your system.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(system) or  
(enclosure).  
2. From Action menu, select Save support archive. The Save As window opens.  
3. In the File name field, type a name for the archive file or accept the default  
name.  
4. Click Save.  
More information  
v
v
v
Arrays object: Use this object, in the Logical devices view, to work with basic  
arrays or spanned arrays or to display their properties:  
Note: A controller supports a maximum of eight arrays or four spanned arrays. An  
integrated RAID controller supports a maximum of one basic array.  
Possible subobject  
v
Warning and error conditions  
v None.  
Actions  
v
v
v If the array has free space, Create logical drive in array  
Understanding creating basic arrays: When you group one or more physical drives  
together and configure the ServeRAID controller to access them in a particular  
pattern, you create a basic array. The maximum number of basic arrays depends on  
the controller and RAID level.  
Arrays are used to improve security, performance, and reliability. The amount of  
improvement depends on the application programs that you run on the server,  
ServeRAID parameters, and the RAID levels that you assign to the logical drives in  
your arrays. The ServeRAID software supports RAID levels-0, 1, 1E, 5, 5E, and 6.  
(Not all RAID levels are supported by all controllers.)  
118 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Note: Each ServeRAID controller supports up to eight logical drives. If any of the  
existing arrays contain a RAID level-5 Enhanced logical drive, you can have  
only seven logical drives on a controller.  
For the ServeRAID-8i controller you can configure a maximum of 128  
logical drives. For the ServeRAID-7t controller, you can configure a maximum of 24  
logical drives.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
Understanding creating spanned arrays:  
Note: This feature is not supported on the integrated RAID controller.  
When you group one or more arrays together and configure the ServeRAID  
controller to access them in a particular pattern, you create a spanned array.  
Spanned arrays are used to create logical drives using as many as 60 physical  
drives. The ServeRAID controller supports RAID level-00, 10, 1E0, and 50.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
Configuring RAID and creating arrays:  
Note: This action is supported on the integrated RAID controller in bootable-CD  
mode only.  
You can use the Configuration wizard to create up to eight arrays and up to eight  
logical drives for each ServeRAID controller. The Configuration wizard provides  
two configuration options: Express and Custom. Express configuration  
automatically configures your ServeRAID controller. Custom configuration allows  
you to configure your controller manually. If you want to use RAID level-1E, RAID  
level-5E, RAID level-5EE, or RAID level-x0, you must use Custom configuration.  
Note: If you intend to use your ServeRAID controllers in a Microsoft Windows  
failover or clustering environment, review the ServeRAID publications  
before configuring ServeRAID.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(controller).  
Note: The integrated RAID controller is displayed in the ServeRAID Manager  
Enterprise view as two controller objects. However, you can configure  
only one array and RAID level-1 logical drive on an integrated RAID  
controller.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2. Right-click Create logical drive, or click  
on the toolbar or Logical devices  
view. The Configuration wizard opens.  
Note: If you click Express configuration, you will have the opportunity to  
review and approve the configuration before the ServeRAID Manager  
applies the configuration.  
4. Click Automatically initialize new logical drives. Initializing a logical drive  
erases the first 1024 sectors on the drive and prevents access to any data  
previously stored on the drive.  
More information  
v
v
Creating arrays and a hot-spare drive for your integrated RAID controller subsystem:  
Complete the following steps to create arrays:  
1. Click the Array tab in the right pane:  
2. Then, from the list of ready drives, select the drives you want to move to the  
array:  
3. Click  
>> (Add selected drives) to add the drives to the array.  
4. If you want to configure a hot-spare drive, complete the following steps:  
a. Click the Spares tab.  
b. Select the physical drive you want to designate as the hot-spare drive; then,  
click  
>> (Add selected drives).  
5. Click Next. The Configuration Summary window opens.  
To return to the Express and Custom Configuration window, click Back. To leave  
the Configuration wizard, click Cancel.  
More information  
v
Deleting all arrays:  
Note:  
120 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1. This action is supported on the integrated RAID controller in  
bootable-CD mode only.  
2. This action is not supported on the ServeRAID-8i, ServeRAID-8k/8k-l,  
and ServeRAID-7t controllers.  
Use this action to delete all arrays on the specified controller.  
For some operating systems, deleting an array and its associated logical drives  
might change the drive-letter assignments of the remaining drives when you  
restart the system.  
Attention: If you delete all arrays associated with the controller, all data on the  
controller is destroyed.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(controller).  
Attention: Before proceeding, ensure that you have backed up any data and  
programs that you want to save.  
2. Right-click Delete all arrays.  
3. Click Yes to confirm the delete.  
Replacing physical drives in an array: If you have an array built with one or more  
physical drives that are not the same size, or you simply want to upgrade the  
array with new, larger drives, you can replace the physical drives in the array.  
Attention: During the rebuild operation, if another physical drive fails, there is  
the risk of losing data.  
1. Replace the physical drive in the server or enclosure with a larger physical  
drive.  
2. Wait for the rebuild to complete.  
3. Repeat steps 1 and 2 until you have replaced all the smaller physical drives in  
the array.  
More information  
v
Modifying an array in the migration wizard: To add or remove drives in an array:  
1. In the Physical devices view (on the right), click the drives you want the array  
to use. To view available segments on each disk drive, switch to the full-size  
Note: A segment shaded in light blue is not part of any array or logical drive.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2. To remove or replace a physical drive, click the drive you want to remove  
(indicated by ). Then, click the drive you want to replace it with. To cancel  
your changes and start over, click  
.
3. When you are ready to continue, click Next. The Configuration Summary  
window opens.  
More information  
v
Choosing the primary physical drive of the array: When you create a RAID level-1  
logical drive on an integrated RAID controller, you must specify the primary  
physical drive. Doing so ensures that you retain the data on the primary physical  
drive. In a RAID level-1 logical drive, the data on the primary physical drive is  
copied to the secondary physical drive (the mirror). Any data on the secondary  
physical drive is destroyed.  
After the logical drive is created, the physical drive Properties panel reports the  
mirror role (primary or secondary) of each drive:  
Knowing the mirror role of each physical drive can be useful in the following  
situations:  
v Creating a logical drive with a physical drive that already contains data. A  
server has one physical drive and the operating system is installed on that  
physical drive. You decide that you want a RAID level-1 logical drive to achieve  
redundancy. When you install a second physical drive and configure the logical  
drive, you must specify the original physical drive as the primary physical drive  
so you do not destroy the data on that drive.  
v During a synchronization failure. After the logical drive is created, a  
synchronization begins to create the mirror of the primary physical drive. While  
the synchronization is in progress, the logical drive is displayed as critical,  
because the mirror is not complete and the logical drive has not achieved  
redundancy. During the synchronization, if the primary physical drive fails, all  
122 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
of the data on the drive is lost because the mirror is incomplete. If the secondary  
physical drive fails, the data on the primary physical drive is intact and you can  
create the mirror using a hot-spare drive.  
More information  
v
v
Confirming your array migration configuration: Use the configuration summary to  
review all the changes that the ServeRAID Manager will apply to your modified  
array and logical drive configuration.  
1. Review the information displayed in the Configuration Summary window. It  
describes how the new configuration will affect the RAID level and free space.  
To change the configuration, click Back.  
2. Click Apply.  
3. Click Yes when asked if you want to apply the new configuration.  
Note: Logical-drive migration is a lengthy process. The ServeRAID Manager  
displays  
(in animation) in the Logical devices view while the  
operation is in progress. When the migration is complete, the  
configuration is saved in the controller and in the physical drives.  
More information  
v
Exporting an array: Use this action to export the specified array. Exporting an array  
prepares the RAID configuration for transfer to another enclosure.  
Note: When you export an array, its status changes to foreign. You cannot perform  
any action on a foreign array except view array components and import a  
RAID configuration.  
To export an array:  
1. In the Logical devices view, click  
2. Right-click Export array.  
(array).  
3. Click Yes to confirm the export.  
More information  
v
v
v
Deleting an array:  
Note: This action is supported on the integrated RAID controller in bootable-CD  
mode only.  
Use this action to delete a specified array.  
For some operating systems, deleting an array and its associated logical drives  
might change the drive-letter assignments of the remaining drives when you  
restart the system.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Attention: If you delete an array, you delete all logical drives that are defined in  
that array. All data and programs on the logical drives in the array are lost during  
this procedure.  
To delete an array:  
1. In the Logical devices view, click  
(array).  
Attention: Before proceeding, ensure that you have backed up any data and  
programs that you want to save.  
2. Right-click Delete array.  
3. Click Yes to confirm the delete.  
Importing an array: Use this action to import the RAID configuration into the  
specified foreign array. Importing the RAID configuration completes the transfer of  
an array from another enclosure.  
To import an array:  
1. In the Logical devices view, click  
2. Right-click Import array.  
(foreign array).  
3. Click Yes to confirm the import.  
More information  
v
v
v
Moving an array to a different controller:  
Note: This action is not supported on enclosures with a single controller  
configuration.  
Use this action to move an array to a different controller in the enclosure. This  
action changes the preferred owner of the array and moves all associated logical  
drives to the new controller.  
1. In the Logical devices view, click  
(array).  
2. Right-click Move to controller and then the controller name (A or B).  
3. Click Yes when prompted to confirm the move.  
More information  
v
Array [letter] object: Use this object, in the Logical devices view, to work with an  
array or to display its properties.  
Notes:  
1. Basic arrays are labeled with letters starting with A. Spanned arrays are  
labeled with numbers starting with 1. Spanned arrays are used in RAID  
level-x0 configurations only.  
2. To view the array labels, switch to Text view; then, expand the array  
list.  
124 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3. A ServeRAID SCSI controller supports a maximum of eight basic arrays  
or four spanned arrays. An integrated RAID controller supports a  
maximum of one basic array.  
Possible subobject  
v
v
Warning and error conditions  
v
v
(warning) is displayed if the logical drives object has a warning condition.  
(error) is displayed if the logical drives object has an error condition.  
Actions  
v
v If the selected array is not a subarray in a RAID level-x0 configuration, the  
following actions are available:  
- RAID 0 to RAID 5  
- RAID 1 to RAID 5  
- RAID 5 to RAID 0  
- RAID 5E to RAID 5  
v If the array is on a network-attached storage enclosure:  
v
Export array (if the array is online)  
Import array (if the array is foreign)  
Move array to controller (dual controller configurations only)  
Logical drives object: Use this object, in the Logical devices view, to work with  
logical drives or to display their properties:  
Notes:  
1. ServeRAID SCSI controllers support a maximum of 8 logical drives.  
2. The ServeRAID-7t SATA controller supports a maximum of 24 logical  
drives.  
3. The ServeRAID-8i and ServeRAID-8k/8k-l SAS controllers support a  
maximum of 128 logical drives.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
4. An integrated RAID controller supports a maximum of one logical  
drive.  
Possible subobject  
v
Warning and error conditions  
v None.  
Actions  
v
v
v
v
Configure access control list (networked storage only)  
Configure target information (networked storage only)  
Understanding when RAID level-x0 logical drives change state: Start with four  
physical drives.  
Use two physical drives to create array A and two physical drives to create array  
B.  
Use arrays A and B to create spanned array 1. As part of a spanned array, arrays A  
and B are now called subarrays.″  
A sub-logical drive is created in array A and another sub-logical drive is created in  
array B.  
Then, create a logical drive in spanned array 1.  
If the sub-logical drive in subarray A is in the okay state and the sub-logical drive  
in subarray B is in the okay state, then the logical drive in spanned array 1 is in  
the okay state.  
If a physical drive fails in subarray A, then the sub-logical drive in subarray A  
changes to the critical state. Subarray B is still in the okay state. The logical drive  
in spanned array 1 changes to the critical state.  
If the second physical drive fails in subarray A, then the sub-logical drive in  
subarray A changes to the offline state. Subarray B remains in the okay state. The  
logical drive in spanned array 1 changes to the offline state.  
If the sub-logical drive in subarray A is in the critical state and a physical drive  
fails in subarray B, then the sub-logical drive in subarray B changes to the critical  
state. With both sub-logical drives in the critical state, the logical drive in spanned  
array 1 remains in the critical state.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
126 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding logical-drive synchronization: The purpose of synchronizing logical  
drives is to compute and write the parity data on the selected drives.  
Synchronizing a logical drive verifies that the data redundancy for the logical drive  
is correct.  
Note: You can determine if your controller firmware supports  
auto-synchronization and data scrubbing by viewing the controller  
properties. The properties pane reports if these features are enabled or  
disabled.  
Using auto-synchronization  
If the logical drive is attached to a controller that supports auto-synchronization,  
the ServeRAID Manager automatically synchronizes all new RAID level-5, 5E, 5EE,  
and 50 logical drives. These logical drives must be synchronized before storing  
data. Auto-synchronization ensures that the parity data is accurately computed.  
Accurate parity is critical for updating the parity when you begin to store data.  
For the ServeRAID-8i, ServeRAID-8k/8k-l, and ServeRAID-7t  
controllers, the ServeRAID Manager also supports auto-synchronization for RAID  
level-1 and 10 logical drives. During auto-synchronization, data from the primary  
drive is automatically copied to the mirror drive.  
Depending on the controller, the ServeRAID Manager displays either a progress  
indicator in the status bar or a  
(in animation) in the Logical devices view,  
indicating that auto-synchronization is in progress. You can perform some actions  
on the controller during an auto-synchronization, such as deleting a logical drive;  
however, you cannot perform a logical drive migration. Also, you can turn off the  
server during an auto-synchronization and, when you turn on the server, the  
firmware will continue the auto-synchronization where it left off.  
Using manual synchronization  
When you create a logical drive that is attached to a controller that does not  
support auto-synchronization, you will receive a warning event in the event viewer  
stating that you must manually synchronize the logical drive before storing data.  
Use Synchronize logical drivesto manually synchronize the logical drive. You  
must synchronize new RAID level-5 logical drives after you create them.  
Manual synchronization can be a lengthy operation. You can synchronize the  
logical drive immediately or schedule it for a later date and time. You can also  
schedule the synchronization as a recurring task. A recurring synchronization task  
starts at the initial start time, then runs periodically according to the given interval:  
the same time each day, each week, or each month. Do not turn off the server until  
the manual synchronization is complete.  
For ServeRAID SCSI controllers, you cannot perform any other actions on  
the controller until the manual synchronization is completed.  
Using manual synchronization for data scrubbing  
Data scrubbing is an automatic background synchronization process. Data  
scrubbing keeps data freshby doing the following:  
v (For RAID level-5, 5E, 5EE, or 50) Reading data and rewriting the data parity.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v (For RAID level-1, 1E, 10, 1E0) Reading data and rewriting the mirror data.  
If data scrubbing is disabled or your controller firmware does not support data  
scrubbing, consider manually synchronizing your logical drives weekly. This does  
not alter data on the drive.  
If data scrubbing is disabled on your ServeRAID controller, you can enable  
data scrubbing, but not through the ServeRAID Manager console. Instead, use the  
IPSSEND command-line program included on the IBM ServeRAID Support CD.  
For more information, refer to the IBM ServeRAID User’s Reference.  
More information  
v
v
v
Creating logical drives: Complete the following steps to create logical drives:  
2. Click the appropriate Array tab.  
3. Select a RAID level from the drop-down list.  
Note:  
a. RAID level-5E and RAID level-5EE allow only one logical drive per  
array.  
b. If you are configuring a spanned array, you can set the RAID level  
only for the first logical drive you create.  
c. If you plan to use Change RAID level,you must assign the same  
RAID level to all logical drives within a single array.  
Attention: Before assigning a logical drive RAID level-5E or RAID level-5EE,  
consider the following. If a physical drive fails during a post-failover  
resynchronization, the logical drive will enter the blocked state. Data might be  
lost or damaged.  
4. If you do not want to use the maximum size for the logical drive, type the size  
in the Data (MB) field.  
Note:  
a. You can define up to eight logical drives per controller. There are two  
exceptions:  
128 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
v If an array contains a logical drive assigned RAID level-5E  
v If you want to use the logical-drive migration feature  
In these cases, one logical drive slot must be left free; therefore, you  
must define no more than seven logical drives.  
b. Some operating systems have size limitations for logical drives.  
Before you save the configuration, verify that the size of the logical  
drive is appropriate for your operating system. For more detailed  
information, see your operating-system documentation.  
c. A logical drive cannot exceed 2048 GB (2 terabytes); the minimum  
size is nMB, where n equals the number of drives in the array.  
d. Typically, the first logical drive defined on the first ServeRAID  
controller found by system BIOS during startup will be your startup  
(boot) drive.  
e. The actual logical-drive size might be slightly different from what  
you select. The RAID level and the number of physical drives  
determine the size of the logical drive. For example, an array  
consisting of three, 1 GB physical drives with a requested RAID  
level-0 logical drive of 1000 MB will actually contain only 999 MB  
because the data is striped across all three drives, with 333 MB on  
each drive.  
5. If you have free space available and want to create additional logical drives,  
click  
.
6. Repeat steps 3 through 5 for each logical drive that you want to define in this  
array.  
7. Repeat steps 2 through 6 for each additional array that you want to configure.  
8. Click Next. The Configuration Summary window opens.  
To return to the Create Arrays window, click Back. To leave the Configuration  
wizard, click Cancel.  
More information  
v
v
v
Creating arrays and hot-spare drives: Complete the following steps to create arrays:  
2. Click the appropriate Array tab in the right pane:  
3. Then, from the list of ready drives, select the drives you want to add to the  
array:  
4. Click  
>> (Add selected drives) to add the drives to the array. You can  
click  
>> (Add all drives) to move all ready drives to an array.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5. Repeat steps 2 and 3 for each additional array or hot-spare drive that you want  
to configure.  
6. If you do not want to create a spanned array, skip to step 6. Otherwise, select  
the Span arrays check box  
. Then, click Next. If you created two  
arrays only, the ServeRAID Manager uses those arrays to create the spanned  
array; continue to step 6. Otherwise, the Create Spanned Arrays window opens.  
Note: To create a spanned array, each array must have the same number of  
physical drives.  
7. After you select the ready drives for your arrays and hot-spare drive, click  
Next. The Create Logical Drives window opens.  
To return to the Express and Custom Configuration window, click Back. To leave  
the Configuration wizard, click Cancel.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
Creating spanned arrays: If you want to assign RAID level-x0 to an array, you must  
create a spanned array.  
Note: Spanned arrays are supported only by IBM ServeRAID-4 Ultra160,  
ServeRAID-5i Ultra320, ServeRAID-6M Ultra320, and ServeRAID-6i/6i+  
Ultra320 SCSI controllers.  
Complete the following steps to create one or more identical spanned arrays:  
2. In the list of arrays, click the arrays that you want to add to your spanned  
array.  
3. Click  
can click  
>> (Add selected arrays) to add the arrays to the spanned array. You  
>> (Add all arrays) to move all arrays to the spanned array.  
4. To create additional spanned arrays, click the New spanned array tab in the  
right pane.  
Then, repeat steps 2 and 3.  
5. Click Next; the Create Logical Drives window opens.  
To return to the Create Arrays window, click Back. To leave the Configuration  
wizard, click Cancel.  
More information  
v
v
Creating additional logical drives:  
130 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Note: This action is not supported on the integrated RAID controller.  
Use this action to create additional logical drives in an existing configuration. If  
you configured your ServeRAID subsystem but left free space in an array, you can  
use this action to create additional logical drives using the free space.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(controller) that contains the array in which  
you want to create the logical drives.  
2. In the Logical devices view, click  
3. Right-click Create logical drive. If the controller includes more than one array,  
right click Create logical drive in array and then the array name. The  
Configuration wizard opens with the Create Logical Drives window.  
Changing the logical drive name: Use this action to change the name of a logical  
drive:  
1. Press the Delete key to clear the drive’s current name.  
2. In the Type new name field, type the drive’s new name.  
3. Click OK.  
Clearing a logical drive: Use this action to initialize a logical drive using the  
Clear initialization method. Initialization is usually automatic when you create a  
logical drive.  
Attention: The Clear initialization method erases the entire logical drive and  
prevents access to any data previously stored on the drive.  
1. In the Logical devices view, click  
2. Right-click Clear.  
(logical drive).  
3. Click Yes.  
Deleting a logical drive:  
Note:  
1. This action is supported on the integrated RAID controller in  
bootable-CD mode only.  
2.  
3.  
For ServeRAID SCSI controllers, this action is available only if the  
selected logical drive is the last logical drive that was created in the  
array.  
To delete a partitioned logical drive on a HostRAID controller,  
you must remove the partition with your operating system disk  
management tools first. Then, you can delete the logical drive with the  
ServeRAID Manager.  
4.  
To delete a logical drive on a networked storage enclosure, all  
iSCSI initiators must be disconnected first. Then, you can delete the  
logical drive.  
Attention: If you delete a logical drive, all data on that logical drive is  
destroyed. Before proceeding, ensure that you have backed up any data and  
programs that you want to save.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1. In the Logical devices view, click  
2. Right-click Delete.  
(logical drive).  
3. Click Yes to confirm the delete.  
Initializing a logical drive: Use this action to initialize a logical drive. Initialization  
is usually automatic when you create a logical drive.  
Attention: Initializing a logical drive erases the first 1024 sectors on the drive and  
prevents access to any data previously stored on the drive.  
1. In the Logical devices view, click  
2. Right-click Initialize.  
3. Click Yes.  
(logical drive).  
Synchronizing logical drives:  
Note: This action is not supported on the integrated RAID controller.  
If auto-synchronization is not supported on your controller, you must use this  
action to manually synchronize new RAID level-5, 5E, and 50 logical drives after  
you create them.  
If data scrubbing is disabled or your controller firmware does not support data  
scrubbing, consider manually synchronizing your logical drives weekly using this  
action.  
Manual synchronization can be a lengthy operation. You can synchronize the  
logical drive immediately or schedule it for a later date and time. You can also  
schedule the synchronization as a recurring task. A recurring task starts at the  
initial start time, then runs periodically according to the given interval: the same  
time each day, each week, or each month.  
Note: You cannot perform any other actions on the controller until the manual  
synchronization is completed. For example, you cannot schedule a  
synchronization if another logical drive synchronization is in progress.  
An example  
You schedule a synchronization task with an initial start time of Sunday, October  
13, 2004 at 2:00 AM. It recurs weekly. It will run again on Sunday October 20, 2004  
at 2:00 AM.  
Note: Do not turn off the server while manual synchronization is in progress.  
To synchronize a logical drive:  
1. In the Logical devices view, click  
2. Right-click Synchronize.  
(logical drive).  
3. Click Yes to synchronize the logical drive immediately (now). Depending on  
the controller, the ServeRAID Manager displays either a progress indicator in  
the status bar or  
(in animation) in the Logical devices view, indicating that  
the operation is in progress.  
4. Or click Schedule to schedule the synchronization for a later date and time.  
The ServeRAID Manager displays the Synchronization Scheduler pane:  
132 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v From the drop-down lists and calendar display, select the day, month, year,  
and time you want the task performed.  
v From the Recurring drop-down list, select the interval at which you want the  
task to recur: Never, Daily, Weekly, Monthly.  
v Click OK to schedule the task; click Cancel to cancel the scheduled task and  
return to the initial confirmation pane.  
More information  
v
v
v
Unblocking a logical drive:  
Note: This action is not supported on the integrated RAID controller.  
After the rebuild operation is completed on an array, if the array contained RAID  
level-0 logical drives, you can unblock the RAID level-0 logical drives and access  
them once again. But remember, the logical drive contains damaged data. You  
must re-create, install, or restore the data from the most recent backup disk or tape.  
To unblock a blocked logical drive:  
1. In the Logical devices view, click  
2. Right-click Unblock logical drive.  
(logical drive).  
3. Click Yes to confirm, understanding that the data on the logical drive is not  
valid. The ServeRAID Manager unblocks the blocked logical drive.  
4. Initialize all unblocked logical drives before using them.  
5. Restore the data to the drive from your most recent backup disk or tape.  
More information  
v
Selecting the logical drive size: When you select the logical drive size, consider the  
following:  
v If you change the RAID level of a logical drive, the total size (data plus parity)  
of the logical drive might change.  
v If you do not use all available free space, you can create another logical drive.  
Click Create new logical drive to do so. You can assign the same or a different  
RAID level to additional logical drives.  
v You cannot delete the last remaining logical drive in the array. You must have at  
least one logical drive for each array.  
v Refer to the documentation provided with your operating system for  
information about the recommended logical-drive size.  
v The default RAID configuration uses all available free space.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 133  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Scheduling the logical-drive migration: Use the calendar display to choose the date  
and time for the logical drive migration:  
v From the calendar display, select the day, month, year, and time that you want  
the task performed.  
v Click Apply.  
v Click Yes when asked if you want to schedule the migration.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
Logical drive [number] object: Use this object, in the Logical devices view, to  
work with a logical drive or to display its properties.  
Notes:  
1. ServeRAID SCSI controllers support a maximum of eight logical drives.  
2. The ServeRAID-7t SATA controller supports a maximum of 24 logical  
drives.  
3. The ServeRAID-8i SAS controller supports a maximum of 128 logical  
drives.  
4. HostRAID controllers support a maximum of 2 logical drives.  
5. An integrated RAID controller supports a maximum of one logical  
drive.  
Possible subobject  
v None.  
Warning and error conditions  
v
(warning) is displayed if the logical drive is in a critical, critical migrating,  
or critical system state. It is also displayed if a physical drive in the logical drive  
is a defunct drive or a defunct hot-spare drive.  
v
v
(error) is displayed if the logical drive is in a blocked or offline state.  
(initialize) is displayed when the logical drive is initialized  
(ServeRAID-8i/8k/8k-l, ServeRAID-7t, HostRAID controllers only).  
v
v
(build/modify) is displayed during a logical-drive migration  
(ServeRAID-8i/8k/8k-l, ServeRAID-7t, HostRAID controllers only).  
(FlashCopy) is displayed if the logical drive is a FlashCopy backup  
(ServeRAID-8i/8k/8k-l, ServeRAID-7t controllers only).  
Actions  
Note: Not all actions are supported on all controllers.  
v
v
v
134 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v
v
v
v If a logical drive is blocked, unblock logical drive  
v
v
v
The following actions are supported for networked storage only (enclosures):  
v
v
v
The following action is supported in bootable-CD mode only, except for  
ServeRAID-8i and ServeRAID-7t controllers:  
v
Channel [number] object: Use this object, in the Physical devices view, to work  
with a selected SCSI channel or to display its properties:  
Notes:  
1. A controller supports a maximum of four SCSI channels.  
2. The ServeRAID-5i controller does not support tape drives and physical  
drives on the same channel.  
Possible subobject  
v
v
v
v
v
v
Warning and error conditions  
None.  
Actions  
v
v
The following action is available only in bootable-CD mode:  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v
Scanning for new or removed ready drives:  
Note: This action is not supported on the integrated RAID controller.  
Use this action to scan all SCSI channels or ports for either of the following:  
v Physical drives that have been added.  
v Ready physical drives that have been removed.  
After physically removing a ready drive from a server or enclosure, the ServeRAID  
Manager still reports the drive as ready. The firmware (microcode) does not  
communicate with ready drives, therefore the firmware does not report the drive  
as removed. Use this action to remove the ready drive from the configuration.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
2. Right-click Rescan.  
(controller) or  
(enclosure).  
3.  
4.  
For ServeRAID SCSI controllers, the Scan for new or removed ready  
drives on controllerwindow opens. The ServeRAID Manager scans all SCSI  
channels on the selected controller. Review the scan report; then, click Done. To  
stop the scan before it completes click Cancel.  
For the ServeRAID-8i, ServeRAID-8k/8k-l, ServeRAID-7t,  
and HostRAID controllers, the ServeRAID Manager scans all ports on the  
selected controller. It reports the results of the scan in theevent viewer.  
Changing the SCSI-transfer speed:  
Note:  
1. This action is supported in bootable-CD mode only.  
2. This action is not supported on the integrated RAID controller.  
3. This action is not supported on the ServeRAID SAS controllers  
(8i/8k/8k-l) and the ServeRAID-7t controller.  
Use this action to change the SCSI-transfer speed.  
1. In the Physical devices view, click the SCSI channel identifier:  
2. Right-click Change the SCSI transfer speed and then a transfer speed. The  
following choices are available:  
v Optimal  
his value is available if your controller supports it; otherwise, Optimal does not  
appear in the menu. Optimal is the default value. When the transfer speed is  
set to Optimal, the ServeRAID controller determines the best transfer speed,  
based on the types of SCSI drives and enclosures in use.  
v Ultra320 SCSI  
v Ultra160 SCSI  
v Ultra2 SCSI  
v
v
UltraSCSI  
Fast SCSI-2  
136 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v
SCSI-2  
v SCSI-1  
This value is available if your controller is set to SCSI-1; otherwise, SCSI-1 does  
not appear in the menu.  
Ports [numbers] object: Use this object, in the Physical devices view, to work  
with selected ports or to display their properties:  
Possible subobject  
v
v
Warning and error conditions  
v None.  
Actions  
v
Physical drive [number] object: Use this object, in the Physical devices view, to  
work with a physical drive or to display its properties.  
Note: A SCSI channel supports a maximum 15 physical drives.  
Possible subobject  
None.  
Warning and error conditions  
v
(warning) is displayed if the selected physical drive is undergoing a rebuild  
operation, reports a PFA, or is a non-warranted physical drive.  
v
(error) is displayed if the selected physical drive is a defunct drive.  
Actions  
v
v If the drive is ready:  
v
v If the drive is defunct, Remove the defunct drive  
v
v
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v If the drive is rebuilding, online, or reports a PFA, set drive state to defunct  
v
Understanding physical drive capacity and unusable capacity: Physical drive capacities  
influence the way you create arrays. Drives in the array can be of different  
capacities (1 GB or 2 GB, for example), but the ServeRAID controller treats them as  
if they all have the capacity of the smallest physical drive.  
For example, if you group three 1 GB drives and one 2 GB drive into an array, the  
total capacity of the array is 1 GB times 4, or 4 GB, not the 5 GB physically  
available. The remaining space on the 2 GB drive is unusable capacity.  
For the ServeRAID-8i, ServeRAID-8k/8k-l, and and ServeRAID-7t  
controllers, the remaining space is usable capacity. That is, you can use the  
remaining space to define another logical drive; see Example: Usable and unusable  
Conversely, if you add a smaller drive to an array of larger drives, such as a 1 GB  
drive to a group containing three 2 GB drives, the total capacity of that array is 4  
GB, not the 7 GB physically available. Therefore, the optimal way to create arrays  
is to use physical drives that have the same capacity.  
A hot-spare drive also must be at least as large as the smallest drive in the array.  
More information  
v
v
v
Clearing a disk drive: Use this action to remove all data from a disk drive:  
1. In the Physical devices view, click  
2. Right-click Clear.  
(online physical drive).  
3. Click Yes to confirm.  
More information  
v
Verifying physical drives: Use this action to check a physical drive for inconsistent  
or bad data. The Verify action examines each sector and block on the disk to  
ensure that it is readable. It does not repair the drive if bad data is found.  
To verify a physical drive:  
1. In the Physical devices view, click  
2. Right-click Verify.  
(physical drive).  
3. Click Yes to verify the drive.  
Note: To check the progress of the operation, switch to text view.  
More information  
v
138 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Initializing physical drives: Use this action to erase the metadata for a ready  
physical drive. The metadata includes all logical drive definition data.  
To initialize a physical drive:  
1. In the Physical devices view, click  
2. Right-click Initialize.  
(physical drive).  
3. Click Yes to initialize the drive.  
Note: To check the progress of the operation, switch to text view.  
More information  
v
Manually rebuilding a defunct drive: Use this action to rebuild a critical logical drive  
when a physical drive in the array is defunct. Normally, the controller rebuilds a  
logical drive when it detects the removal and reinsertion of a drive that is part of  
an array. Use this operation to force the rebuild to begin immediately, without  
physically removing and replacing the disk drive.  
Note: The controllers can rebuild RAID level-1, level-1E, level-5, level-5E,  
level-5EE, level-10, level-1E0, and level-50 logical drives. They cannot,  
however, rebuild RAID level-0 logical drives because RAID level-0 is not  
redundant.  
Complete the following steps to manually rebuild a defunct drive:  
1. In the Physical devices view, click  
2. Right-click Rebuild drive.  
3. Click Yes to confirm.  
(defunct physical drive).  
Note: During the rebuild operation, the defunct drive enters the rebuild state  
and the logical drive remains critical until the rebuild operation is  
completed.  
More information  
v
v
Removing a defunct drive:  
Note: This action is not supported on network storage controllers. It is supported  
on the integrated RAID controller in bootable-CD mode only.  
You can use this action only on defunct physical drives that are not part of any  
array. Although the ServeRAID software implicitly removes defunct drives from  
the configuration, this action is useful if you want to remove a defunct drive from  
the Physical devices view so you can view an accurate configuration.  
1. In the Physical devices view, click  
(defunct physical drive).  
2. Right-click Remove defunct drive. The ServeRAID Manager removes the  
defunct drive from the configuration.  
Setting a drive state to online:  
Note: This action is not supported on the integrated RAID controller.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 139  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
You can use this action only when the following is true:  
v The defunct drive is part of an array.  
v There are no critical logical drives in the array.  
Attention: When you set a defunct drive to online, there is a high risk of data  
loss.  
1. In the Physical devices view, click  
2. Right-click Set drive state to online.  
3. Click Yes to confirm.  
(defunct physical drive).  
Setting a drive state to defunct:  
Note: This action is not supported on the ServeRAID-8i, ServeRAID-8k/8k-l, and  
ServeRAID-7t controllers.  
You can use this action only on a physical drive that is part of an array. If a  
physical drive is part of an array, you must change the drive state to defunct  
before removing the drive from the server or enclosure. Doing so eliminates the  
risk of losing data. After you replace the physical drive, you can rebuild the  
affected array.  
This action is useful in situations such as the following:  
v You want to replace a physical drive that is marked with a PFA.  
v You want to replace a physical drive that is unwarranted.  
v You have an array built with one or more physical drives that are not the same  
drives so that the array no longer has unusable capacity and an inefficient  
configuration.  
Attention:  
1.  
If you do not change an online physical drive state to defunct before removing  
the drive from the server or enclosure, you risk losing data or damaging the  
physical drive.  
2. You cannot use this action on a physical drive undergoing a rebuild operation.  
3. (For non-RAID level-x0 logical drives) If you choose to use this action and a  
logical drive is:  
v In a critical state, the logical drive state will change to offline.  
v RAID level-0 and in an okay state, the logical drive will change to offline.  
v Not RAID level-0 and in an okay state, the logical drive state will change to  
critical.  
4. (For RAID level-x0 logical drives) If you choose to use this action and a logical  
drive is in a critical state, the logical drive state might change to offline.  
1. In the Physical devices view, click  
(defunct physical drive) or  
(physical  
drive).  
2. Right-click Set drive state to defunct. A confirmation window opens to warn  
that this action might corrupt data.  
Note: If the logical drive that contains this physical drive is already offline, the  
ServeRAID Manager does not display this warning because the data is  
already corrupt. Continue to step 4.  
140 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3. Click Yes. The ServeRAID Manager sets the drive status to defunct.  
4. Replace the selected physical drive. If the logical drive is not offline, a rebuild  
automatically occurs.  
More information  
v
v
Rebuilding a defunct drive: A physical drive is marked defunct when there is a loss  
of communication between the controller and the physical drive. This can be  
caused by any of the following:  
v An improperly connected cable, physical drive, or controller  
v Loss of power to a drive  
v An improperly assembled SCSI channel in an unsupported configuration  
v A defective cable, backplane, physical drive, or controller  
v Connecting unsupported SCSI devices (such as tape drives or CD-ROM drives)  
to the same SCSI channel used for an array  
In each case, after the communication problem is resolved, a rebuild operation is  
required to reconstruct the data for the device in its disk array. The ServeRAID  
controllers can reconstruct RAID level-1, level-1E, level-5, level-5E, level-5EE,  
level-10, level-1E0, and level-50 logical drives. They cannot, however, reconstruct  
data stored in RAID level-0 logical drives because RAID level-0 is not redundant.  
If an array contains only RAID level-0 logical drives, the logical drives in the array  
are marked offline and the logical drives contain damaged data. You cannot  
rebuild the logical drives. You must correct the cause of the failure or replace the  
physical drives; then, you must restore your data.  
To prevent data-integrity problems, the ServeRAID controllers set the RAID level-0  
logical drives in the affected array to blocked during the rebuild operation for  
RAID level-1 or RAID level-5. After the rebuild operation is completed, you can  
unblock the RAID level-0 logical drives and access them once again. Remember,  
however, that the RAID level-0 logical drives contain damaged data.  
Note: For logical drives in an IBM ServeRAID Cluster Solution:  
v Because shared logical drives can have only one logical drive for each  
array, blocking a RAID level-0 logical drive during a rebuild operation  
does not apply to shared logical drives.  
v Because non-shared logical drives can have more than one logical drive for  
each array, blocking a RAID level-0 logical drive during a rebuild  
operation does apply to non-shared logical drives.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 141  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v
v
Recovering from defunct drives: If the defunct drives are not part of an array, contact  
your service representative.  
If a physical drive fails in an array or multiple physical drives fail in separate  
arrays (one physical drive per array), complete the following steps:  
1. Replace each defunct physical drive. The controller starts the rebuild operation  
when it detects the removal and reinsertion of a drive that is part of an array.  
Note: (For a configuration that contains a hot-spare drive) If you replace a  
failed physical drive, it is not necessary to position the new physical  
drive on the same SCSI channel and SCSI ID as the original hot-spare  
drive. The replacement physical drive is automatically incorporated into  
the configuration as a hot-spare drive. Here is an example of how this  
works:  
a. The original configuration consists of a RAID level-5 logical drive  
composed of four physical drives. The physical drives are connected  
to SCSI channel 1; they are assigned SCSI IDs 0, 1, 2, and 3. SCSI ID  
3 is a hot-spare drive.  
b. The physical drive at Channel 1, SCSI ID 2, fails; the logical drive  
enters the critical state.  
c. The hot-spare drive at Channel 1, SCSI ID 3, is rebuilt into the array.  
d. You remove the failed physical drive at Channel 1, SCSI ID 2, and  
replace it with a new physical drive. The new physical drive at  
Channel 1, SCSI ID 2, is automatically assigned to be a hot-spare  
drive.  
2. If a rebuild operation is in progress, wait until the rebuild is complete.  
Otherwise, go to step 3.  
Note: If you are replacing multiple defunct drives, you must wait for each  
rebuild operation to complete before starting subsequent rebuild  
operations.  
3. Verify the cables, physical drives, and controllers are installed properly.  
4. Attempt to rebuild the defunct physical drive by performing a hot-swap  
5. If the hot-swap rebuild fails, contact your service representative.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Viewing shared drives:  
Note: This action is not supported when using the following:  
142 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v Integrated RAID controller  
v ServeRAID-5i controller  
v ServeRAID-6i/6i+ controller  
v ServeRAID-7k controller  
v ServeRAID-7t controller  
v ServeRAID-8i controller  
v ServeRAID-8k/8k-l controller  
v HostRAID controller  
Use this action to view the physical drives owned by a cluster partner system in  
the Enterprise view.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(controller).  
2. Right-click Clustering actions View shared drives to view the physical drives  
owned by a partner system.  
3. Select the Enable view shared drives box. To disable viewing shared drives,  
deselect the Enable view shared drives box.  
4. Define the location of the partner system online drive by specifying the SCSI  
channel and SCSI ID in the drop-down lists.  
5. Click OK.  
The ServeRAID Manager displays the physical drives owned by the partner system  
in the Enterprise view as  
(Reserved). You only can view these reserved drives;  
you cannot perform any actions upon them.  
More information  
v
Hot-spare drive object: Use this object, in the Physical devices view, to work with  
a hot-spare drive in your configuration or to display its properties.  
Possible subobject  
None.  
Warning and error conditions  
v
(warning) is displayed if the hot-spare drive reports a PFA or is a  
non-warranted physical drive.  
v
(error) is displayed if the hot-spare drive is defunct.  
Actions  
v
v
Hot-spare configuration summary: If a hot-spare drive of the appropriate size is  
available, this column reports Yes.  
If the logical drive is redundant (that is, RAID level-1, 1E, or 5), but a hot-spare  
drive of the appropriate size is not available, this column reports No (in red).  
If the logical drive is RAID level-0, this column reports No (in black).  
Creating a hot-spare drive:  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 143  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Note: This action is supported on the integrated RAID controller in bootable-CD  
mode only.  
Use this action to create a hot-spare drive.  
1. In the Physical devices view, click  
(ready physical drive) or  
(standby  
hot-spare drive).  
2. Click  
in the Logical devices view. The ServeRAID Manager creates the  
hot-spare drive.  
Note: A hot-spare drive with a blue plus sign next to it indicates that the  
logical devices are protected by the hot spare. A hot-spare drive with a  
yellow plus sign next to it indicates that:  
v The drive is too small to protect any drives in the logical devices  
v None of the logical devices support hot spares (for example, a RAID  
Level-0 array)  
v No logical devices are defined  
More information  
v
v
Creating a standby hot-spare drive:  
Note: This action is not supported on the ServeRAID-8i/8k/8k-l SAS controllers,  
ServeRAID-7t SATA controller, and the integrated RAID controller.  
Use this action to create a standby hot-spare drive.  
1. In the Physical devices view, click  
(ready physical drive) or  
(hot-spare  
drive).  
2. Right-click Create standby hot-spare drive. The ServeRAID Manager creates  
the standby hot-spare drive.  
Note: A standby hot-spare drive with a blue plus sign next to it indicates that  
the logical devices are protected by the hot spare. A standby hot-spare  
drive with a yellow plus sign next to it indicates that:  
v The drive is too small to protect any drives in the logical devices  
v None of the logical devices support hot spares (for example, a RAID  
Level-0 array)  
v No logical devices are defined  
More information  
v
v
v
Creating an assigned hot-spare drive:  
Note: This action is supported only on the ServeRAID-7t, ServeRAID-8i,  
ServeRAID-8k/8k-l, and external storage enclosures (networked storage).  
Use this action to assign one or more hot-spare drives to a logical drive. An  
assigned hot-spare drive is a dedicated spare: it is used only to rebuild the logical  
144 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
drive to which it is assigned. An unassigned hot-spare drive is global: it can be  
used to rebuild any logical drive on the controller.  
Note: You cannot assign a hot-spare drive while a logical drive is being built or  
modified (such as a logical drive migration).  
1. In the Physical devices view, click  
(ready physical drive).  
the logical device name.  
2. Right-click Create assigned hot-spare drive for  
The ServeRAID Manager creates a dedicated hot-spare drive for the logical  
drive.  
More information  
v
v
Deleting a hot-spare drive:  
Note: This action is supported on the integrated RAID controller in bootable-CD  
mode only.  
Use this action to delete a hot-spare physical drive from your configuration.  
1. In the Physical devices view, click  
(hot-spare drive).  
2. Right-click Delete hot-spare drive. The ServeRAID Manager deletes the  
hot-spare drive from the configuration by setting the drive state to ready. If you  
removed the drive from the server, the ServeRAID Manager removes the drive  
from the configuration.  
Deleting a standby hot-spare drive:  
Note: This action is not supported on the ServeRAID-8i/8k/8k-l SAS controllers,  
the ServeRAID-7t SATA controller, and the integrated RAID controller.  
Use this action to delete a standby hot-spare physical drive from your  
configuration.  
1. In the Physical devices view, click  
(standby hot-spare drive).  
2. Right-click Delete standby hot-spare drive. The ServeRAID Manager deletes  
the standby hot-spare drive from the configuration by setting the drive state to  
ready. If you have physically removed the drive, the ServeRAID Manager  
removes the drive from the configuration.  
Choosing to create a hot-spare or standby hot-spare drive: Hot-spare drives and  
standby hot-spare drives supply additional protection to a RAID configuration. If a  
physical drive fails in configurations other than RAID level-0 and RAID level-00,  
the hot-spare drive automatically replaces the failed physical drive. Subsequently,  
the logical drive can be rebuilt automatically.  
Note: You cannot use hot-spare drives with RAID level-0 and RAID level-00.  
You can create a hot-spare drive in the Configuration wizard when you first  
configure the controller. If you choose not to create a hot-spare drive at that time,  
you can do so later.  
More information  
v
v
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 145  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v
v
v
Rebuilding a hot-swap drive: A hot-swap rebuild refers to a rebuild operation that is  
started by the controller when it detects that a drive that is part of an array and in  
the defunct state has been removed and reinserted on the SCSI cable or backplane.  
The reinsertion of the physical drive, whether it is the same drive or a new drive,  
will trigger the controller to start the rebuild operation. During the rebuild  
operation, the drive being rebuilt is in the rebuild state, and the logical drive  
remains critical until the rebuild operation has been successfully completed.  
On most servers, when a hot-spare drive is available, the rebuild operation begins  
automatically without the need to replace the failed drive. If more than one drive  
fails within the same array, no rebuild takes place. If multiple drives fail in  
separate arrays (one physical drive per array), the controller initiates a rebuild  
operation for the logical drives within the array containing the first failed physical  
drive. This rebuild operation is performed on the first hot-spare drive of sufficient  
size to become a valid member of the array.  
Complete the following steps to start a hot-swap rebuild:  
1. Without removing the drive completely, gently remove the physical drive from  
the server, using the handle of the hot-swap tray. If necessary, refer to the  
documentation that comes with your server for information about removing a  
physical drive.  
Attention: When power is removed from a hot-swap drive, the drive  
immediately parks the heads, locks the actuator in the landing zone,and  
begins spinning down. However, the spinning down of the disk might require  
up to 20 seconds after power is removed. Do not move the drive while it is  
spinning down. Moving the drive while it is spinning down might damage the  
drive.  
2. Wait 20 seconds to allow the physical drive to completely stop spinning.  
3. If you are certain there is nothing wrong with the physical drive you removed,  
gently reinstall the drive into the server. Make sure the drive is completely  
installed in the backplane connector.  
Otherwise, replace the physical drive with a new drive that is the same size (or  
larger) and continue with the rebuild operation.  
Note:  
a. If multiple drives fail in separate arrays (one physical drive per  
array), replace each defunct physical drive. If multiple physical drives  
fail at the same time within the same array, contact your service  
representative.  
b. Although it is possible to rebuild a defunct physical drive to an  
online physical drive that is defective, avoid doing so.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
146 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Enclosure management device object: Use this object, in the Physical devices  
view, to work with a storage enclosure attached to controller with a SAF-TE  
processor.  
Note: The integrated RAID controller does not support enclosure monitoring. Any  
enclosure in an integrated RAID controller RAID subsystem is displayed in  
the ServeRAID Manager Enterprise view; however, the ServeRAID Manager  
and the ServeRAID Manager agent will not generate any events or enclosure  
status information.  
Possible subobject  
None.  
Warning and error conditions  
v
v
(warning) is displayed if the enclosure has the following conditions:  
– A fan has failed.  
– A power supply has failed.  
(error) is displayed if the enclosure has the following conditions:  
– It is not responding.  
– It is overheating.  
– Multiple fans have failed.  
– Multiple power supplies have failed.  
v
(enclosure) is displayed if the enclosure is one of the following:  
Working properly.  
– Not supported.  
– Supported, but not monitored for problems. For example, enclosures that are  
internal to a server do not have separate fans or power supplies.  
Actions  
CD-ROM drive object: Use this object to display CD-ROM drive properties.  
Note: The ServeRAID-5i, 6i/6i+, 6M, and 7t controllers do not support CD-ROM  
drives.  
Possible subobject  
None.  
Warning and error conditions  
CD-ROM drive objects cannot have warning or error conditions.  
Actions  
None.  
Removable-media drive object: Use this object to display removable-media drive  
properties.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 147  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Possible subobject  
None.  
Warning and error conditions  
Removable-media drive objects cannot have warning or error conditions.  
Actions  
None.  
Tape drive object: Use this object to display tape drive properties.  
Note: The ServeRAID-5i controller does not support tape drives and physical  
drives on the same channel.  
Possible subobject  
None.  
Warning and error conditions  
Tape drive objects cannot have warning or error conditions.  
Actions  
None.  
Using display groups  
Note: Display groups are not available when using:  
v ServeRAID Manager in bootable-CD mode  
v ServeRAID Manager as a plug-in application  
Display groups allow you organize related systems in the Enterprise view under  
an expandable tree object. Using actions on the System object, the Management  
station object, and the Display group object, you can:  
v
v
v
v
Create, delete, and rename display groups  
In this example, managed systems are organized by location, using three display  
groups.  
Display groups are sorted alphabetically. They appear in the tree below all systems  
that are not part of any display group.  
148 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Note: A system can be part of only one display group at a time; it cannot appear  
in multiple display groups.  
More information  
v
Creating a display group:  
Note: This action is not supported when using the following:  
v ServeRAID Manager in bootable-CD mode  
v ServeRAID Manager as a plug-in application  
Use this action to add a system or enclosure to a new display group. This action  
creates the display group and moves the system into it in a single step.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(system) or  
(enclosure).  
2. Right-click Change display group new group. The Group Name window  
opens.  
3. Enter a name for the group.  
4. Click OK.  
More information  
v
v
v
Deleting or renaming a display group:  
Note: This action is not supported when using the following:  
v ServeRAID Manager in bootable-CD mode  
v ServeRAID Manager as a plug-in application  
Use this action to delete or rename a display group.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(display group).  
2. To delete the display group, right-click Delete display group. All systems in  
the group move back to their original location in the tree.  
3. To rename the display group:  
a. Right-click Rename display group. The Group Name window opens.  
b. Enter a new name for the display group.  
c. Click OK.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 149  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
More information  
v
v
v
Moving systems in and out of a display group:  
Note: This action is not supported when using the following:  
v ServeRAID Manager in bootable-CD mode  
v ServeRAID Manager as a plug-in application  
Use this action to move a system or enclosure into an existing display group; to  
move the system or enclosure from one display group to another; or to remove the  
system or enclosure from a display group.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(system) or  
(enclosure).  
2. To move the system into a display group or from one display group to another,  
right-click Change display group and then the display group name.  
3. To remove the system from the display group, right-click Change display  
group none.  
Note: When you remove the last system in a display group, the ServeRAID  
Manager deletes the display group.  
More information  
v
v
v
Changing the display options: You can sort objects in the ServeRAID Manager  
Enterprise view alphabetically or chronologically. You can also view the disk  
capacity unit of measure in megabytes (MB), gigabytes (GB), or terabytes (TB).  
Note: The local system always appears first when you sort objects alphabetically.  
Complete the following steps set the display options:  
1. In the User Preferences window, click the Display options tab.  
2. From the System tree sorting list, select chronological or alphabetical.  
Note: This action is not supported in bootable-CD mode.  
3. From the Capacity display units list, select one of the following:  
v MB (megabytes)  
v GB (gigabytes)  
v TB (terabytes)  
v Auto-select  
Choose Auto-select to let the ServeRAID Manager choose the unit of measure  
for you, based on the drive size. With this option, the ServeRAID Manager may  
display different drives with different units.  
4. Click OK.  
Monitoring systems over a network  
You can monitor other systems over a network. To do so, the ServeRAID Manager  
must be installed and running on your local system and on the other systems.  
150 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Then, you can add the remote systems to your ServeRAID Manager Enterprise  
view. Also, you can choose to use the ServeRAID Manager agent, instead of the  
ServeRAID Manager program.  
Note: You cannot monitor other systems when using:  
v ServeRAID Manager in bootable-CD mode  
v ServeRAID Manager as a plug-in application  
In addition to the ServeRAID Manager, you can use the following:  
v
The Notification Manager is a tool that you can use to notify other systems  
running the ServeRAID Manager of all events that occur on this (that is, the  
local) system.  
v Use the Email Notification Manager to notify users by email when events occur  
on the local system. You can send email notifications to anyone on the network;  
the recipient does not have to be running ServeRAID Manager.  
v Use the Task Manager to manage scheduled tasks on local or remote systems,  
such as logical drive migration or synchronization. You can modify the task  
schedule, delete the scheduled task, or view task properties.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Using the Notification Manager:  
Note: You cannot use the Notification Manager when using:  
v ServeRAID Manager in bootable-CD mode  
v ServeRAID Manager as a plug-in application  
The Notification Manager is a tool that you can use to notify other systems  
running the ServeRAID Manager of all events that occur on this (that is, the local)  
system. The user of the system types system names in the notification list. Each  
system in the list is notified of all events that occur on the local system.  
You can use the Notification Manager to:  
v
v
v
v
v
The Notification Manager is enabled by default. To disable the Notification  
Manager, click Actions Disable notifications . If you disable the Notification  
Manager, the events are generated, but not dispatched to remote systems.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 151  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
An example  
You install SystemA in a lab with a ServeRAID Manager subsystem. You run the  
ServeRAID Manager on SystemA to monitor for events and problems, but you  
want to monitor from your workstation and not from SystemA. You open the  
SystemA Notification Manager from the ServeRAID Manager and define your  
workstation in the notification list. When running the ServeRAID Manager from  
your workstation, you are notified of all problems and events that occur on  
SystemA.  
Note: You can use the Email Notification Manager to notify users of events by  
email. This allows you to notify users who have not installed or are not  
currently running ServeRAID Manager.  
The Notification Manager and its events  
Events generated by the Notification Manager include the following:  
v Progress information, such as rebuilds, synchronizations, and migrations.  
v Problems, such as defunct physical drives and PFA errors.  
v Changes to the local configuration, such as creating a hot-spare drive or defining  
a logical drive.  
When an event is generated on a system, the Notification Manager connects with  
each system in the notification list and relays the event to these systems’  
ServeRAID Manager. If the Notification Manager successfully connects and sends  
the event, the notification list updates its Last event sentcolumn. If the  
Notification Manager does not successfully connect or send the event, the  
Notification Manager:  
v Updates the Last event sentcolumn with a  
notifying you of a problem.  
v Logs an event in the Notification Manager event viewer detailing why the event  
could not be sent.  
The Notification Manager interface  
The Notification Manager consists of the following:  
Toolbar  
Provides quick-path icons for common tasks.  
Notification list  
Displays the remote systems configured to receive event notification.  
Notification event viewer  
Displays status information for the Notification Manager.  
In addition to displaying the events in the event viewer, the Notification  
Manager appends each event to a logging file, RAIDNOT.LOG. If this file  
exceeds 200 KB, the ServeRAID Manager copies the file to RAIDNOT.OLD  
and creates a new RAIDNOT.LOG. If there is a RAIDNOT.OLD already,  
the ServeRAID Manager overwrites it.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
152 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
v
v
v
v
v
Notification Manager menubar: The Notification Manager menu bar has the  
following functions:  
File >  
Clear event log  
Click Notification Manager from the menu. Clears the current  
contents of the Notification Manager event viewer. This option  
does not clear or delete the event logging file.  
Close Closes the Notification Manager.  
View >  
Toolbar  
Turns the toolbar on and off. The default is on (selected).  
Actions >  
Help >  
Information about this window  
View context-sensitive information for the current window.  
Search  
Searches for one or more specified words in ServeRAID Manager  
Assist and displays a list of topics that include the words.  
Contents  
Presents the ServeRAID Manager Assist contents. You can use the  
contents to acquaint yourself with ServeRAID Manager Assist  
topics.  
About ServeRAID Manager  
Reports the ServeRAID Manager version number, copyright, and  
legal information.  
Notification Manager toolbar: The Notification Manager toolbar has the following  
functions:  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 153  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Information about this window View context-sensitive information for the  
current window.  
Adding a system in the Notification Manager:  
Note: This action is not supported when using the ServeRAID Manager in  
bootable-CD mode.  
Use this action to add a new system to the notification list. Every new system that  
you add to the list is notified of all events that occur on this system.  
1. Click  
(Add system).  
2. Type the host name or TCP/IP address of the system that you want to add.  
3. Type the TCP/IP port for the remote system Startup port number. The default  
port is 34571. If you changed the system Startup port number in the User  
Preferences window on the remote system, type that number here.  
4. Click Add.  
5. Continue to add systems, or click Cancel to close the window.  
After you add the system to the notification list, the ServeRAID Manager will  
attempt to connect to the remote system and send an initial set of events. The  
Manager uses these events to update the ServeRAID Manager interface running on  
the remote system.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
Deleting a system in the Notification Manager:  
Note: This action is not supported when using the following:  
v ServeRAID Manager in bootable-CD mode  
v ServeRAID Manager as a plug-in application  
Use this action to delete a remote system from the notification list. After deleting  
the remote system, the Notification Manager no longer notifies the remote system  
of events occurring on the local system.  
1. Click the system you want to delete from the notification list.  
2. Click  
(Delete system).  
3. Click Yes to confirm. The Notification Manager deletes the system from the  
notification list.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
154 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Monitoring events sent from the Notification Manager: For each system in the  
notification list, you can view details about the last event the Notification Manager  
sent (or tried to send) to that system.  
In the notification list, double-click the Last event sent column for the system in  
which you are interested. The Last Event Detail window opens. This window  
contains information about the last event the Notification Manager sent (or tried to  
send) to the selected system. The event information includes the following: status,  
type, date, time, source, target, and description.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
Modifying a system in the Notification Manager:  
Note: This action is not supported when using the following:  
v ServeRAID Manager in bootable-CD mode  
v ServeRAID Manager as a plug-in application  
Use this action to modify a remote system host name, TCP/IP address, or port  
number:  
1. Click the system that you want to modify from the notification list.  
2. Click  
(Modify system). The System Properties window opens.  
3. Change the system properties in the appropriate entry fields.  
4. Click OK.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
Sending a test event in the Notification Manager:  
Note: This action is not supported when using the following:  
v ServeRAID Manager in bootable-CD mode  
v ServeRAID Manager as a plug-in application  
Use this action to send a test event to a remote system:  
1. Click the system in the notification list that you want to send a test event.  
Note: If you click no system or more than one system, this action is disabled.  
2. Click Actions Send test event. A window opens to report success or failure.  
The remote system will respond to the test event with a beep.  
3. Click OK.  
If the test fails, verify the following and try the test send again:  
1. You typed the correct TCP/IP information.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2. The ServeRAID Manager is running on the remote system.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
Changing the alarm settings:  
Note: This action is not supported in bootable-CD mode.  
Warning and Error events cause an audible alarm to sound every five minutes,  
notifying you of the event. Any Error or Warning event can trigger the alarm if the  
event causes the system to enter the critical state or the event arrives while the  
system status is critical. Once triggered, the repeating alarm continues to sound as  
long as any system in the ServeRAID Manager Enterprise view is critical.  
Some events, such as the non-warranted drive event, do not affect the system  
status in the Enterprise view; if the system status is not critical, these events will  
not sound the alarm.  
You can adjust the alarm settings with the following steps:  
1. In the User Preferences window, click the Alarm settings tab.  
2. Select the check box to enable or disable the repeating alarm.  
Note: If you disable the alarm, you will not hear an audible alarm when you  
receive problem events.  
3. If you have enabled the alarm, you can adjust the time interval (in seconds)  
that you want between each alarm. The default is 300 seconds (5 minutes).  
4. If you have enabled the alarm, you can adjust the length of time (in beeps) that  
you want the alarm to continue. The default is 3 beeps.  
5. Click OK.  
6. Restart the ServeRAID Manager for these settings to take effect.  
Using the Email Notification Manager:  
Note: You cannot use the Email Notification Manager when using:  
v ServeRAID Manager in bootable-CD mode  
v ServeRAID Manager as a plug-in application  
The Email Notification Manager is a tool that you can use to notify users by e-mail  
of events that occur on this (that is, the local) system. The user of the system types  
recipient names and e-mail addresses in the e-mail notification list. Each recipient  
in the list is notified of all or selected events that occur on the local system.  
You can use the Email Notification Manager to:  
v
v
v
v
v
156 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v
The Email Notification Manager is enabled by default. To disable the Email  
Notification Manager, click Actions Disable Email Notifications . If you disable  
the Email Notification Manager, events are generated but users do not receive  
e-mail notification when the events occur.  
An example  
You install SystemA in a lab with a ServeRAID Manager subsystem. You run the  
ServeRAID Manager on SystemA to monitor for events and problems. You want to  
monitor SystemA from your workstation but do not have ServeRAID Manager  
installed. You open the SystemA Email Notification Manager from the ServeRAID  
Manager and add your name and e-mail address to the e-mail notification list. You  
are notified by e-mail of all problems and events that occur on SystemA.  
The Email Notification Manager and its events  
Events monitored by the Email Notification Manager include the following:  
v Progress information, such as rebuilds, synchronizations, and migrations.  
v Problems, such as defunct physical drives and PFA errors.  
v Changes to the local configuration, such as creating a hot-spare drive or defining  
a logical drive.  
Each event has an event type indicating its severity: error, warning, or  
informational. You can configure a recipient to be notified of errors, errors and  
warnings, or errors, warnings, and informational events.  
When an event is generated on a system, the Email Notification Manager attempts  
to send a message to each recipient in the email notification list. If the Email  
Notification Manager successfully sends the message, it updates the Last message  
sentcolumn in the email notification list. If the Email Notification Manager does  
not successfully connect or send the message, the Email Notification Manager:  
v Updates the Last message sentcolumn with a  
notifying you of a problem.  
v Logs an event in the Email Notification Manager event viewer detailing why the  
message could not be sent.  
The Email Notification Manager interface  
The Email Notification Manager consists of the following:  
Toolbar  
Provides quick-path icons for common tasks.  
Email notification list  
Displays the recipients configured to receive e-mail notifications.  
Email notification event viewer  
Displays status information for the Email Notification Manager.  
In addition to displaying the events in the event viewer, the Email  
Notification Manager appends each event to a logging file,  
RAIDSMTP.LOG. If this file exceeds 200 KB, the ServeRAID Manager  
copies the file to RAIDSMTP.OLD and creates a new RAIDSMTP.LOG. If  
there is a RAIDSMTP.OLD already, the ServeRAID Manager overwrites it.  
The Email Notification Manager appends SMTP transport errors in a  
separate log file, SMTPERR.LOG.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 157  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
About Email Notification Manager:  
Email Notification Manager menu bar: The Email Notification Manager menu bar  
has the following functions:  
File →  
Clear event log  
Click Email Notifications from the menu. Clears the current contents  
of the Email Notification Manager event viewer. This option does not  
clear or delete the event logging file.  
Close Closes the Email Notification Manager.  
View →  
Toolbar  
Turns the toolbar on and off. The default is on (selected).  
Actions →  
Help →  
Information about this window  
View context-sensitive information for the current window.  
Search  
Searches for one or more specified words in ServeRAID Manager  
Assist and displays a list of topics that include the words.  
Contents  
Presents the ServeRAID Manager Assist contents. You can use the  
contents to acquaint yourself with ServeRAID Manager Assist topics.  
158 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
About ServeRAID Manager  
Reports the ServeRAID Manager version number, copyright, and legal  
information.  
Email Notification Manager menu bar: The Email Notification Manager menu bar  
has the following functions:  
File >  
Close Closes the Email Notification Manager.  
View >  
Toolbar  
Turns the toolbar on and off. The default is on (selected).  
Actions >  
Help >  
Information about this window  
View context-sensitive information for the current window.  
Search  
Searches for one or more specified words in ServeRAID Manager  
Assist and displays a list of topics that include the words.  
Contents  
Presents the ServeRAID Manager Assist contents. You can use the  
contents to acquaint yourself with ServeRAID Manager Assist  
topics.  
About ServeRAID Manager  
Reports the ServeRAID Manager version number, copyright, and  
legal information.  
Email Notification Manager toolbar: The Email Notification Manager toolbar has the  
following functions:  
Information about this window View context-sensitive information for the  
current window.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 159  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Email Notification Manager toolbar: The Email Notification Manager toolbar has the  
following functions:  
Information about this window  
View context-sensitive information  
for the current window.  
The Email Notification Manager Message Format: When an event is generated on a  
system, the Email Notification Manager sends a message to each recipient in the  
email notification list. The message format is:  
To: <recipient email address>  
From: <administrator email adress>  
Subject: ServeRAID Manager Event Notification - Event type <event type>  
This message was generated by ServeRAID Manager Agent.  
Please do not reply to this message.  
Event Description: <event description>  
Event Type: <event type>  
Event Source: <agent domain name>  
Date: <date>  
Time: <time>  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
The Email Notification Manager Message Format: When an event is generated on a  
system, the Email Notification Manager sends a message to each recipient in the  
email notification list. The message format is:  
From: <management station email adress>  
Sent: <date>  
To: <recipient email address>  
Subject: <management station> - <Event message>  
This message was generated by the ServeRAID Manager. Please  
do not reply to this message.  
160 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Event Description: <event description>  
Event Type: <event type>  
Event Source: <management station> / <IP address>  
Time: <date> <time>  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
Adding a recipient to the Email Notification Manager:  
Note: This action is not supported when using the following:  
v ServeRAID Manager in bootable-CD mode  
v ServeRAID Manager as a plug-in application  
Use this action to add a recipient to the email notification list. Every recipient that  
you add to the list is notified of all or selected events that occur on this system.  
1. Click  
(Add recipient).  
2. Type the name of the recipient that you want to add to the list.  
3. Type the recipient’s e-mail address. Include the user name and domain, such as  
4. Select the type of event you want the recipient to be notified of: error, error and  
warning, or error, warning, and informational.  
5. Click Add.  
6. Continue to add recipients, or click Cancel to close the window.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
Deleting a recipient from the Email Notification Manager:  
Note: This action is not supported when using the following:  
v ServeRAID Manager in bootable-CD mode  
v ServeRAID Manager as a plug-in application  
Use this action to delete a recipient from the e-mail notification list. After deleting  
a recipient, the Email Notification Manager no longer notifies the user of events  
occurring on the local system.  
1. Click the recipient you want to delete from the e-mail notification list.  
2. Click  
(Delete recipient).  
3. Click Yes to confirm. The Email Notification Manager deletes the recipient from  
the e-mail notification list.  
More information  
v
v
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 161  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v
v
v
Modifying a recipient in the Email Notification Manager:  
Note: This action is not supported when using the following:  
v ServeRAID Manager in bootable-CD mode  
v ServeRAID Manager as a plug-in application  
Use this action to modify an e-mail recipient name, address, or event type:  
1. Click the recipient that you want to modify in the e-mail notification list.  
2. Click  
(Modify email recipient). The Modify Email Recipient window opens.  
3. Change the recipient properties in the appropriate fields.  
4. Click OK.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
Sending a test message in the Email Notification Manager:  
Note: This action is not supported when using the following:  
v ServeRAID Manager in bootable-CD mode  
v ServeRAID Manager as a plug-in application  
Use this action to send a test message to a recipient in the e-mail notification list:  
1. Click the recipient in the e-mail notification list that you want to send a test  
message.  
Note: If you click no recipient or more than one recipient, this action is  
disabled.  
2. Click Actions Send test message. If the Email Notification Manager does not  
successfully connect or send the message, it:  
v Updates the Last message sentcolumn with a  
notifying you of a  
problem.  
v Logs an event in the Email Notification Manager event viewer detailing why  
the message could not be sent.  
3. Click OK.  
If the test fails, verify the following and try the test again:  
1. You typed the correct e-mail address when you added the recipient to the  
Email Notification Manager.  
2. You typed the correct SMTP server address when you configured the Email  
Notification Manager.  
More information  
v
v
162 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v
v
v
Monitoring messages sent from the Email Notification Manager: For each recipient in  
the e-mail notification list, you can view details about the last message the Email  
Notification Manager sent (or tried to send) to that recipient.  
In the e-mail notification list, double-click the Last message sent column for the  
recipient in which you are interested. The Last Message Detail window opens. This  
window contains information about the last message the Email Notification  
Manager sent (or tried to send) to the recipient. The message information includes  
the following: status, type, date, time, source, target, and description.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
Configuring the Email Notification Manager:  
Note: This action is not supported when using the following:  
v ServeRAID Manager in bootable-CD mode  
v ServeRAID Manager as a plug-in application  
Use this action to specify the SMTP server address and the administrator’s reply  
toaddress. The reply to address typically is the address of the ServeRAID  
Manager system administrator or IT or network administrator.  
1. Click Actions SMTP server settings. The SMTP server settings window  
appears.  
2. Type the SMTP server address. You can enter the host name, including domain,  
or the TCP/IP address.  
3. Type the administrator’s reply to address. Include the user name and domain,  
such as [email protected].  
4. Click OK.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
v
Adding a recipient to the Email Notification Manager: Use this action to add a  
recipient to the e-mail notification list. You can add one recipient only, typically the  
ServeRAID Manager administrator, or system or network administrator. The  
recipient is notified of all or selected events that occur on the enclosure(s)  
connected to the management station.  
1. Click  
(Add e-mail recipient). The Add e-mail Recipient window opens.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 163  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2. In the To e-mail address field, type the name of the recipient that you want to  
add to the list. Include the user name and domain, such as  
3. Select the type of event(s) you want the recipient to be notified of: error,  
warning, or informational.  
4. Click Add.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
Configuring the Email Notification Manager: Use this action to specify the SMTP  
server address and the fromaddress of the e-mail sender. The default from″  
address includes a generalized management station name and a partial e-mail  
address of the form <name@%s>. Replace the the partial address with the address  
you want to appear in the From field of the e-mail message.  
1. Click Actions SMTP server settings. The SMTP Server Settings window  
opens.  
2. Type the SMTP server address. You can enter the host name, including domain,  
or the TCP/IP address.  
3. Type the from address, replacing the general management station name and  
e-mail address with the name and address you want to appear in the From  
field of the e-mail message.  
4. Click Add.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
Deleting a recipient from the Email Notification Manager: Use this action to delete a  
recipient from the email notification list. After deleting a recipient, the Email  
Notification Manager no longer notifies the user of events occurring on the  
enclosure(s) connected to the management station.  
1. In the e-mail notification list, click the recipient you want to delete.  
2. Click  
(Delete e-mail recipient).  
3. Click Yes to confirm. The Email Notification Manager deletes the recipient from  
the e-mail notification list.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
Modifying a recipient in the Email Notification Manager: Use this action to modify the  
e-mail recipient’s address or monitored event types:  
1. In the e-mail notification list, click the recipient that you want to modify.  
2. Click  
(Modify email recipient). The Modify Email Recipient window opens.  
164 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3. Change the recipient properties in the appropriate fields.  
4. Click Modify.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
Sending a test message in the Email Notification Manager: Use this action to send a  
test message to a recipient in the email notification list:  
1. Click a recipient in the e-mail notification list.  
Note: This action is disabled if you do not click a recipient.  
2. Click Actions Send test message.  
If the test fails, verify the following and try the test again:  
1. You typed the correct e-mail address when you added the recipient to the  
Email Notification Manager.  
2. You typed the correct SMTP server address when you configured the Email  
Notification Manager.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
Using the Task Manager:  
Note: You cannot use the Task Manager in bootable-CD mode or when using the  
ServeRAID Manager as a plug-in application.  
The Task Manager is a tool that you can use to manage scheduled tasks, such as a  
the Task Manager displays the task start time, status, and description.  
You can use the Task Manager to:  
v
v
v
The Task Manager is enabled by default. To disable the Task Manager, click  
Actions Disable Task Scheduler .  
Note: If you disable the Task Manager, a task may miss its start time. To run the  
task, you must reschedule it. See Understanding scheduled tasks for more  
about missed start times.  
An example  
You schedule a synchronization task with an initial start time of Sunday, October  
13, 2003 at 2:00 AM. Due to a power outage, the task misses its start time. The Task  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 165  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Manager flags the error. The next day, you modify the task schedule to run on  
Sunday October 20, 2003 at 2:00 AM.  
The Task Manager status  
If a scheduled task runs successfully, the Task Manager updates the Status″  
column in the task list with Complete. For recurring tasks, an asterisk (*) indicates  
that the task has completed one cycle and is scheduled to run again at the given  
interval. If a scheduled task does not run successfully, the Task Manager:  
v Updates the Statuscolumn in the task list with Error.  
v Updates the first column of the task list with a  
, notifying you of a  
if the error is  
recoverable error (a warning message); it displays a  
non-recoverable (a critical error).  
To see details about the error, use View task properties. See Understanding  
scheduled tasks for more about Task Manager status, start time validation, missed  
start times, and error conditions.  
The Task Manager interface  
The Task Manager consists of the following:  
Toolbar  
Provides quick-path icons for common tasks.  
Task list  
Displays the scheduled tasks.  
Task event viewer  
Displays status information for the Task Manager.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Task Manager menu bar: The Task Manager menu bar has the following functions:  
File →  
Clear event log  
Click Task from the menu. Clears the current contents of the Task  
Manager event viewer.  
Close Closes the Task Manager.  
View →  
Toolbar  
Turns the toolbar on and off. The default is on (selected).  
Actions →  
166 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Disable Task Scheduler  
Turns the Task Scheduler on and off. The default is on.  
Help →  
Information about this window  
View context-sensitive information for the current window.  
Search  
Searches for one or more specified words in ServeRAID Manager  
Assist and displays a list of topics that include the words.  
Contents  
Presents the ServeRAID controller Assist contents. You can use the  
contents to acquaint yourself with ServeRAID Manager Assist topics.  
About ServeRAID Manager  
Reports the ServeRAID Manager version number, copyright, and legal  
information.  
Task Manager toolbar: The Task Manager toolbar has the following functions:  
Information about this window  
View context-sensitive information  
for the current window.  
Starting the Task Manager: Use this action to start the Task Manager. You must start  
the Task Manager to manage scheduled tasks.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(system).  
2. From the Actionsmenu, select Agent actions Configure. The ServeRAID  
Manager Agent window opens.  
3. Click the Task note tab.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 167  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Modifying a scheduled task in the Task Manager:  
Note: This action is not supported when using the following:  
v ServeRAID Manager in bootable-CD mode  
v ServeRAID Manager as a plug-in application  
Use this action to modify a scheduled task’s start time and date, description, and  
recurrence interval (if the task can be recurring):  
1. Click the task that you want to modify in the task list.  
2. Click  
(Modify task). The Modify Task window opens.  
3. Change the task properties in the appropriate fields.  
4. Click OK.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
Deleting a scheduled task from the Task Manager:  
Note: This action is not supported when using the following:  
v ServeRAID Manager in bootable-CD mode  
v ServeRAID Manager as a plug-in application  
Use this action to delete a scheduled task from the task list. After deleting a task,  
the Task Manager no longer attempts to run the task at the scheduled time.  
1. Click the task you want to delete from the task list.  
2. Click  
(Delete task).  
3. Click Yes to confirm. The Task Manager deletes the task from the task list.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
Viewing task properties from the Task Manager: You can view details about each task  
in the task list.  
In the task list, double-click the task in which you are interested. The Task  
Properties window opens. This window contains information about the task,  
including the following: description, task ID, start time, recurrence interval, and  
last time a recurring task started. An error description appears if the Task Manager  
flagged an error for the task.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
168 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v
Monitoring storage enclosures on a network: You can monitor network-attached  
storage enclosures from a ServeRAID Manager console running on the local  
system. The ServeRAID Manager management station software must be installed  
and running on the system to which the storage enclosure is attached. Then, you  
can add a management station to your ServeRAID Manager Enterprise view.  
You can configure the management station to monitor and manage  
network-attached storage:  
v Use the Security Manager to allow users to configure and view enclosure  
information from remote systems.  
v Use the Email Notification Manager to notify users by email when events occur  
on the enclosures attached to the management station. You can send email  
notifications to any user on the network; the recipient does not have to be  
running ServeRAID Manager.  
v Use the SNMP Trap Manager to notify other systems running an SNMP console  
of all SNMP traps that occur on the enclosures attached to the management  
station.  
More information  
v
v
v
Using the Security Manager: Use the Security Manager to give users the ability to  
connect to a management station from remote systems and configure and view the  
attached enclosures. You must configure at least one user name and password  
before any user can connect to the management station.  
Note: You cannot disable security for a management station.  
Use the following actions in the Security Manager to manage users’ ability to  
configure and view network storage from remote systems:  
v
v
v
The first time you open the Security Manager, the ServeRAID Manager prompts  
you to type an Admin (administrator) password. Either type a password or click  
Cancel to not have an Admin user.  
The Security Manager interface  
The Security Manager consists of the following:  
Toolbar  
Provides quick-path icons for common tasks.  
Security list  
Displays the users with access to this management station.  
The Security Manager logs events to a logging file, RAIDSEC.LOG. If this file  
exceeds 200 KB, the ServeRAID Manager copies the file to RAIDSEC.OLD and  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 169  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
creates a new RAIDSEC.LOG. If there is a RAIDSEC.OLD already, the ServeRAID  
Manager overwrites it.  
More information  
v
v
v
Using the SNMP Trap Manager: Use the SNMP Trap Manager to notify other  
systems running an SNMP console of all SNMP traps that occur on the enclosures  
connected to a management station. You add system names to the SNMP traps list.  
Each system in the list is notified of all traps that occur on the enclosure.  
You can use the SNMP Trap Manager to:  
v
v
v
v
The SNMP Trap Manager is enabled by default. To disable the SNMP Trap  
Manager, click Actions Disable SNMP Traps . If you disable the SNMP Trap  
Manager, the SNMP traps are generated, but not dispatched to remote systems.  
An example  
You install SystemA in a lab with a network-attached storage enclosure. You  
configure SystemA to send SNMP traps from the enclosure, but you want to  
monitor the traps from your workstation, not SystemA. You open the SystemA  
SNMP Trap Manager from the ServeRAID Manager and define your workstation in  
the SNMP traps list. When running the SNMP console from your workstation, you  
are notified of all SNMP traps that occur on the enclosures attached to SystemA.  
The SNMP Trap Manager and traps  
Traps generated by SNMP include the following:  
v Progress information, such as rebuilds, synchronizing, and migrations.  
v Problems, such as defunct physical drives and PFA errors.  
v Changes to the local configuration, such as adding or replacing a controller.  
When an SNMP trap is generated on an enclosure, the SNMP Trap Manager  
connects with each system in the SNMP traps list and relays the trap to these  
systems’ SNMP consoles.  
The SNMP Trap Manager also logs each trap to a logging file, RaidSNMP.log. If  
this file exceeds 200 KB, the Manager copies the file to RaidSNMP.old and creates a  
new RaidSNMP.log. If there is a RaidSNMP.old already, the Manager overwrites it.  
The SNMP Trap Manager interface  
The SNMP Trap Manager consists of the following:  
Toolbar  
Provides quick-path icons for common tasks.  
170 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
SNMP traps destination list  
Displays the remote systems configured to receive SNMP traps.  
More information  
v
v
v
Using the Email Notification Manager: Use the Email Notification Manager to notify  
users by e-mail of events that occur on enclosures connected to a management  
station. You type the recipient’s name and e-mail address in the e-mail notification  
list. The recipient is notified of all or selected events that occur on the enclosure.  
You can use the Email Notification Manager to:  
v
v
v
v
v
The Email Notification Manager is enabled by default. To disable the Email  
Notification Manager, click Actions Disable Email Notifications. If you disable  
the Email Notification Manager, events are generated but users do not receive  
e-mail notification when the events occur.  
An example  
You install SystemA in a lab with a network-attached storage enclosure. You add a  
management station agent on SystemA to monitor for events and problems. You  
want to monitor SystemA from your workstation but do not have ServeRAID  
Manager installed. You open the SystemA Email Notification Manager from the  
ServeRAID Manager and add your name and e-mail address to the e-mail  
notification list. You are notified by e-mail of all problems and events that occur on  
the enclosure attached to SystemA.  
The Email Notification Manager and its events  
Events monitored by the Email Notification Manager include the following:  
v Progress information, such as rebuilds, synchronizing, and migrations.  
v Problems, such as defunct physical drives and PFA errors.  
v Changes to the local configuration, such as creating a hot-spare drive or defining  
a logical drive.  
Each event has an event type indicating its severity: error, warning, or  
informational. You can configure a recipient to be notified of errors, errors and  
warnings, or errors, warnings, and informational events.  
The Email Notification Manager logs events to a logging file, RAIDSMTP.LOG. If  
this file exceeds 200 KB, the ServeRAID Manager copies the file to  
RAIDSMTP.OLD and creates a new RAIDSMTP.LOG. If there is a RAIDSMTP.OLD  
already, the ServeRAID Manager overwrites it. The Email Notification Manager  
appends SMTP transport errors in a separate log file, SMTPERR.LOG.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 171  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
The Email Notification Manager interface  
The Email Notification Manager consists of the following:  
Toolbar  
Provides quick-path icons for common tasks.  
Email notification list  
Displays the recipients configured to receive e-mail notifications.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
Modifying logical drives using the Configuration wizard  
Understanding logical-drive migration  
Logical-drive migration is a powerful and flexible feature of ServeRAID controllers.  
You can use logical-drive migration to:  
v Change the RAID level of existing logical drives  
v Increase array free space, so you can create additional logical drives  
v Increase the size of an existing logical drive  
You can migrate a logical drive while the server is running with only minor  
performance degradation for users during the process. You can start the migration  
immediately or schedule it for a later date and time.  
HostRAID controllers do not support logical drive migration.  
Note: To perform a logical-drive migration, the following must be true:  
v For ServeRAID SCSI controllers, no more than seven logical drives  
currently exist.  
During logical-drive migration, the ServeRAID Manager creates one  
logical drive for temporary use. (You must have an extra logical drive  
onto which the data can migrate.) The ServeRAID Manager sets this  
logical drive to the system state. When migration is complete, this logical  
drive is removed.  
v The logical drive that you have selected to migrate must be in the okay  
state.  
v For ServeRAID SCSI controllers, the logical drive cannot be configured  
with RAID level-00, 10, 1E0, 50, or 5EE.  
If a physical drive fails during a logical-drive migration and you are migrating  
between RAID levels other than RAID level-0, the migration will continue and  
complete. Then, you must replace and rebuild the failed physical drive.  
Logical-drive migrations also can recover from a power failure. If power is lost to  
the server during a logical-drive migration, the migration will restart as soon as  
power is restored, and complete without data corruption.  
Note: (Cluster and failover configurations only) A logical drive will not failover  
while undergoing logical-drive migration.  
172 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
Example: Increasing free space: Create an array with three physical drives. Then,  
create two logical drives (labeled 1 and 2) in the array such that you have no  
available free space. The logical drive stripes look similar to the following.  
Later, you decide to create another logical drive in the array. First, you must create  
some free space by adding more physical drives to the array.  
If you add two more physical drives to the array, the logical drives migrate such  
that they are striped across all five drives. The ServeRAID Manager retains the size  
of the logical drive by decreasing the size of each block on a physical drive. The  
space in the logical drives does not increase, so there is free space across the  
bottom portion of each physical drive (labeled 3).  
When the operation is complete, use Create logical driveto create a new logical  
drive in the free space.  
When increasing free space, you can add up to three physical drives, as long as the  
sum of the physical drives does not exceed the maximum number of physical  
drives allowed for the array. The maximum number of physical drives you can  
have in an array is limited by the controller stripe-unit size.  
Example: Increasing the logical drive size:  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 173  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Create an array with three physical drives. Then, create two logical drives (labeled  
1 and 2) in the array such that you have no available free space. The logical drive  
stripes look similar to the following.  
Later, you decide you need additional space in the logical drives in the array. First,  
you must add more physical drives to the array.  
Note: Blocks are labeled as x and * in these examples. All blocks labeled x are the  
same size in logical drive 1. All blocks labeled * are the same size in logical  
drive 2.  
If you add two additional physical drives to the array, the logical drives migrate  
such that they are striped across all five drives. The ServeRAID Manager expands  
the size of each logical drive in proportion to the original configuration. If there  
originally was free space in the array, the free space is increased also.  
When increasing logical drive space, you can add up to three physical drives, as  
long as the sum of the physical drives does not exceed the maximum physical  
drives allowed for the array. The maximum number of physical drives you can  
have in an array is limited by the controller stripe-unit size.  
For ServeRAID SAS controllers (8i/8k/8k-l) and the ServeRAID-7t  
controller, the ServeRAID Manager does not enforce the three physical drive limit  
when increasing logical drive size.  
174 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
Understanding scheduled tasks: The ServeRAID Manager Task Scheduler allows  
you to run lengthy operations at a convenient time, such as a logical drive  
migration or synchronizing a logical drive. All schedulable tasks work the same  
way: To schedule a migration, for example, you perform the standard set of steps;  
then, in the last step, you can choose to run the task immediately or to schedule it  
for another time.  
You can run the task at the given date and time or make it a recurring task. If the  
task is recurring, it runs on a regular basis according to the interval you choose:  
the same time each day, the same time each week, or the same time each month.  
Not all tasks can be recurring tasks. For example, a logical drive migration cannot  
be a recurring task.  
The Task Manager is a tool that you can use to manage scheduled tasks. It allows  
you to:  
v
v
v
Start time validation  
When you schedule a task, it executes on the agent machine which may be a  
remote machine in a different time zone. To prevent scheduling problems due to  
time differences between the agent and client machines, the Task Scheduler  
performs the following checks:  
v To accommodate differences in times zones, you can schedule a task up to 23  
hours in the past, pending approval by the agent.  
v If the agent determines that the task is scheduled in the past (based on the local  
time on the agent machine), it will reject the task and you will be prompted to  
select a different date and time.  
Missed start times  
If a non-recurring task misses its start time, the Task Manager flags it with an  
error. You must modify the task schedule if you want to run it at another time.  
If a recurring task misses its start time, it is rescheduled to run at the next  
scheduled interval. Example: a recurring task runs every Monday at 1:00 AM. The  
agent machine is powered off at that time. When you restart the agent machine,  
the missed task is rescheduled to run the following Monday at 1:00 AM.  
Note: To accommodate temporary or brief interruptions on the agent machine,  
each task has a 30-minute grace period built into its start time. Example: a  
task is scheduled to run at 10:00 PM. A power outage lasts 20 minutes, from  
9:55 PM to 10:15 PM. The task runs at 10:15 PM.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 175  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Error conditions  
When a scheduled task does not run successfully, the Task Manager displays an  
error icon and updates the Statuscolumn with an Error. If a task misses its start  
time, it is flagged with a warning error condition. You must reschedule the task to  
clear the error. If the error is non-recoverable it is considered critical. You must  
delete the task from the Task Manager; to reschedule it, you must create a new  
task. To see details about the error, use View task properties; examine the Error  
Description field for a description of what went wrong and what caused the task  
to fail.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Extending a partition on a logical drive: (Microsoft Windows 2000, Windows XP,  
Windows Server 2003, and Windows NT 4.0 only)  
If you have increased the size of a logical drive, you can extend the partition on  
that logical drive to use the newly added space.  
Notes:  
v To complete this procedure, you must be logged on as one of the  
following:  
– An administrator  
– A member of the Administrators group  
v If your server is connected to a network, network policy settings might  
prevent you from completing this procedure.  
Windows 2000, Windows XP, Windows Server 2003  
1. After completing Increase logical drive space,shut down and restart the  
server.  
2. In the lower-left corner of the desktop, click Start Programs Administrative  
Tools Computer Management. The Computer Management window opens.  
3. Right-mouse click the volume and click Extend Volume.  
4. Follow the Extend Volume wizard instructions.  
Notes:  
v You cannot extend the following types of volumes:  
– Striped  
– Mirrored  
– RAID level-5  
– FAT or FAT32 format  
– System  
176 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
– Startup (boot)  
– Simple or extended volumes that were upgraded from basic to  
dynamic.  
v You can extend a volume only if the volume is formatted using NTFS or  
does not contain a file system.  
v You can extend a simple or extended volume only if the volume was  
created as a dynamic volume.  
v You can extend a simple volume if the extension will occur within its  
original physical drive or onto additional physical drives.  
v After a volume is extended onto multiple drives (spanned), it cannot be  
mirrored or striped.  
v You can extend simple and spanned volumes on dynamic disks onto a  
maximum of 32 dynamic disks.  
v After a spanned volume is extended, you cannot delete any portion of  
the volume without deleting the entire spanned volume.  
Windows NT 4.0  
1. After completing Increase logical drive space,shut down and restart the  
server.  
2. In the lower-left corner of the desktop, click Start Programs Administrative  
Tools (Common) Disk Administrator. The Disk Administrator window  
opens.  
3. Hold the Ctrl key down and right-click both the old volume and the new free  
space on the logical drive; then, click Extend Volume Set.  
4. Type the total size you want for the partition.  
5. Click OK.  
6. Right-mouse click the volume and click Commit Changes Now. A confirmation  
window opens.  
7. Click Yes. Another confirmation window opens.  
8. Click Yes.  
Notes:  
v You can extend a volume only if it is formatted using NTFS. You must  
convert FAT volume sets to NTFS before you can extend them.  
v You can extend volume sets onto a maximum of 32 physical drives.  
v You cannot extend the volume where the Windows NT 4.0 system files  
reside.  
v After a volume is extended, you cannot delete any portion of the volume  
without deleting the entire volume.  
More information  
v
v
Configuration wizard notes and attentions: While you are creating the  
configuration, the ServeRAID Manager reports notes and attentions regarding the  
configuration in the event viewer. These events can help you create a better or  
more optimized configuration.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 177  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Array storage space still available.  
Explanation: You can create another logical drive in this array or make a logical  
drive in this array larger.  
Physical drives contain unusable capacity.  
Explanation: You could redefine your arrays with the same size drive capacities to  
avoid wasting space.  
There is(are) n ready drive(s) still available. (Where n is a number)  
Explanation: You can create another array, add the remaining ready drives to one  
of the new arrays, or create a hot-spare drive.  
This hot-spare drive will not work for any defined array.  
Explanation: This hot-spare drive is not large enough to replace a failed drive in  
any array, or there are no redundant logical drives.  
Modifying logical drives on ServeRAID SCSI controllers  
(ServeRAID series 3, 4, 5, 6, and 7K)  
Changing the RAID level:  
Note: This action is not supported on the integrated RAID controller.  
You can change the RAID levels of currently defined logical drives. To use  
Change RAID level,all of the logical drives within the array must be the same  
RAID level.  
Note:  
1. If the logical drive is RAID level-00, 10, 1E0, 50, or 5EE, you cannot  
change the logical drive to another RAID level. If the logical drive is  
RAID level-0, 1, 1E, 5, or 5E, you cannot change the logical drive to  
RAID level-00, 10, 1E0, or 50.  
2. You can schedule the logical-drive migration for a later date and time  
3. You cannot change the RAID level while the logical drive is being  
4. (Cluster and failover configurations only) A logical drive will not failover  
while undergoing logical-drive migration.  
1. In the Physical devices view, click  
(array).  
2. Right-click Logical-drive migration and then the appropriate Change RAID  
level.  
Note: If the array already contains the maximum number of physical drives  
(based on the stripe-unit size), the following actions are not available:  
v
Change RAID level from RAID 0 to RAID 5  
Change RAID level from RAID 1 to RAID 5  
v
3. If you click one of the following:  
v
Change RAID level from RAID 0 to RAID 5  
Change RAID level from RAID 1 to RAID 5  
v
178 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
The Configuration wizard opens with the Create Arrays window. Add the  
physical drives to the array; then, review and apply your new configuration.  
If you click Change RAID level from RAID 5 to RAID 0, the Configuration  
wizard automatically removes the physical drives and opens the Configuration  
Summary window. Review and apply the new configuration.  
If you click Change RAID level from RAID 5E to RAID 5, the Configuration  
wizard does not add or remove a physical drive. Instead, the wizard changes  
the spare space to become free space. Use this free space to create a new logical  
More information  
v
v
Increasing free space:  
Note: This action is not supported on the integrated RAID controller.  
Using this action you can add one, two, or three physical drives to an existing  
array so that you can create another logical drive in the array.  
When you create an array, logical drives are striped across all physical drives in  
that array. To create more free space in an existing array, define additional physical  
drives to add to the array. Then, the ServeRAID Manager migrates the logical  
drives such that the data is spread across the existing and new physical drives.  
Note:  
1. To increase free space in an array, you need at least one ready drive that  
is at least as big as the largest drive in the array.  
2. You can schedule the logical-drive migration for a later date and time  
3. (Cluster and failover configurations only) A logical drive will not failover  
while undergoing logical-drive migration.  
1. In the Logical devices view, click  
(array).  
2. Right-click Logical-drive migration Increase free space. The Configuration  
wizard opens with the Create Arrays window.  
3. Add the physical drives to the array. When complete, click Next. The  
Configuration Summary window opens.  
5. After the logical-drive migration is complete, create a new logical drive in the  
new free space.  
More information  
v
v
v
Increasing logical-drive size:  
Note: This action is not supported on the integrated RAID controller.  
Using this action you can add one, two, or three physical drives to an existing  
array so you can expand the size of the logical drives in the array. When increasing  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 179  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
logical drive space, the ServeRAID Manager migrates the logical drives such that  
the logical drives gain additional space, much like adding paper to a notebook.  
When you create an array, logical drives are striped across all of the physical  
drives in that array. To increase the size of the logical drives in an existing array,  
define additional physical drives to add to the array. Then, the ServeRAID  
Manager migrates the logical drives such that the data is spread across the existing  
and new physical drives.  
Note:  
1. To increase the logical drive size, you need at least one ready drive that  
is at least as big as the largest drive in the array.  
2. You can schedule the logical-drive migration for a later date and time  
3. (Cluster and failover configurations only) A logical drive will not failover  
while undergoing logical-drive migration.  
1. In the Logical devices view, click  
(array).  
2. Right-click Logical-drive migration Increase logical-drive size. The  
Configuration wizard opens with the Create Arrays window.  
Note: This option is not available if the logical drive exceeds 2 terabytes using  
any available physical drive.  
3. Add the physical drives to the array. When complete, click Next. The  
Configuration Summary window opens.  
5. After the logical-drive migration is complete, create additional partitions to use  
the newly added logical-drive space. If the server is a Microsoft Windows  
system, you can extend the size of a pre-existing partition with the newly  
acquired logical-drive space.  
More information  
v
v
v
Adding physical drives in an existing configuration: You can add physical  
drives (also called logical-drive migration or LDM) to dynamically modify an  
existing array and its logical drives.  
Note: You cannot add more than three physical drives. The maximum number of  
physical drives you can have in an array is still limited by the controller  
1. Click the appropriate Array tab in the right pane:  
Then, from the list of ready drives, select the  
drives you want to move to the array:  
180 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2. Click  
>> (Add selected drives) to add the drives to the array. You can click  
>> (Add all drives) to move all ready drives to an array.  
Notes:  
a. The list includes only physical drives that are at least the size of the  
smallest physical drive in the selected array. When adding to an  
existing array, you cannot add physical drives that are smaller than  
the smallest drive currently in the array.  
b. When adding to an existing array, if you add physical drives that  
are larger than the physical drives currently in the array, you will  
not be able to use all the space on the new drives.  
c. You cannot add a physical drive to the array if the resulting logical  
drive size will exceed 2 terabytes.  
d. Existing physical drives in the selected array are labeled Online.  
Newly added physical drives are labeled New online. You cannot  
remove online drives from an existing array.  
3. After you add the physical drives to your arrays, click Next. The Configuration  
Summary window opens.  
To leave the Configuration wizard, click Cancel.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Confirming your logical-drive migration configuration: Use the configuration  
summary to review all the changes that the ServeRAID Manager will apply to  
your modified logical drive configuration. You can start the migration immediately  
or schedule it for another time.  
1. Review the information that is displayed in the Configuration Summary  
window. It describes how the new configuration will affect the logical drives  
and free space. To change the configuration, click Back.  
2. To start migration now, click Apply. Click Yes when asked if you want to apply  
the new configuration.  
Note: Logical-drive migration is a lengthy process. You cannot perform any  
other actions on the affected controller until the migration is complete.  
The ServeRAID Manager displays a progress indicator in the status bar  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 181  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
while the operation is in progress. When the migration is complete, the  
configuration is saved in the ServeRAID controller and in the physical  
drives.  
3. To schedule the migration for a later date and time, click Schedule. The  
ServeRAID Manager displays the Scheduler pane:  
4.  
v From the calendar display, select the day, month, year, and time you want  
the task performed.  
v Click Apply.  
v Click Yes when asked if you want to schedule the migration.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
Modifying logical drives on ServeRAID SAS and SATA controllers  
(ServeRAID-7t, ServeRAID-8i)  
Changing the RAID level: You can change the RAID levels of currently  
defined logical drives.  
1. In the Logical devices view, click  
(logical drive).  
2. Right-click Expand or change logical drive. The Configuration wizard opens  
with the Choose RAID Level window.  
3. Choose a new RAID level for the logical drive; then, click Next. The Create  
Logical Drives window opens.  
Note: Only valid RAID level migrations appear in the list. Migration  
requirements for each RAID level are described here.  
4. Add the physical drives needed to support the new RAID level (if any). Click  
Advanced settings to set the logical drive size; optionally, select a new  
stripe-unit size. Then, click Next. The Configuration Summary window opens.  
Note: When you add drives, the migration wizard shows the current layout of  
the data, including the current logical drive size. For most migrations,  
you will need to increase the logical drive size setting; the default size is  
not generally adequate once you add drives or segments.  
More information  
v
v
v
Increasing logical-drive size: Use this action to add space to an existing logical  
drive so you can increase its size.  
When you create a logical drive, it is striped across all of the physical drives used  
by the logical drive. To increase the size of an existing logical drive, you add  
segments to the logical drive, which can be on the same or different disks. Then,  
the ServeRAID Manager migrates the logical drive such that the data is spread  
across the existing and new physical drives.  
182 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Note:  
1. The capacity of the modified logical drive must match or exceed its  
current capacity.  
2. The maximum size of a logical drive is 2 terabytes.  
1. In the Logical devices view, click  
(logical drive).  
2. Right-click Expand or change logical drive. The Configuration wizard opens  
with the Choose RAID Level window. Click Next. The Create Logical Drives  
window opens.  
3. Add segments to the logical drive. Optionally, click Advanced to select a new  
stripe-unit size for the logical drive.  
Note: To remove or replace a physical drive, click the drive you want to  
remove (indicated by  
); then, click the drive you want to replace it  
with. To cancel your changes and start over, click  
.
When you are ready to continue, click Next. The Configuration Summary  
window opens.  
5. After the logical-drive migration is complete, create additional partitions to use  
the expanded logical-drive space. If the server is a Microsoft Windows system,  
you can extend the size of a pre-existing partition with the newly acquired  
logical-drive space.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
Confirming your logical-drive migration configuration: Use the configuration  
summary to review all the changes that the ServeRAID Manager will apply to  
your modified logical drive configuration. You can start the migration immediately  
or schedule it for another time.  
1.  
Review the information that is displayed in the Configuration Summary  
window. It describes how the new configuration will affect the logical drives  
and free space. To change the configuration, click Back.  
2. To start the migration now, click Apply. Click Yes when asked if you want to  
apply the new configuration.  
Note: Logical-drive migration is a lengthy process. The ServeRAID Manager  
displays  
(in animation) in the Logical devices view while the operation is in  
progress. When the migration is complete, the configuration is saved in  
the ServeRAID controller and in the physical drives.  
3. To schedule the migration for a later date and time, click Schedule. The  
ServeRAID Manager displays the Scheduler pane:  
v From the calendar display, select the day, month, year, and time you want  
the task performed.  
v Click Apply.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 183  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v Click Yes when asked if you want to schedule the migration.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
Modifying logical drives on ServeRAID enclosures  
Changing the RAID level: You can change the RAID level of currently defined  
logical drives in an array.  
1. In the Logical devices view, click  
(array).  
2. Right-click Expand or migrate array. The Configuration wizard opens with the  
Choose RAID Level window.  
3. Choose a new RAID level for the array; then, click Next. The Modify Array  
window opens.  
Note: Only valid RAID level migrations appear in the list. Migration  
requirements for each RAID level are described here.  
4. Add the physical drives needed to support the new RAID level (if any).  
Optionally, click Advanced settings to set the drive capacity display units (MB,  
GB, TB). Then, click Next. The Configuration Summary window opens.  
More information  
v
v
Increasing logical drive capacity: Use this action to increase the size of logical  
drives in an enclosure. To increase the size of one or more drives in an enclosure,  
use the Configuration wizard. To increase the size of a specific logical drive, use  
the Increase logical drive capacity action on the logical drive object.  
Increasing logical drive size with the Configuration wizard  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(enclosure).  
2. Right-click Configure storage. The Configuration wizard opens with the  
Configuration Path window.  
3. Click Advanced options; then, select Increase logical drive capacity.  
4. Click Next. The Increase Logical Drive Capacity window opens.  
5. Click the appropriate array tab.  
184 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
6. For each logical drive in the array, type amount space you want to add to the  
logical drive in the Additional (MB) field.  
7. Repeat steps 5 and 6 to increase logical drive capacity for other arrays.  
8. When you are ready to continue, click Next.  
Increasing the size of a single logical drive  
1. In the Logical devices view, click  
(logical drive).  
2. Right-click Increase logical drive capacity. The Configuration wizard opens  
with the Increase Logical Drive Capacity window.  
3. Type amount space you want to add to the logical drive in the Additional  
(MB) field.  
4. When you are ready to continue, click Next.  
More information  
v
v
Adding drives to an existing array: Use this action to add physical drives to an  
existing array without changing the RAID level.  
When you create an array, it is striped across all the physical drives used by the  
array. To increase the size of an existing array, you add segments to the array,  
which can be on the same or different disks. Then, the ServeRAID Manager  
migrates the array such that the data is spread across the existing and new  
physical drives.  
Note:  
1. The capacity of the modified array must match or exceed its current  
capacity.  
2. The maximum size of an array is 2 terabytes.  
3. This action is not supported for all RAID levels.  
1. In the Logical devices view, click  
(array).  
2. Right-click Expand or migrate array. The Configuration wizard opens with the  
Choose RAID Level window.  
3. Click Next. (Do not change the RAID level!) The Modify Array window opens.  
4. Add segments to the array. Optionally, click Advanced settings to set the drive  
capacity display units (MB, GB, TB).  
5. When you are ready to continue, click Next. The Configuration Summary  
window opens.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 185  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
More information  
v
Changing the authentication settings:  
Note: The ServeRAID Manager supports authentication for iSCSI initiators only.  
Use this action to modify the authentication method, user list, and advanced  
settings for each logical drive in the enclosure.  
1. In the Logical devices view, click  
(logical drive).  
2. Right-click Configure target information. The Configuration wizard opens with  
the Define Authentication Method window.  
4. If you enabled authentication (by choosing CHAP or SRP), click  
;
5. When you are ready to continue, click Next.  
More information  
v
v
Defining the authentication method:  
Note: The ServeRAID Manager supports authentication for iSCSI initiators only.  
Use the Authentication Information window to define the authentication method  
(if any) for each user permitted to use the logical drives in the array. Optionally,  
you can enable Radius authentication (an external authentication service) and  
define the SLP (Service Location Protocol) Scope name.  
1. Select a logical drive from the list on the left.  
2. From the Authentication type list, select the method used to authenticate users  
of this logical drive. You can choose:  
v
v
v
None - Do not authenticate users  
CHAP - Challenge Handshake Authentication Protocol  
SRP - Secure Remote Password  
3. If you enabled authentication (by choosing CHAP or SRP), click  
; the  
Global User Name and Password Management window opens. Then, add users  
4. To enable Radius authentication for the CHAP authentication method, click  
Radius authentication; then, enter the following:  
v In the Primary server field, enter the host name or TCP/IP address of the  
authentication service; then, in the Port field, enter the server’s startup port.  
v In the Secondary server field, enter the host name or TCP/IP address of the  
authentication service; then, in the Port field, enter the server’s startup port.  
Note: Radius authentication is supported by the CHAP authentication method  
only.  
5. To modify the default SLP Scope name, click Advanced settings; then, in the  
SLP Scope Name field, type a unique scope name or choose an existing name  
from the drop-down list.  
186 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
6. Repeat steps 1 through 5 to enable authentication for additional logical drives.  
To replicate the settings for all logical drives, click  
.
7. When you are ready to continue, click Next. The Define Initiators window  
opens.  
To return to the Create Logical Drives window, click Back. To leave the  
Configuration wizard, click Cancel.  
More information  
v
Changing the rebuild rate:  
Note:  
1. This action is supported in bootable-CD mode only.  
2. This action is not supported on the integrated RAID controller.  
Use this action to change the rebuild rate. The rebuild rate determines the rate that  
the data from a failed physical drive is rebuilt to a new or hot-spare drive.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(controller).  
2. Right-click Change rebuild rate and then click a rebuild rate. The following  
choices are available:  
v
v
v
High  
Medium  
Low  
When the rebuild rate is High, the rebuild I/O request gets high priority in the  
controller execution order.  
If you change the rebuild rate from High to Medium in a heavily loaded system,  
the rebuild time can increase but provide better system performance.  
If you change the rebuild rate from High or Medium to Low in a moderate to  
heavily loaded system, the rebuild time can increase, but provide better system  
performance.  
Changing access control settings: Use this action to add, modify, and delete  
initiators that are permitted to access an enclosure. You can also change the logical  
drive assignments for an initiator.  
1. In the Logical devices view, click  
(logical drive).  
2. Right-click Configure access control list. The Configuration wizard opens with  
the Define Initiators window.  
3. Add, delete, or modify an initiator. When you are ready to continue, click  
Next.  
4. Update logical drive assignments; then, click Next.  
Adding an initiator  
To add an initiator:  
1. Click  
. Depending on the initiator type, the Add iSCSI Initiator window  
opens or the Add Port Name window opens.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 187  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Deleting an initiator  
To delete an initiator:  
1. Select an initiator from the list: simply point to the initiator and click left.  
2. Click  
.
Modifying an initiator  
To modify an initiator:  
1. Select an initiator from the list.  
2. Click  
. The Modify Initiator window opens.  
3. Type a new initiator alias.  
Note: You cannot change the initiator IQN or port name. The ServeRAID  
Manager updates the IQN and port name from the initiator alias.  
4. (iSCSI initiators only) Change the advanced settings.  
5. Click OK.  
More information  
v
Defining the user list: You can define a user list for each logical drive. You must  
add at least one user to the list if you enabled authentication for the logical drive.  
1. In the User name field, enter a user name.  
2. In the Password field, enter the user’s password.  
3. In the Confirm password field, enter the password again.  
4. Click Add.  
5. Repeat steps 1-4 to add additional users.  
Note: To remove a user from the list, select the user; then, click Delete.  
6. When you are finished adding and deleting users, click Cancel.  
Tuning your system for optimal performance  
Fine-tuning your system  
When fine-tuning your controller settings for optimal performance, consider the  
applications that you intend to run on your server. Controller settings are usually  
sensitive to the types of applications running on the server, not the server  
workload or the number of users using the server. You must investigate your  
application’s design, especially its input/output behavior, to make your decision.  
When configuring your controller, your server application environment can  
influence the following:  
v The RAID level you select for your server  
More information  
v
v
188 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Fine-tuning the stripe-unit size: A new controller stripe-unit size is set at the  
factory to 8 KB (SCSI) or 16KB (SATA/SAS). If you need to change this setting for  
a ServeRAID SCSI controller or HostRAID controller, you must change the  
stripe-unit size before you store data in the logical drives. After you store data in  
the logical drives, you cannot change the stripe-unit size without destroying data  
in the logical drives.  
The ServeRAID-8i, ServeRAID-8k/8k-l, ServeRAID-7t, and  
HostRAID controllers do not support an 8 KB stripe-unit size.  
Note: For ServeRAID SCSI controlles, you must use the ServeRAID Manager in  
bootable-CD mode to change the stripe-unit size setting.  
Environment  
Groupware (such as Lotus Notes or  
Exchange)  
16 KB  
16 KB  
16 KB  
8 KB  
File server (Microsoft Windows NT,  
Windows 2000, Windows Server 2003,  
Novell NetWare)  
16 KB  
File server (Other)  
Other  
8 KB  
8 KB  
8 KB  
More information  
v
v
Fine-tuning the write-cache mode: (Novell NetWare only)  
If you are preparing to install Novell NetWare 5.x from the startable Novell NetWare  
5.x CD, you must set the write-cache mode for all logical drives to write through.  
Complete the following steps to accomplish this:  
1. In the Logical devices view, right-click  
(logical drive).  
2. Click Change write-cache mode to write-through.  
3. Repeat steps 1 and 2 for each logical drive.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 189  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Selecting a RAID level and tuning performance  
Disk arrays are used to improve performance and reliability. The amount of  
improvement depends on the application programs that you run on the server and  
the RAID levels that you assign to the logical drive.  
Each RAID level provides different levels of fault-tolerance (data redundancy),  
utilization of physical drive capacity, and read and write performance. In addition,  
the RAID levels differ in regard to the minimum and maximum number of  
physical drives that are supported.  
When selecting a RAID level for your system, consider the following factors.  
Note: Not all RAID levels are supported by all ServeRAID controllers.  
Physical  
drive  
Min.  
Max.  
Data redun- capacity  
Read perfor- Write perfor- Built-in  
number of  
drives  
number of  
drives  
RAID level dancy  
utili- zation mance  
mance  
spare drive  
100%  
50%  
50%  
Superior  
Very high  
Very high  
Superior  
Very high  
Very high  
No  
No  
No  
1
2
3
16  
2
Yes  
16  
67% to 94% Superior  
50% to 88% Superior  
High  
High  
No  
Yes  
3
4
16  
16  
Yes  
Yes  
50% to 88% Superior  
50% to 88% Very High  
High  
Yes  
4
16  
High  
No  
No  
4
2
16  
60  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
No  
100%  
50%  
50%  
Superior  
Very high  
Very high  
Superior  
Very high  
Very high  
High  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
4
6
6
8
2
4
16  
60  
67% to 94% Superior  
50% to 88% Very High  
60 (SCSI) 128  
(SAS, SATA)  
High  
128  
100%  
Superior  
Superior  
Superior  
48  
50% to 100% Superior  
48  
Physical drive utilization, read performance, and write performance depend on the  
number of drives in the array. Generally, the more drives in the array, the better  
the performance.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
190 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
v
v
v
Things to consider when changing the RAID level:  
ServeRAID SCSI controllers  
If you have a...  
And you want...  
Then...  
or more drives  
Add one and only one drive  
RAID level-1 array with two RAID level-5  
Add one and only one drive  
and only two drives  
RAID level-5 array  
RAID level-0  
The ServeRAID Manager  
removes the last drive in the  
array  
RAID level-5 Enhanced array RAID level-5  
The ServeRAID Manager  
does not add or remove a  
drive  
ServeRAID SATA and SAS controllers  
If you have a... And you want...  
Then...  
RAID level-0 logical drive  
with two or more drives  
Add at least one drive  
RAID level-5 logical drive  
RAID level-0 logical drive  
RAID level-0  
Optionally, remove one drive  
Double (at least) the drive  
count  
RAID level-6 logical drive  
RAID level-5  
Optionally, remove one or  
two drives  
RAID level-5 logical drive  
Add at least one drive  
RAID level-5EE logical drive RAID level-5  
Optionally, remove one drive  
RAID level-5 logical drive  
RAID level-10  
Make sure you have  
(source-1)*2 drives total  
RAID level-1 logical drive  
RAID level-1 logical drive  
RAID level-5  
RAID level-10  
Add at least one drive  
Add at least two drives  
ServeRAID Enclosures (networked storage)  
If you have a...  
And you want...  
Then...  
RAID level-0 logical drive  
with two or more drives  
Add at least one drive  
RAID level-1 logical drive  
RAID level-1 logical drive  
RAID level-5  
RAID level-10  
Add at least one drive  
Add at least two drives in  
multiples of two  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 191  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
More information  
v
v
v
v
Application environment groups reference  
Environment  
Applications  
Groupware  
Lotus Notes  
Microsoft Exchange  
Other  
Transaction processing  
DB2  
Informix  
Oracle  
SQLServer  
Sybase  
Other  
Decision support or data warehousing  
Thin client environments  
DB2 Informix Oracle SQLServer Sybase  
Other  
Citrix WinFrame or MetaFrame  
Microsoft Terminal Server  
Other  
File server  
Web server  
Novell NetWare  
Microsoft Windows 2000  
Microsoft Server 2003  
Other network operating systems (for  
example, OpenServer, Linux)  
Apache  
Microsoft IIS  
Netscape Commerce Server  
Other  
Understanding write-cache mode for physical drives  
When using the write-cache-mode option, you can choose from two available  
settings.  
Write back  
For the write back setting, the controller sends data to the physical drive for  
storage. Subsequently, the physical drive sends a confirmation to the controller  
before actually storing the data. Doing so increases performance, but also contains  
an element of risk.  
192 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Attention:  
1. It is possible to lose data if a power outage occurs while using the write back  
setting. Consider carefully whether to enable write back on a physical drive.  
Depending on how you use the system, write back might be undesirable.  
2. If you set this feature to write back, wait at least 10 seconds after your last  
operation before you turn off your system. Failure to follow this practice might  
result in lost data.  
Write through  
For the write-through setting, the controller sends data to the physical drive for  
storage. Subsequently, the physical drive stores the data; then, sends a confirmation  
to the controller. Using write through can decrease performance, but has no risk of  
losing data.  
More information  
v
v
Understanding write-cache mode for logical drives  
When using the write-cache-mode option, you can choose from two available  
settings.  
Write back  
For the write-back setting, the operating system sends data to the controller to  
write to a storage device. Subsequently, the controller sends a confirmation to the  
operating system before actually writing the data to the storage device. Doing so  
increases performance, but also contains an element of risk. For example, if there is  
a power failure, the data currently in the controller cache is lost. This is no risk  
when using a controller with a battery-backup cache. The battery preserves the  
data in the controller cache in the event of a power failure.  
Attention:  
1. It is possible to lose data if a power outage occurs while using the write back  
setting without a battery-backup cache device. If your controller does not have  
a battery-backup cache installed and enabled, consider carefully whether to  
enable write back on a logical drive. Depending on how you use the system,  
write back might be undesirable.  
2. If you do not have a battery-backup cache installed and enabled and you set  
this feature to write back, wait at least 10 seconds after your last operation  
before you turn off your system. Failure to follow this practice might result in  
lost data.  
Write through  
For the write-through setting, the operating system sends data to the controller to  
write to a storage device. Subsequently, the controller writes the data to the storage  
device; then, sends a confirmation to the operating system. This setting can  
decrease performance, but contains no risk of losing data.  
More information  
v
v
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 193  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding stripe-unit size  
With RAID technology, data is striped across an array of physical drives. This  
data-distribution scheme complements the way the operating system requests data.  
The granularity at which data is stored on one drive of the array before subsequent  
data is stored on the next drive of the array is called the stripe-unit size .  
You can set the stripe-unit size to 8 KB, 16 KB, 32 KB, or 64 KB. You can maximize  
the performance of your ServeRAID controller by setting the stripe-unit size to a  
value that is close to the size of the system I/O requests. For example,  
performance in transaction-based environments, which typically involve large  
blocks of data, might be optimal when the stripe-unit size is set to 32 KB or 64 KB.  
However, performance in file and print environments, which typically involve  
multiple small blocks of data, might be optimal when the stripe-unit size is set to  
8 KB or 16 KB.  
The ServeRAID-7t, ServeRAID-8i, ServeRAID-8k/8k-l, and  
HostRAID controllers do not support an 8 KB stripe-unit size. The ServeRAID-7t  
ServeRAID-8i, and ServeRAID-8k/8k-l controllers support these additional  
stripe-unit sizes: 128 KB, 256 KB, 512 KB, and 1024 KB.  
The collection of stripe units, from the first drive of the array to the last drive of  
the array, is called a stripe.  
After you configure an array and store data on the logical drives, you  
cannot change the stripe-unit size without destroying data in the logical drives.  
You can set the stripe-unit size to 8 KB, 16 KB, 32 KB, or 64 KB. The default setting  
is 8 KB data bytes.  
v When the stripe-unit size is 8 KB or 16 KB, the maximum number of physical  
drives in an array is 16.  
v If you have a ServeRAID-3H or ServeRAID-3HB controller using ServeRAID  
firmware (version 4.0, or later) and the stripe-unit size is 32 KB or 64 KB, the  
maximum number of physical drives in an array is 16. Otherwise, when the  
stripe-unit size is 32 KB or 64 KB, the maximum number of physical drives in an  
array is 8.  
v If you have a ServeRAID-4 controller and the stripe-unit size is set to 32 KB or  
64 KB, the maximum number of physical drives in an array is 16.  
More information  
v
v
Understanding enabled and disabled read-ahead cache mode for  
logical drives  
Note: You can enable and disable the read-ahead setting without destroying data  
in a logical drive by using the ServeRAID Manager in bootable-CD mode.  
Enabled read-ahead cache mode  
The controller transfers data from the logical drive to its local cache in increments  
equal to the stripe-unit size. This provides excellent overall performance when  
194 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
workloads are steady and sequential. However, if the workload is random or the  
system I/O requests are smaller than the stripe-unit size, reading ahead to the end  
of the stripe might degrade performance.  
Disabled read-ahead cache mode  
The controller transfers data from the logical drive to its local cache in increments  
equal to the system I/O request size, without reading ahead to the end of the  
stripe. This provides excellent overall performance when the workload is random  
or the system I/O requests are smaller than the stripe-unit size.  
More information  
v
v
v
Understanding adaptive read-ahead cache mode  
The ServeRAID controller continually reevaluates whether to transfer data from  
disk to its local cache in increments equal to the stripe-unit size or in increments  
equal to the system I/O request size.  
The ServeRAID-4 controllers and the ServeRAID-3HB controller come with the  
adaptive read-ahead mode as a standard feature. The ServeRAID-3H and  
ServeRAID-3L controllers must use new ServeRAID firmware (version 3.50, or  
later) to implement adaptive read-ahead cache mode. You can download and  
install the new firmware for the ServeRAID-3H and ServeRAID-3L controllers.  
If you have the controller and firmware for adaptive read-ahead mode installed,  
the ServeRAID Manager reports Adaptive on the controller properties pane.  
Otherwise, the properties pane states either Enabled or Disabled.  
Note: With this new firmware, the non-Adaptive read-ahead modes are no longer  
available in the ServeRAID Manager. You can override Adaptive read-ahead,  
but not through the ServeRAID Manager. Instead, use the IPSSEND  
command-line program. This program comes with the device option and is  
on the IBM ServeRAID Support CD. For more information, refer to the IBM  
ServeRAID User’s Reference.  
Read-ahead cache mode settings: Depending on your controller’s level of  
firmware, there are three settings for read-ahead cache mode:  
v
v
You can change the read-ahead setting without destroying data in a logical drive  
using the ServeRAID Manager in bootable-CD mode.  
Changing the stripe-unit size  
Note:  
1. This action is supported in bootable-CD mode only.  
2. This action is not supported on the ServeRAID-7t controller, ServeRAID  
SAS conrollers (8i/8k/8k-l), and the integrated RAID controller.  
3. On ServeRAID-7t controller and ServeRAID SAS controllers, use the  
configuration wizard to change the stripe-unit size.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 195  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Use this action to set the size of the chunk of data that the controller reads from  
each physical drive at a time. To maximize overall performance, choose a  
stripe-unit size that is close to the size of the system I/O request.  
Attention: After you configure an array and store data on the logical drives, you  
cannot change the stripe-unit size without destroying data in the logical drives.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(controller).  
2. Right-click Change stripe-unit size and then click a stripe-unit size. The  
following choices are available:  
8 KB With this stripe-unit size, an array can have a maximum of 16 physical  
drives.  
16 KB With this stripe-unit size, an array can have a maximum of 16 physical  
drives.  
32 KB This setting is available if the controller supports an array with 16  
physical drives using a 32 KB stripe-unit size, or the controller contains  
no arrays with more than 8 physical drives. Otherwise, this setting is  
unavailable.  
64 KB This setting is available if the controller supports an array with 16  
physical drives using a 64 KB stripe-unit size, or the controller contains  
no arrays with more than 8 physical drives. Otherwise, this setting is  
unavailable.  
More information  
v
v
v
Changing the write-cache mode on a logical drive  
Note:  
1. This action is supported in bootable-CD mode for ServeRAID SCSI  
controllers.  
2. This action is supported in interactive mode only for ServeRAID SAS  
controllers (8i/8k/8k-l) and the ServeRAID-7t controller.  
3. This action is not supported on the integrated RAID controller.  
v
Note:  
1. (RAID level-x0 only) All logical drives in a spanned array must be either  
write back or write through. That is, the write-cache mode settings for  
the logical drives in the spanned array cannot be a mixture of write back  
and write through.  
2. (Failover environment only) A fault-tolerant controller pairing must be  
configured as write through. This is because the logical drives are  
configured as Shared.For more information, refer to the IBM  
3. (Cluster environment only) If the logical drives are configured as  
Shared,the controllers must be configured as write through. For more  
information, refer to the IBM ServeRAID User’s Reference .  
1. In the Logical devices view, click  
(logical drive).  
196 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2. Right-click Change write-cache mode to write back or write through.  
3. If you click write back and you do not have a battery-backup cache, click Yes  
to confirm your choice because there is a risk of losing data.  
If you click write back and you do have a battery-backup cache, the  
ServeRAID Manager changes the mode.  
If you click write through, the ServeRAID Manager changes the mode.  
More information  
v
Changing the write-cache mode  
Note: This action is not supported on enclosures with a dual controller  
configuration.  
Use this action to change the write-cache mode setting of all the physical drives in  
an array. The write-cache mode determines if a physical drive stores data before or  
after sending a confirmation to the controller.  
Note: It is possible to lose data if a power outage occurs while using the  
write-back setting. Consider carefully whether to use the write-back setting  
on a physical drive. Depending on how you use the system, the write-back  
setting might be undesirable.  
1. In the Logical devices view, click  
(array).  
2. Right-click Configure write cache write back or write through.  
3. Click Yes to confirm.  
More information  
v
Enabling and disabling read-ahead cache mode  
Use this action to set the read-ahead cache mode to Enabled or Disabled. If the  
read-ahead cache mode is set to Adaptive, you cannot use this action.  
Note: You can override the Adaptive setting, but not through the ServeRAID  
Manager. Instead, use the IPSSEND command-line program. This program is  
on the IBM ServeRAID Support CD.  
1. In the Logical devices view, click  
(array).  
2. Right-click Configure read cache enabledor Configure read cache →  
disabled.  
3. Click Yes to confirm.  
More information  
v
v
Managing storage devices  
Managing direct attached storage devices  
Understanding FlashCopy backup: The FlashCopy function creates a quick  
backup copy of data. It sets up a link between the source and target logical drives;  
then, it creates a backup of the source data on the target drive. Any changes made  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 197  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
to the source drive after you create a FlashCopy backup are not reflected on the  
target drive. You can use the backup copy of data for tape backup, drive cloning,  
and multi-server rollout.  
There are two primary FlashCopy functions: backup and nobackup. The FlashCopy  
backup function copies the entire contents of the source drive to the target drive so  
that entire logical drives can be moved from one server to another. The FlashCopy  
nobackup function creates a temporary copy of a drive for tape drive backup and  
reference purposes. The FlashCopy nobackup function is less I/O-intensive than  
the FlashCopy backup function.  
Before using FlashCopy, consider the following requirements:  
v You can perform a FlashCopy backup operation on only one controller at a time.  
v The source and target logical drives can have the same or different RAID level  
(they do not have to match).  
v The source and target logical drives must be on the same controller.  
v You can create a maximum of four independent FlashCopy backups per  
controller.  
v There is no limit on the size of the source and target logical drive. However, for  
both FlashCopy backup and nobackup operations, the size of the target drive  
must be greater than or equal to the source drive.  
v You cannot perform any action on a FlashCopy source or target logical drive  
(such as synchronizing the drive). You can only delete a FlashCopy backup.  
More information  
v
v
Understanding copy back mode:  
Note: Copy back is supported on the ServeRAID-8i, ServeRAID-7k,  
ServeRAID-6M, and ServeRAID-6i/6i+ controllers only. It is not supported  
in cluster or failover pair configurations.  
Copy back is a method of restoring a logical drive’s original configuration after  
you replace a failed drive in an array. It allows you to restore the data to its prior  
location, before the logical drive was rebuilt from its spare.  
An example  
A RAID Level-5 logical drive consists of three physical drives and a spare. When a  
drive in the array fails, the spare drive is used to rebuild the logical drive. When  
you replace the failed drive, copy back moves the data from the former spare to  
the newly replaced drive. Then, the former spare resumes its original role as the  
spare drive.  
Copy back is enabled by default; it starts automatically when the ServeRAID  
controller detects that a failed drive is replaced. The ServeRAID Manager displays  
a progress indicator in the status bar while the operation is in progress. To disable  
copy back, choose Disable copy back mode from the controller object Action menu.  
You cannot perform any other actions on the controller until copy back is  
completed.  
198 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Note: Copy back is disabled by default when you upgrade the ServeRAID  
software from a previous release.  
More information  
v
Enabling and disabling copy back mode:  
Note: Copy back is supported on the ServeRAID-8i, ServeRAID-7k,  
ServeRAID-6M, and ServeRAID-6i/6i+ controllers only. It is not supported  
in cluster or failover pair configurations.  
Use this action to change the copy back-mode setting. This setting determines if  
the ServeRAID Manager restores a logical drive’s original configuration after you  
replace a failed drive in an array.  
Copy back is enabled by default except when you upgrade the ServeRAID  
software from a previous release; then, copy back mode is disabled by default.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(controller).  
2. Right-click Enable or Disable copy back mode.  
More information  
v
Creating a FlashCopy backup: Use this action to create a FlashCopy backup  
of data on a logical drive. You can create a FlashCopy with backup (full copy) or  
without backup (temporary copy).  
1. In the Logical devices view, click  
(Logical drive).  
2. Right click Create FlashCopy with backup to the logical drive name or  
Create FlashCopy without backup to the logical drive name.  
More information  
v
v
Removing a FlashCopy backup: Use this action to remove a FlashCopy  
backup of a logical drive.  
1. In the Logical devices view, click  
2. Right click Remove FlashCopy.  
(FlashCopy).  
More information  
v
v
Managing networked storage devices (enclosures)  
Shutting down an enclosure: Use this action to shut down the controllers in an  
enclosure.  
Attention: Use care when you shut down an enclosure. Users cannot access the  
data on the arrays and logical drives until the enclosure is restarted.  
Follow these steps to shut down an enclosure:  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 199  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(enclosure) that you want to shut down.  
2. Right-click Shut down enclosure..  
3. Click Yes when asked to confirm that you want to shut down the enclosure.  
More information  
v
v
Restarting an enclosure: Use this action to restart the controllers in an enclosure.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
2. Right-click Restart enclosure.  
(enclosure) that you want to restart.  
3. Click Yes when asked to confirm that you want to restart the enclosure.  
Attention: Restarting the enclosure may take several minutes. Data on the  
controller(s) are unavailable during that time.  
More information  
v
v
Changing controller date and time: Follow these steps to change the controller  
date and time:  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(enclosure).  
2. Right-click Change controller date and time. The Change Controller Date and  
Time window opens.  
3. Select the new date, time, and time zone from the calendar and time controls.  
4. Click OK. The ServeRAID Manager will apply the update to the controller.  
More information  
v
v
Configuring host information: Use this action to configure the network settings  
for an external storage enclosure. You can set the host name, domain, primary and  
secondary DNS servers, and the default gateway for network access.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(enclosure).  
2. Right-click Configure network details. The Configure Host Information  
window opens  
3. In the Host name field, type the enclosure’s host name.  
4. In the Domain name field, type the enclosure’s network domain; for example,  
mydomain.com.  
5. In the Primary Domain Name Server field, type the TCP/IP address of the  
enclosure’s primary DNS.  
6. In the Secondary Domain Name Server field, type the TCP/IP address of  
enclosure’s secondary DNS.  
7. In the Default Gateway field, type the TCP/IP address of the default gateway  
for network access.  
8. Click OK.  
More information  
v
200 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Configuring Ethernet ports: Use this action to configure the Ethernet settings for  
the controllers in an enclosure. For iSCSI initiators, you can configure three ports  
per controller: the management port and two iSCSI ports. For fibre channel  
initiators, you can configure the management port for each controller.  
For the management port (iSCSI or fibre channel), you can configure the port link  
speed. For iSCSI ports, you can configure network settings, such as Maximum  
Transfer Unit (MTU), TCP/IP address, and subnet mask. If your network uses  
dynamic IP addresses, you can enable DHCP.  
Configuring the management port  
To configure the management port:  
1. In the Physical devices view, click a controller in the enclosure.  
Attention: Be sure to switch to enclosure view first.  
2. Right click Configure Ethernet port ETH 0 (management). The Configure  
Ethernet port window opens.  
3. From the Link speed drop-down list, select the port link speed, in megabytes.  
To automatically detect the link speed (1 GB or less), select AUTO.  
4. Click OK.  
Configuring iSCSI ports (iSCSI initiators only)  
To configure the iSCSI ports:  
1. In the Physical devices view, click a controller in the enclosure.  
Attention: Be sure to switch to enclosure view first.  
2. Right-click Configure Ethernet port ETH 2 (iscsi) or Configure Ethernet port  
ETH 3 (iscsi). The Configure Ethernet port window opens.  
3. From the Link speed drop-down list, select the port link speed, in megabytes,  
as described above.  
4. From the Maximum transmission unit drop-down list, select the MTU packet  
size, in megabytes; either 1500 MB or 9000 MB.  
5. If your network uses dynamic IP addresses, click DHCP; then, skip to step 9.  
6. In the IP address field, enter the iSCSI port’s TCP/IP address.  
7. In the Subnet mask field, enter the TCP/IP number of the device’s TCP/IP  
subnet.  
8. In the Broadcast address field, enter the TCP/IP address for sending messages  
to machines on the network.  
9. Click OK.  
More information  
v
Updating controller and enclosure software: The ROM Update wizard  
guides you through the process of updating the software for your direct-attached  
and network-attached storage devices:  
v For direct-attached storage devices, the wizard updates the BIOS software for all  
ServeRAID controllers of the same type on the local and remote systems. You  
can update only one type of controller at a time.  
v For external (network-attached) storage devices, the wizard updates the  
enclosure and controller software for all controllers in the enclosure (single or  
dual controller configurations).  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 201  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Before you can use the ROM update wizard, you must download the latest  
software images from your vendor’s software support site on the World Wide Web.  
For direct-attachd storage devices, the image upgrade files typically come in sets of  
two or more and have a .ufi file extension. For external storage enclosures, the  
(single) image upgrade file has a .upgrade file extension.  
To update the controller software for direct-attached or network-attached storage  
devices:  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(Direct attached storage object) or  
(Networked storage object)  
2. Right-click Update controller images. The ROM Update wizard opens.  
3. Click Next.  
6. Click Next; then, review the update summary.  
7. Click Apply. The ServeRAID Manager applies the software update to the  
selected controllers or enclosures.  
8. Restart the server(s) or enclosures to activate the new ROM image.  
Recovering storage with fail back:  
Note: This action is not supported on enclosures with a single controller  
configuration.  
For enclosures with a dual controller configuration, use this action to restore an  
array to its preferred owner. When a controller fails in an enclosure (or is  
intentionally removed), its arrays and logical drives automatically fail over to the  
other controller. This action moves the arrays and logical drives back to the  
controller to which they were originally assigned.  
Note: You cannot use fail back until the failed controller is replaced or repaired.  
To fail back storage in an enclosure:  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
2. Right-click Fail back storage.  
(enclosure).  
3. Click Yes when prompted to confirm the action.  
More information  
v
Managing Foreign arrays and Alien arrays:  
Foreign arrays  
You can export RAID data and transfer the drives and RAID configuration to  
another enclosure. When you export an array, it is called a  
foreign array  
. The array icon is grayed out in the Logical devices view. You cannot perform any  
action on a foreign array, except view array components.  
When you physically remove the component drives from the enclosure, the  
ServeRAID Manager removes the foreign array icon from the console. When you  
202 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
insert the drives in another enclosure, the ServeRAID Manager displays a foreign  
array icon in the Logical devices view. You must then import the RAID data to  
complete the transfer. You may then use the array to store and manage data.  
Alien arrays  
If the ServeRAID Manager only partially completes the array configuration  
process, the resulting array is called an  
alien array  
. For example, an alien array might be created if power is interrupted during array  
creation. You cannot use an alien array to store or manage data. The array icon is  
grayed out in the Logical devices view. The only action you can perform on an  
alien array is to delete it.  
More information  
v
v
v
Managing FlashCopy backups:  
Note: You cannot use the ServeRAID Manager console create a FlashCopy for an  
enclosure-based logical device. To create a FlashCopy backup, you must use  
the command line interface provided with your IBM DS300 or DS400  
storage enclosure. Or you can use the sstool command provided with the  
FlashCopy agent.  
A FlashCopy backup creates a point-in-time backup of logical drive data. It sets up  
a link between the source and target logical drives. When data on the source drive  
changes, the differences are captured on the target drive, maintaining the data as it  
looked at the time the backup was created. You can use the backup copy of data  
for tape backup, drive cloning, and multi-server rollout.  
Initially, a FlashCopy backup starts at 10% the size of the FlashCopy source. As  
new data are written to the source drive, the FlashCopy backup grows to the size  
of FlashCopy source. This is known as the FlashCopy virtual size.  
The ServeRAID Manager displays both the virtual size and actual size of a  
FlashCopy backup, depending on the situation:  
v In the Logical devices view, it displays the virtual size:  
v In the Configuration wizard, it displays the actual size of the first FlashCopy  
backup. It displays 0 for all other FlashCopy backups.  
v In the logical drive Properties panel, it displays both the virtual size and actual  
size.  
You cannot perform any action on a FlashCopy target. You can only delete a  
FlashCopy target, using the Delete logical drive action.  
More information  
v
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 203  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Updating the software license key: Use this action to enable new features on  
the specified enclosure. To enable new features, you must obtain a feature key  
from your ServeRAID Manager sales or support representative.  
To update the software license key:  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(enclosure).  
2. Right-click Enter software key. The Enter Software Key window opens.  
3. In the Feature key field, enter the feature key.  
4. Click OK. A confirmation window opens.  
5. Click OK to confirm.  
More information  
v
Updating controller and enclosure software: The ROM Update wizard guides  
you through the process of updating the software for your direct-attached and  
network-attached storage devices:  
v For direct-attached storage devices, the wizard updates the BIOS software for all  
ServeRAID controllers of the same type on the local and remote systems. You  
can update only one type of controller at a time.  
v For external (network-attached) storage devices, the wizard updates the  
enclosure and controller software for all controllers in the enclosure (single or  
dual controller configurations).  
Before you can use the ROM update wizard, you must download the latest  
software images from your vendor’s software support site on the World Wide Web.  
For direct-attachd storage devices, the image upgrade files typically come in sets of  
two or more and have a .ufi file extension. For external storage enclosures, the  
(single) image upgrade file has a .upgrade file extension.  
To update the controller software for direct-attached or network-attached storage  
devices:  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(Direct attached storage object) or  
(Networked storage object)  
2. Right-click Update controller images. The ROM Update wizard opens.  
3. Click Next.  
6. Click Next; then, review the update summary.  
7. Click Apply. The ServeRAID Manager applies the software update to the  
selected controllers or enclosures.  
8. Restart the server(s) or enclosures to activate the new ROM image.  
Adding a remote system  
Note: This action is not supported when using the following:  
v ServeRAID Manager in bootable-CD mode  
v ServeRAID Manager as a plug-in application  
Use this action to connect to a remote system or management station and add it to  
the Enterprise view.  
204 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tip: Before adding a remote system, verify that the system is running the required  
software. To add a remote system with direct-attached storage, the ServeRAID  
Manager must be running on that system. To add a management station with  
a network-attached storage enclosure, the ServeRAID Manager management  
station software must be running on that system.  
1. From the Remote menu, select Remote Add or click  
(Add) on the  
toolbar. The Add managed system window opens.  
2. From the Type drop-down list, select:  
v
v
Managed System, to add a remote system with direct-attached storage  
Management Station, to add a remote management station with a  
network-attached storage enclosure  
3. Type the remote host name or TCP/IP address.  
4. (Managed system only) Type the remote system startup port number. The  
default port number is 34571.  
5. Type your user name and password.  
Note: The password is case sensitive.  
6. If you want to save the user name and password, select the Save user  
name/Password box. Once you successfully connect to the remote system, the  
ServeRAID Manager stores this information in a file along with the host name  
so you do not have to type your user name and password every time you run  
the ServeRAID Manager.  
7. Click Connect.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
Viewing the ServeRAID Manager event log  
Note: This action is not supported in bootable-CD mode.  
Use this action to view events in the ServeRAID Manager agent event log.  
1. From the Actions menu, click Agent actions View agent event log. The Agent  
event log window opens.  
2. If you want to save the event log to a file, click File Save As. The default is  
Events.txt.  
3. Click File Close to close event log window.  
More information  
v
v
v
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 205  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Using the ServeRAID Manager agent  
Starting the ServeRAID Manager agent  
The ServeRAID Manager agent is a monitoring agent for ServeRAID controllers  
that uses less memory than the ServeRAID Manager graphical user interface (that  
is, the console). You can manage and configure a server running the agent through  
a ServeRAID Manager console running on another system.  
Note: If the system administrator chose during installation to start the agent as a  
background service (daemon), the agent is already running. Verify that the  
Use the following procedure to start the ServeRAID Manager agent on your  
system.  
Windows  
On Windows systems, the ServeRAID Manager agent is installed as a background  
service. It starts automatically when the system is started. To start the agent  
manually, use the Windows Administrative tools. See Verifying that the agent is  
OS/2  
To start the ServeRAID Manager agent on a Windows or OS/2 system:  
1. Change to the directory where you installed the ServeRAID Manager program  
by typing:  
cd \RaidMan  
2. Press Enter.  
3. Type the following:  
RaidAgnt  
4. Press Enter.  
NetWare  
To start the ServeRAID Manager agent on NetWare:  
1. From the NetWare console, type the following:  
LOAD RaidAgnt  
2. Press Enter.  
OpenServer, UnixWare, and Open UNIX  
To start the ServeRAID Manager agent on OpenServer, UnixWare, and Open UNIX:  
1. Change to the directory where you installed the ServeRAID Manager program  
by typing one of the following:  
For OpenServer  
cd /opt/RaidMan  
cd /opt/RaidMan  
For UnixWare or Open UNIX  
2. Press Enter.  
206 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3. Type the following:  
sh RaidAgnt.sh  
4. Press Enter.  
Linux  
On Linux systems, the ServeRAID Manager agent runs as a background process  
(daemon). It starts automatically when the system is started. It is loaded from the  
following location:  
/etc/init.d/raid_agent  
More information  
v
v
v
Viewing the ServeRAID Manager event log  
Note: This action is not supported in bootable-CD mode.  
Use this action to view events in the ServeRAID Manager agent event log.  
1. From the Actions menu, click Agent actions View agent event log. The Agent  
event log window opens.  
2. If you want to save the event log to a file, click File Save As. The default is  
Events.txt.  
3. Click File Close to close event log window.  
More information  
v
v
v
Receiving events from a removed system  
When a remote system is in the Enterprise view, you always receive events that  
occur on that remote system. With the Remove remote system action, you can  
choose between Continue to receive events from remote systemor Do not  
continue to receive events from remote system.If you choose the first option, you  
can monitor for problems on remote systems without having the system in your  
Enterprise view.  
The default is to continue receiving events.  
If you choose not to continue receiving events, the ServeRAID Manager on your  
local system must connect to the remote system. If the ServeRAID Manager  
successfully connects, it removes your local system from the remote system  
notification list. Because the notification list determines what systems receive  
events from that remote system, your local system stops receiving events.  
If the ServeRAID Manager cannot connect to the remote system and is therefore  
unable to remove your system from the notification list, another window opens  
asking if you want to remove the system from the Enterprise view even though  
you will continue receiving events.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 207  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v If you click Yes, the ServeRAID Manager removes the remote system from the  
Enterprise view tree and you continue receiving events.  
v If you click No, the remote system remains in the Enterprise view tree and you  
continue receiving events. You can reattempt removing your system from the  
notification list at a later time.  
Event viewer description of events  
The event viewer description of events can inform you of the following:  
v A rebuild is started  
v A configuration is applied  
v A failed drive is detected  
v Other potential problems that might occur to your managed systems.  
Events for remote systems display in the event viewer when the following occurs:  
1. Your local system is defined in a remote system’s notification list.  
2. You have added the remote system to your Enterprise view using Add remote  
system.″  
More information  
v
v
Configuring the ServeRAID Manager agent  
You can configure the ServeRAID Manager agent port number and alarm. You can  
also configure the ServeRAID Manager agent to log events to the operating system  
event log. To configure the agent, edit the file RaidAgnt.pps or adjust the General  
settings in the ServeRAID Manager agent console. RaidAgnt.pps is located in the  
same directory where you installed the ServeRAID Manager. If the RaidAgnt.pps  
file does not exist when you start the ServeRAID Manager agent, a new file is  
created with the default settings.  
Note:  
1. The RaidAgnt.pps file is preserved during a ServeRAID Manager  
upgrade.  
2. If you change settings while the ServeRAID Manager agent is running,  
you must stop and restart the agent to make the changes take effect.  
3. The ServeRAID Manager agent alarm is not supported by the ServeRAID  
Manager in bootable-CD mode.  
Configuring the port number  
The default port number for the ServeRAID Manager agent and console (client) is  
34571. To change the port number, edit the following line in the file RaidAgnt.pps:  
agent.startupPortNum=34571  
For accessing remote systems, the ServeRAID Manager uses four consecutive ports  
starting from the startup port: 34571, 34572, 34573, and 34574. If your system has a  
conflict with these ports, change the startup port to a different port number.  
208 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Configuring the alarm  
When the ServeRAID Manager agent is started, it reads the alarm settings. When a  
critical or fatal event occurs in the RAID subsystem, the ServeRAID Manager agent  
triggers its alarm, if enabled. The alarm continues at the specified interval until  
you either:  
v Correct all the critical and fatal problems (if agent.auto.off.alarm is set to true).  
v Delete the file alarm.on. This file is located in the same directory where you  
installed the ServeRAID Manager. When you delete this file, the alarm stops  
until the next critical or fatal event occurs. The alarm.on file is automatically  
created each time the alarm starts.  
You can configure the following alarm settings:  
v
agent.enable.alarm Specifies whether the agent alarm is enabled or disabled.  
Set this value to true to enable the alarm or false to disable the alarm. The  
default value is false.  
v
v
agent.interval.alarm Specifies the interval (in seconds) between audible alarms.  
The default is 300 seconds (5 minutes).  
agent.auto.off.alarm Specifies whether the alarm should turn off automatically  
when no more problems are detected. Set this value to true to cause the alarm to  
turn off automatically, or false to manually turn the alarm off. If you set this  
value to false, you must delete the file alarm.on to turn off the alarm. The  
default is true.  
Configuring event logging  
The ServeRAID Manager agent logs warning and fatal events to the operating  
system event log. You can view the event log from the ServeRAID Manager  
console. For Windows systems, you can also view the event log with the Windows  
Event Viewer. For Unix systems, events are logged according to the  
/etc/syslog.conf settings. (For more information, see the syslogd(8) man page.)  
You can enable and disable event logging by editing the following line in the file  
RaidAgnt.pps. Set the value to true to enable event logging (the default) or false to  
disable event logging.  
agent.enable.logEventsWithOS = true  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Configuring the ServeRAID Manager agent > general settings  
Note: This action is not supported in bootable-CD mode.  
Use this action to configure The ServeRAID Manager agent general settings,  
including the base port for the agent and console. The agent can log events to the  
operating system event log, sound an alarm when an event occurs, and broadcast  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 209  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
events to users. If you enable event broadcasting, agents on Windows machines  
will display pop-up alert dialogs when events occur. On Linux machines, a  
message will be broadcast to all connected console processes using the ’wall’  
command.  
You can adjust the agent general settings with the following steps:  
1. In the ServeRAID Manager Agent window, click the General settings tab.  
2. In the Agent base port number field, enter the port number for the ServeRAID  
Manager agent and console. The default port is 34571.  
Note: For accessing remote systems, the ServeRAID Manager uses four  
consecutive ports starting from the base port: 34571, 34572, 34573, and  
34574. If your system has a conflict with these ports, change the base  
port to a different port number.  
3. To log events to the operating system event log, click Save events in OS event  
log.  
Note: You can use the View agent event log option to view the event log. You  
can also use operating system administration tools to view the event log.  
4. To broadcast events to users, click Broadcast events to logged-in users.  
5. Select the check box to enable or disable the alarm. When a critical or fatal  
event occurs in the RAID subsystem, the ServeRAID Manager agent triggers an  
alarm, if enabled.  
6. If you enabled the alarm, adjust the length of time (in seconds) between alarms.  
The default is 300 seconds (5 minutes).  
7. Click Save changes.  
8. Restart the ServeRAID Manager for the settings to take effect.  
Note: To load settings from the ServeRAID Manager agent configuration file, click  
. Use this option if you change settings in the configuration  
file while the agent is running. If you change the port number, you must  
stop and restart the agent for the change to take effect.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
Using the ServeRAID Manager agent  
The ServeRAID Manager agent includes the following components:  
v Notification Manager  
v Email Notification Manager  
v Task Manager  
v General settings  
Because the agent runs as a background process, it uses less memory resources  
than the ServeRAID Manager console. However, the ServeRAID Manager agent is  
useful in the following situations:  
v The agent can relay events to any ServeRAID Manager console installed on the  
local system or on a remote system. As events occur, the agent sends the events  
210 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
to each remote system. Use the Notification Manager from the agent console to  
add systems to the agent destination list.  
v The agent can notify users by email when events occur on the local system. Use  
the Email Notification Manager to add recipients to the email notification list.  
v The agent can run maintenance tasks on a regular basis, such as a logical drive  
migration or synchronization. Use the Task Manager to manage scheduled tasks.  
v The agent can log events to the operating system event log, sound an alarm  
when an event occurs, and broadcast critical or fatal events to users. Use the  
General settings from the agent console to configure these settings.  
Note: ServeRAID Manager also logs events to a log file. Each component of the  
agent (except for the Task Manager) has its own log file.  
The ServeRAID Manager agent monitors and generates events for critical or fatal  
problems in the ServeRAID Manager configuration every 5 seconds. These changes  
include, but are not limited to:  
v defunct drives  
v PFA drives  
v Failed battery  
v Offline or critical logical drives  
v Failed controllers  
v Enclosure problems  
v Non-warranted drives. An event is sent at startup, console connection, and every  
30 days  
More information  
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Using Security Manager  
Security Manager menu bar  
The Security Manager menu bar has the following functions:  
File →  
Close Closes the Security Manager.  
View →  
Toolbar  
Turns the toolbar on and off. The default is on (that is, selected).  
Actions →  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 211  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Help →  
Information about this window  
View context-sensitive information for the current window.  
Search  
Searches for one or more specified words in ServeRAID Manager  
Assist and displays a list of topics that include the words.  
Contents  
Presents the ServeRAID Manager Assist contents. You can use the  
contents to acquaint yourself with ServeRAID Manager Assist topics.  
About ServeRAID Manager  
Reports the ServeRAID Manager version number, copyright, and legal  
information.  
Security Manager toolbar  
The Security Manager toolbar has the following functions:  
Information about this window View context-sensitive information for the  
current window.  
Adding a user in the Security Manager  
Use this action to permit a user access to the management station.  
1. Click  
(Add user). The Add User window opens.  
2.  
Fill in all the entry fields for the user you want to add. User name, Password,  
and Confirm password are required fields.  
Note: The password is case sensitive.  
.
3. Click Add.  
More information  
v
v
v
212 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Deleting a user in the Security Manager  
Use this action to revoke access to the management stations for a selected user.  
1. Click the user that you want to delete from the security list.  
2. Click  
(Delete user).  
3. Click Yes to confirm. The ServeRAID Manager deletes the user from the  
security list.  
More information  
v
v
v
Modifying a user in the Security Manager  
Use this action to modify a user’s password.  
1. Click the user you want to modify in the security list.  
2. Click  
(Modify user). The User Properties window opens.  
3. Enter a new password; then, enter it again to confirm.  
4. Click Modify.  
More information  
v
v
v
Using SNMP Trap Manager  
SNMP Trap Manager menu bar  
The SNMP Trap Manager menu bar has the following functions:  
File →  
Close Closes the SNMP Trap Manager.  
View →  
Toolbar  
Turns the toolbar on and off. The default is on (selected).  
Actions →  
Help →  
Information about this window  
View context-sensitive information for the current window.  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 213  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Search  
Searches for one or more specified words in ServeRAID Manager  
Assist and displays a list of topics that include the words.  
Contents  
Presents the ServeRAID Manager Assist contents. You can use the  
contents to acquaint yourself with ServeRAID Manager Assist topics.  
About ServeRAID Manager  
Reports the ServeRAID Manager version number, copyright, and legal  
information.  
SNMP Trap Manager toolbar  
The SNMP Trap Manager toolbar has the following functions:  
Information about this window View context-sensitive information for the  
current window.  
Adding a system in the SNMP Trap Manager  
Use this action to add a system to the SNMP traps list. You can add one system  
only, such as an administrator’s workstation. The system is notified of the traps  
that occur on the enclosures attached to the management station.  
1. Click  
(Add system). The Add System window opens.  
2. Type the host name or TCP/IP address of the system you want to add.  
3. Type the remote system SNMP trap port number. The default port is 162.  
4. Type the Community for the system.  
5. From the Version drop-down list, select the SNMP version number. The default  
is SNMPv1.  
6. Select the type of events you want to be notified of: error, warning, or  
informational.  
7. Click Add.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
Deleting a system in the SNMP Trap Manager  
Use this action to delete a system from the SNMP traps list. After deleting the  
remote system, the SNMP Trap Manager no longer notifies the remote system of  
traps occurring on the enclosures connected to the management station.  
1. In the SNMP traps list, click the system you want to delete.  
2. Click  
(Delete system).  
214 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3. Click Yes to confirm. The SMNP Trap Manager deletes the system from the  
SNMP traps list.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
Modifying a system in the SNMP Trap Manager  
Use this action to modify system properties in the SNMP trap list, such as the host  
name, TCP/IP address, or port number.  
1. In the SNMP traps list, click the system that you want to modify.  
2. Click  
(Modify system). The System Properties window opens.  
3. Change the system properties in the appropriate fields.  
4. Click Modify.  
More information  
v
v
v
v
Managing software and firmware  
Confirming your software update  
Use the software update summary to review all the changes that the ServeRAID  
Manager will apply to your controllers or enclosures:  
1.  
Review the information displayed in the Update Summary window.  
2. When you are ready to continue, click Apply; then, click Yes when asked if you  
want to apply the software update.  
3. When the update is complete, click OK.  
4. Restart your server(s) or enclosures to activate the new software.  
Changing BIOS-compatibility mapping  
Note:  
1. This action is supported in bootable-CD mode only.  
2. This action is not supported on the integrated RAID controller.  
Use this action to change BIOS-compatibility mapping. Extended indicates 8 GB  
Extended; Limited indicates 2 GB Limited.  
The ServeRAID controller allows the migration of drives from the PCI RAID  
Adapter or Streaming RAID Adapter/A configurations. Using Change  
BIOS-compatibility mapping,you can set your ServeRAID controller to be  
compatible with these older drive configurations by selecting either 2 GB or 8 GB  
mapping. The default is 8 GB.  
1. In the Enterprise view, click  
(controller).  
Chapter 4. Managing ServeRAID devices 215  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2. Right-click either Change BIOS-compatibility mapping Extended either or  
Change BIOS-compatibility mapping Limited.  
3. Click Yes to confirm the setting.  
Updating BIOS and firmware code  
Before configuring the controller, you must have the latest BIOS and firmware code  
installed on your server. Complete the following steps to update the levels of BIOS  
and firmware code:  
1. Insert the IBM ServeRAID Support CD into the server CD-ROM drive, and turn  
on the server.  
The ROM Update Wizard automatically starts. The ROM (read-only memory)  
Update Wizard is a program that updates the BIOS and firmware code on your  
ServeRAID controllers. The wizard automatically identifies and scans each  
controller.  
If the BIOS and firmware code do not require updating, the wizard  
automatically stops and the ServeRAID Manager program starts. Use the  
ServeRAID Manager program to continue with configuring the controller.  
If the BIOS and firmware code require updating, a report screen opens with the  
following information:  
v Controller types found.  
v Controller slot number, if known.  
v Firmware version.  
v BIOS version.  
v Update status. If a controller has outdated BIOS or firmware code, the ROM  
Update Wizard marks the controller as a candidate for update.  
The ROM Update Wizard asks if you want to update. You decide whether to  
update, but you must update all or none of the controllers in your server; you  
cannot selectively update.  
2. If you want to update your controllers, click Update. If the wizard detects an  
error, an error message appears and you are prompted to insert a diskette into  
your diskette drive. The wizard saves details about the error to a file on the  
diskette.  
If you do not want to update your controllers, click Cancel.  
3. When all updates are completed, scroll through the Features window. This  
window reports the changes that the ROM Update Wizard applied to your  
controllers.  
4. Leave the ServeRAID Manager Support CD in the CD-ROM drive; shut down  
and restart the server.  
Selecting ROM update images  
To select ROM update image files:  
1. Click  
; then, select the software image files from the file system.  
Note: To remove an image from the file list, select the file, then click  
.
2. When you are ready to continue, click Next; the Select Controller window  
opens.  
216 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Chapter 5. Troubleshooting ServeRAID Manager  
Could not copy the configuration from the drives: controller [number]  
Explanation:  
v There is no configuration on any of the physical drives that are attached to the  
controller.  
v There are no physical drives attached to the controller.  
v The controller does not support one or more features of the drive configuration.  
Action:  
If you have physical drives attached to the controller and the physical drives  
contain a valid controller configuration, complete the following steps:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
If the problem persists, the configuration data has been lost. Reconfigure the  
controller using the ServeRAID Manager.  
Could not restore the configuration to the factory-default settings:  
controller [number]  
Explanation:  
The ServeRAID Manager could not restore the factory-default settings because of  
one of the following:  
v Your configuration contains a large number of drives (10 or more).  
v A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
v If your configuration contains a large number of drives and all the logical drives  
were deleted, ignore this error. If all the logical drives were not deleted, follow  
the actions listed for the following list item.  
v If your configuration does not contain a large number of drives:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Retry the command.  
3. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
If the problem persists, complete the following steps:  
1. Disconnect all the SCSI cables from controller.  
2. Restore to the factory-default settings. If this does not work, contact your  
service representative.  
3. Connect the SCSI cables to the controller.  
4. If step 2 was successful, restore to the factory-default settings.  
© Copyright IBM Corp. 1999, 2006  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
217  
 
Could not unblock logical drive [number]: controller [number]  
Explanation:  
The specified logical drive could not be unblocked because of one of the following:  
v The rebuild operation was not completed successfully.  
v A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
Verify that the rebuild operation was completed successfully. If it did, then  
complete the following steps:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
5.  
If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
Could not create a hot-spare drive: controller [number], < drive  
location> Could not create a standby hot-spare drive: controller  
[number], < drive location>  
Explanation:  
The hot-spare drive or standby hot-spare drive could not be defined because a  
hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
Could not delete array: controller [number], array [letter]  
Explanation:  
The array could not be deleted because a hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
5. If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
218 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Could not delete all of the arrays: controller [number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
Delete the arrays by using Restore to factory-default settings.  
If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
Could not delete logical drive: controller [number], logical drive  
[number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
5. If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
Logical drive was not initialized: controller [number], logical drive  
[number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
Verify that the specified logical drive is not offline. If the logical drive is offline,  
replace the failed physical drives and restore the data from tape backup.  
If the specified logical drive is not offline, complete the following steps:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
Could not start the logical drive synchronization: controller [number],  
logical drive [number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Chapter 5. Troubleshooting ServeRAID Manager 219  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Action:  
Verify that the specified logical drive is not offline or critical (that is, one physical  
drive that is offline in a RAID level-1, 1E, 5, 5E, 10, 1E0, or 50 logical drive). If the  
logical drive is critical, replace the failed physical drive. If the logical drive is  
offline, replace the failed physical drives and restore the data from tape backup.  
If the specified logical drive is not offline or critical, complete the following steps:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
Could not set the drive to online: controller [number], < drive location>  
Explanation:  
The specified drive could not be brought online because a hardware error  
occurred.  
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
If the problem persists, replace the specified drive.  
Could not remove the defunct drive: controller [number], < drive  
location>  
Explanation:  
The defunct drive could not be removed because a hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Retry the command.  
3. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
Could not replace the defunct drive: controller [number], < drive  
location>  
Explanation:  
The defunct drive could not be replaced because a hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
220 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
Could not delete the hot-spare drive: controller [number], < drive  
location> Could not delete the standby hot-spare drive: controller  
[number], < drive location>  
Explanation:  
The hot-spare drive or standby hot-spare drive could not be deleted because a  
hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
If the problem persists, replace the specified drive.  
Could not set the merge-group number: controller [number], logical  
drive [number]  
Explanation:  
The specified merge-group number could not be set because a hardware error  
occurred.  
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
5.  
If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
Could not blink the device lights  
Explanation:  
The device lights could not flash because of one of the following:  
v The physical drives are not managed by an enclosure.  
v A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
Verify that the device is managed by an enclosure (SAF-TE) device on the SCSI  
drive channel. If it is, complete the following steps:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
Chapter 5. Troubleshooting ServeRAID Manager 221  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
5.  
If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
The battery-backup cache device needs a new battery: controller  
[number]  
Explanation:  
The battery and battery-backup cache are malfunctioning because of one of the  
following:  
v The battery and battery-backup cache device are installed improperly.  
v The battery is low, and the battery-backup cache device must be replaced.  
Action:  
Verify that the battery and battery-backup cache device are installed properly. If  
they are installed properly, contact your service representative.  
The battery-backup cache device is defective: controller [number]  
Explanation:  
The battery-backup cache device is installed improperly or is defective.  
Action:  
1. Verify that the battery-backup cache device is installed properly.  
2. If the battery-backup cache device is installed properly but is defective, contact  
your service representative.  
Background polling commands are not responding: controller  
[number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the drives.  
3. Restart the server.  
4.  
If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
Commands are not responding: controller [number]  
Explanation:  
v If the controller status displays Not responding,a hardware error occurred.  
v If the controller status displays Bad configuration,a configuration error  
occurred.  
222 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Action:  
v If the controller status displays Not responding,complete the following steps:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Restart the server.  
If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
v If the controller status displays Bad configuration,complete the following  
steps:  
1. In the Enterprise view, click the specified  
(controller).  
2. If the controller is not configured, click Actions Restore to factory-default  
settings. If the controller is configured, click Actions Copy configuration  
from drives. If Copy configuration from drivesdoes not correct the  
problem, click Actions Restore to factory-default settings; then, recreate  
the configuration using the ServeRAID Manager.  
Rebuild failed: controller [number], logical drive [number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
4. If the problem persists, replace the specified drive.  
Synchronization failed: controller [number], logical drive [number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
Verify that the specified logical drive is not offline or critical (that is, one physical  
drive that is offline in a RAID level-1, 1E, 5, 5E, 10, 1E0, or 50 logical drive). If the  
logical drive is critical, replace the failed physical drive. If the logical drive is  
offline, replace the failed physical drives and restore the data from tape backup.  
If the specified logical drive is not offline or critical, complete the following steps:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
Chapter 5. Troubleshooting ServeRAID Manager 223  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Migration [logical-drive migration type] failed: controller [number],  
logical drive [number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
Determine if one or more physical drives that are part of the specified logical drive  
have failed. If such a failure has occurred, restore the data from a tape backup.  
Otherwise, do the following:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
Compression failed: controller [number], logical drive [number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
Determine if one or more physical drives that are part of the specified logical drive  
have failed. If such a failure has occurred, restore the data from a tape backup.  
Otherwise, do the following:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
Decompression failed: controller [number], logical drive [number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
Determine if one or more physical drives that are part of the specified logical drive  
have failed. If such a failure has occurred, restore the data from a tape backup.  
Otherwise, do the following:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
224 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
defunct drive: controller [number], < drive location>  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
v If the specified physical drive is part of an array, refer to the event pertaining to  
the logical drives in that array for additional information.  
v If the specified physical drive is not part of an array, contact your service  
representative.  
PFA detected for drive: controller [number], < drive location>  
Explanation:  
The physical drive is going to fail.  
Action:  
Contact your service representative.  
Logical drive is offline: controller [number], logical drive [number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
Contact your service representative.  
Logical drive is critical: controller [number], logical drive [number]  
Explanation:  
A physical drive is defunct in the specified logical drive. The data on this logical  
drive is at risk. If another physical drive fails, the data might be lost.  
Action:  
v If a rebuild operation is in progress, wait until the rebuild is complete.  
v If a rebuild operation is not in progress, replace the failed physical drive with a  
new physical drive. After the physical drive is replaced, a rebuild operation will  
start automatically. Refer to the troubleshooting chapter of the IBM ServeRAID  
Logical drive is blocked: controller [number], controller [number]  
[number]  
Explanation:  
When the ServeRAID controller performs a rebuild operation on an array, it  
reconstructs the data that was stored in RAID level-1 and RAID level-5 logical  
drives. However, the ServeRAID controller cannot reconstruct the data that was  
Chapter 5. Troubleshooting ServeRAID Manager 225  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
stored in any RAID level-0 logical drives in that array. The data in the RAID  
level-0 logical drives is blocked when the ServeRAID controller detects that the  
array is valid, but the data might be damaged.  
Action:  
Restore the data from tape.  
Could not communicate with controller: controller [number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
5.  
If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
User name or password is not valid  
Explanation:  
An incorrect or undefined user name or password was typed.  
Action:  
v Verify that you specified a valid user name and password for the remote system.  
Passwords are case sensitive.  
v If you do not require security, you can disable security on the remote system. In  
this case, a user name and password are not required to access the system  
remotely.  
ServeRAID Manager failed to start at port number [number]  
Explanation:  
The ServeRAID Manager was unable to use the specified port number on the local  
system. Another session of the ServeRAID Manager or another application is  
currently using the port.  
Action:  
Change the port number for the system by doing the following:  
1. Click Agent actions  
Configure.  
2. Click the General settings tab.  
3. In the Agent base port number field, type a new value for the port number.  
The default port number for local access is 34571. Note: When changing the  
port number, consider the following:  
v This change does not take effect until you restart the ServeRAID Manager.  
226 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v Any system that is accessing this system remotely must have the port  
number changed to match the value you type. On the remote system, you  
can change this value in the Add Remote System window.  
v Any system that contains this system in its Notification list must change the  
port number to the new port number. On the remote system, you can change  
the port number in the Notification Manager by clicking Modify system .  
No controllers were found in this system.  
Explanation:  
The ServeRAID Manager did not detect any controllers in the system.  
Action:  
If you know there are controllers in the system, the ServeRAID Manager might not  
identify the controllers because of the following:  
v The device driver is not loaded.  
v (Linux, UnixWare, and OpenServer only) You are not running the ServeRAID  
Manager as root.The ServeRAID Manager cannot access the device driver  
unless it is run with root authority. Without access to the device driver, the  
ServeRAID Manager cannot identify any controllers.  
If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
Host name [ID] is unknown or the network is down  
Explanation:  
The ServeRAID Manager could not access the remote system.  
Action:  
Verify the following:  
1. The remote system is on.  
2. Both the local and remote systems are connected to the network.  
3. TCP/IP networking support is configured on both the local and remote  
systems.  
4. The network is functioning. Verify that you can ping the remote system.  
Failed to connect to host name [ID] due to incompatible versions  
[Local=number Remote=number]  
Explanation:  
The local and remote versions of the ServeRAID Manager are incompatible  
versions.  
Action:  
Upgrade the older version of the ServeRAID Manager to the newer version.  
Chapter 5. Troubleshooting ServeRAID Manager 227  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Unable to connect to the remote system  
Explanation:  
The ServeRAID Manager could not communicate with the ServeRAID Manager  
agent on the remote system.  
Action:  
2. Verify that the port number specified for the remote system in the Add Remote  
System window matches the value on the remote system. You can verify the  
port number on the remote system by going to the ServeRAID Manager  
running on that system and doing the following:  
a. Click Agent actions Configure.  
b. Click the General settings tab.  
c. Verify the value for the port number. The default port numbers for remote  
access are 34571-34574.  
3. Verify the following:  
a. The remote system is on.  
b. Both the local and remote systems are connected to the network.  
c. TCP/IP networking support is configured on both the local and remote  
systems.  
d. The host name of the remote system is defined in the Domain Name Server  
or a Hosts file, if you are trying to connect using a host name.  
e. The network is functioning.  
Array [letter] storage space still available.  
Explanation:  
You have configured an array that still contains free space.  
Action:  
Before you apply this configuration, you can do either of the following:  
v Increase the size of the new logical drives.  
v If there is enough free space, create more logical drives in this array by returning  
to the Configure Logical Drive window in the Configuration wizard.  
Physical drives in array [letter] contain unusable space  
Explanation:  
You have configured an array using physical drives of different sizes. If you  
configure an array using physical drives of different sizes, you cannot use all the  
physical drive space.  
Action:  
To create optimal array configurations, include only physical drives of the same  
size in any one array.  
228 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Hot spare is too small for use by at least one array.  
None of the logical drives in the specified array support  
hot-spare drives.  
At least one array is too large to use the hot spare drive  
[number]. Replace the specified drive with a larger drive.  
Explanation:  
This hot-spare drive will not work for any defined array because of one of the  
following:  
v None of the existing array support hot-spare drives.  
v The hot-spare drive must have the same capacity as or larger capacity than the  
smallest physical drive in the array.  
v If any of the physical drives in your arrays fail, the specified hot-spare drive  
cannot replace the failed drive.  
Action:  
Remove the specified hot-spare drive and add a drive of the appropriate size.  
Could not start logical drive migration: controller [number] logical  
drive [number]  
Explanation:  
The logical-drive migration could not start because of one of the following:  
v A rebuild, synchronization, or migration operation is currently in progress on  
the specified controller.  
v A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
Verify that there is no rebuild, synchronization, or migration operation currently in  
progress on this controller. If you see a progress indicator in the status bar or  
(in animation) in the Logical devices view, one of these operations is in  
progress and you must wait for the operation to be completed. Otherwise,  
complete the following steps:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
5. If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
Could not enable the hot-swap rebuild operation: controller [number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Chapter 5. Troubleshooting ServeRAID Manager 229  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
5.  
If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
Could not create logical drive: controller [number], logical drive  
[number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Verify that none of the physical drives are defunct.  
4. Retry the command.  
5. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
6.  
If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
Logical drive was not initialized: controller [number], logical drive  
[number]  
Explanation:  
The logical drive has not been initialized.  
Action:  
Do not store data on this logical drive until you initialize the logical drive.  
Initialize the logical drive by doing the following:  
1. In the Logical devices view, click the specified logical drive.  
2. Click Actions Initialize; or, for the ServeRAID-7t or ServeRAID-8i controller,  
click, Actions Clear.  
Logical drive must be synchronized: controller [number], logical drive  
[number]  
Explanation:  
You must synchronize the specified logical drive before storing data on it.  
Action:  
Synchronize the logical drive by doing the following:  
1. In the Logical devices view, click the specified logical drive.  
230 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2. Click Actions Synchronize.  
[Number] ready drives still available.  
Explanation:  
You have ready drives still available for configuration.  
Action:  
You can configure these drives as new arrays, add them to other new arrays, or  
define them as hot-spare drives.  
Cannot communicate with the remote system  
Explanation:  
1. The local ServeRAID Manager has lost communication with the ServeRAID  
Manager on the remote system.  
2. The local ServeRAID Manager has lost communication with the server on  
which it is installed. The ServeRAID Manager agent might fail leaving the  
ServeRAID Manager console available, but unable to communicate with the  
server.  
Action:  
For explanation 1, use the following actions:  
v If the ServeRAID Manager is running in network mode, use the following  
actions:  
2. Verify that the port number specified for the remote system in the Add  
Remote System window matches the value on the remote system. You can  
verify the port number on the remote system by going to the ServeRAID  
Manager running on that system and doing the following:  
a. Click Agent actions Configure ServeRAID Manager agent.  
b. Click the General settings tab.  
c. Verify the value for the port number. The default port numbers for  
remote access are 34571-34574.  
3. Verify the following:  
a. The remote system is on.  
b. Both the local and remote systems are connected to the network.  
c. TCP/IP networking support is configured on both the local and remote  
systems.  
d. The host name of the remote system is defined in the Domain Name  
Server or a Hosts file, if you are trying to connect using a host name.  
e. The network is functioning.  
v If the ServeRAID Manager is running as a plug-in to another program, use the  
following actions:  
1. If the connection fails but has worked before, re-initiate the ServeRAID  
Manager task by closing the current ServeRAID Manager window and then  
dragging the RAID task icon onto the appropriate system.  
2. If the connection fails and has not worked before, verify the following:  
Chapter 5. Troubleshooting ServeRAID Manager 231  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
a. The remote system is on.  
b. The program using the ServeRAID Manager agent as a plug-in is  
installed on the remote system.  
c. Both the local and remote systems are connected to the network.  
d. TCP/IP networking support is configured on both the local and remote  
systems.  
e. The network is functioning.  
Note:  
a. If you install a program that uses the ServeRAID Manager, the  
ServeRAID Manager agent is installed also. The ServeRAID  
Manager agent is started automatically by the program using it.  
b. When using the ServeRAID Manager agent as a plug-in to another  
program, the ServeRAID Manager does not recognize port  
numbers.  
For explanation 2, use the following actions:  
1. Verify that the ServeRAID Manager agent or console is running on the local  
system. View processes or services to verify that the agent is running.  
2. Restart the ServeRAID Manager console.  
3. Verify that TCP/IP networking support is configured on the local system.  
4. Verify that the network is functioning.  
5. Restart the server.  
Error getting controller configuration.  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
If the problem persists, complete the following steps:  
Agent is running in local only mode.  
Explanation:  
v If you specified -l (that is, minus and a lowercase letter L) as a command-line  
parameter, the ServeRAID Manager starts in local-only mode. The ServeRAID  
Manager is not network-enabled. In this mode, you can configure and monitor  
the local system only. You cannot configure or monitor remote systems. If you  
added remote systems to your Enterprise view, they are not visible in this mode.  
They will be visible in the tree when you start the ServeRAID Manager in  
non-local-only mode.  
232 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v If the network is unreachable, the ServeRAID Manager starts in local-only mode.  
An additional event is displayed in the event viewer indicating that the network  
is unreachable.  
v If the port number is in use on the local system, the ServeRAID Manager starts  
in local-only mode. An additional event is displayed in the event viewer  
indicating that the network is unreachable.  
Action:  
v If the network is unreachable, check the event viewer for details on any  
networking errors.  
v If the port number is in use, exit from the application using the port number, or  
specify a different port number. Complete the following steps to specify a  
different port number:  
1. Click Agent actions Configure.  
2. Click the General settings tab.  
3. In the Agent base port number field, type a new value for the port number.  
The default port number for local access is 34571. Note: When changing the  
port number, consider the following:  
– This change does not take effect until you restart the ServeRAID Manager.  
– Any system that is accessing this system remotely must have the port  
number changed to match the value you type. On the remote system, you  
can change this value in the Add Remote System window.  
– Any system that contains this system in its Notification list must change  
the port number to the new port number. On the remote system, you can  
change the port number in the Notification Manager by clicking Modify  
Networking support is not available.  
Explanation:  
The network is unreachable.  
Action:  
Verify the following:  
1. The local system is connected to the network.  
2. The TCP/IP networking support is configured.  
3. The network is functioning.  
Could not send the event to the system.  
Explanation:  
An event could not be sent to the remote system.  
Action:  
1. Verify that the ServeRAID Manager is running on the remote system.  
2. Verify that the port number specified in the Notification list matches the value  
for the start-up port number on the remote system.  
v You can verify the port number for this event in the Notification Manager by  
using the System Properties window for this system.  
Chapter 5. Troubleshooting ServeRAID Manager 233  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
v You can verify the port number on the remote system by going to the  
ServeRAID Manager running on that system and doing the following:  
a. Click Agent actions Configure.  
b. Click the General settings tab.  
c. Verify the value for the port number.  
3. Verify the following:  
a. The remote system is on.  
b. Both the local and remote systems are connected to the network.  
c. TCP/IP networking support is configured on both the local and remote  
systems.  
d. The network is functioning.  
4. Verify that the local and remote systems are using compatible versions of the  
ServeRAID Manager. If they are not, upgrade to the latest version of the  
ServeRAID Manager.  
Failed to connect to host name [ID] at port number [number].  
Explanation:  
The ServeRAID Manager could not communicate with the ServeRAID Manager  
client on the remote system.  
Action:  
2. Verify that the port number specified for the remote system in the Add Remote  
System window matches the value on the remote system. You can verify the  
port number on the remote system by going to the ServeRAID Manager  
running on that system and doing the following:  
a. Click Agent actions Configure.  
b. Click the General settings tab.  
c. Verify the value for the port number. The default port numbers for remote  
access are 34571-34574.  
3. Verify the following:  
a. The remote system is on.  
b. Both the local and remote systems are connected to the network.  
c. TCP/IP networking support is configured on both the local and remote  
systems.  
d. The host name of the remote system is defined in the Domain Name Server  
or a Hosts file, if you are trying to connect using a host name.  
e. The network is functioning.  
Note: If the local ServeRAID Manager is trying to connect to a remote system that  
has multiple network adapters, the local ServeRAID Manager must use a  
host name to connect to the remote system.  
234 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Failed to connect to host name [ID] due to incompatible versions  
[Local=id Remote=id].  
Explanation:  
The local and remote versions of the ServeRAID Manager are incompatible  
versions.  
Action:  
Upgrade the older version of the ServeRAID Manager to the newer version.  
ServeRAID Manager failed to start at port number [number].  
Explanation:  
The ServeRAID Manager was unable to use the specified port number. The port is  
currently in use.  
Action:  
Change the port number for the system by doing the following:  
1. Click Agent actions Configure.  
2. Click the General settings tab.  
3. In the Agent base port number field, type a new value for the port number.  
The default port number for local access is 34571. Note: When changing the  
port number, consider the following:  
v This change does not take effect until you restart the ServeRAID Manager.  
v Any system that is accessing this system remotely must have the port  
number changed to match the value you type. On the remote system, you  
can change this value in the Add Remote System window.  
v Any system that contains this system in its Notification list must change the  
port number to the new port number. On the remote system, you can change  
the port number in the Notification Manager by clicking Modify system .  
Refused connection from [remote system ID].  
Explanation:  
Security is enabled on this system, and the ServeRAID Manager received a remote  
log-in request containing an incorrect user ID or password.  
Action:  
The remote system requesting a log-in to this system must specify a valid user ID  
and password. Be sure the remote system issuing the log-in request specifies a  
valid user ID and password.  
Chapter 5. Troubleshooting ServeRAID Manager 235  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
FlashCopy with backup failed: controller [number], logical drive  
[number]  
Explanation:  
The FlashCopy failed because a hardware error occurred. The specified logical  
drive might be offline.  
Action:  
If the source logical drive is offline, replace the failed physical drives and restore  
the data from tape backup. If the target logical drive is offline, replace the failed  
physical drives. FlashCopy will not work when the source or target logical drives  
are offline.  
If the source or target logical drives are not offline, complete the following steps:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
5.  
If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
Could not import configuration with more than eight drives into a  
ServeRAID-3L controller.  
Explanation:  
The ServeRAID-3L controller does not support more than eight drives in an array  
when the stripe-unit size is 32 KB or 64 KB.  
Action:  
Do one of the following:  
v Replace the ServeRAID-3L controller with a ServeRAID-3H controller. The  
configuration stored on the physical drives is supported only on a  
ServeRAID-3H controller or later hardware. or  
v Create a new configuration that does not contain more than eight drives in an  
array with the stripe-unit size being 32 KB or 64 KB.  
Attention:  
When creating a new configuration, you will destroy the data  
currently on the physical drives.  
Could not copy the configuration from the drives: controller [number],  
< drive location>  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
236 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
Possible non-warranted physical drive found: controller [number], <  
device location>  
Explanation:  
The ServeRAID Manager has detected that the specified physical drive might not  
be a qualified and warranted part.  
Action:  
This message is an alert only. The physical drive will continue to function and the  
ServeRAID Manager will not make any changes or modifications to the  
configuration.  
For further assistance, contact the source from which you obtained the specified  
physical drive.  
Could not set the host name: controller [number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
Verify that the cluster partner system is turned off. If it is, complete the following  
steps:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
Could not set the partner host name: controller [number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
Verify that the cluster partner system is turned off. If it is, complete the following  
steps:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
5. If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
Chapter 5. Troubleshooting ServeRAID Manager 237  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Could not change the rebuild rate: controller [number], < device  
location>  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
5. If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
Could not change the stripe-unit size: controller [number], < device  
location>  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
Could not change the write-cache mode: controller [number], logical  
drive [number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
5. If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
Could not change the SCSI transfer speed: controller [number],  
channel [number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
238 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
5. If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
Could not enable unattended mode: controller [number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
5. If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
Could not disable unattended mode: controller [number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
5. If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
Could not enable read cache: controller [number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
5. If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
Could not disable read cache: controller [number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Chapter 5. Troubleshooting ServeRAID Manager 239  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
5. If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
Could not set the SCSI initiator ID: controller [number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
5. If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
Note: (Cluster and failover environment only) Verify that the cable from the  
second system (for clustering) or controller (for failover) is disconnected  
from the SCSI backplane.  
Could not switch the active and passive controllers.  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
5. If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
Could not clear the controller event logs for system [number].  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
5. If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
240 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Could not copy the configuration from the non-shared logical drives  
(merge group [number]): controller [number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
1. Delete the arrays by using Restore to factory-default settings.  
2. Set the controller name, the partner controller name, and the SCSI initiator IDs.  
3. Retry the command.  
If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
Could not change the BIOS-compatibility mapping to [Extended or  
Limited]: controller [number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
5. If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
Could not change the write-cache mode: controller [number], channel  
[number], SCSI ID [number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
If the problem persists, replace the specified drive.  
Enclosure device is not responding: controller [number], channel  
[number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Chapter 5. Troubleshooting ServeRAID Manager 241  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
5. If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
Enclosure fan [number] is malfunctioning: controller [number],  
channel [number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
Verify that the fan in the enclosure device is installed properly. If it is, complete the  
following steps:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
If the problem persists, replace the specified fan.  
Enclosure power supply [number] is malfunctioning: controller  
[number], channel [number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
Verify that the power supply in the enclosure device is installed properly. If it is,  
complete the following steps:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
If the problem persists, replace the specified power supply.  
Enclosure temperature is out of normal range: controller [number],  
channel [number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
242 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Action:  
Verify that the fans in the enclosure device are installed properly and working. If  
they are, complete the following steps:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Retry the command.  
3. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
4. If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
Could not save the event logs: controller [number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
5. If the problem persists, contact your service representative.  
Version mismatch detected: controller [number]  
Explanation:  
The version of the BIOS, firmware, and device driver are not compatible.  
Action:  
Install a compatible version of the BIOS, firmware, and driver for this controller.  
You can download the latest version from the  
Compaction failed: controller [number], logical drive [number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
Determine if one or more physical drives that are part of the specified logical drive  
have failed. If such a failure has occurred, restore the data from a tape backup.  
Otherwise, do the following:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
Chapter 5. Troubleshooting ServeRAID Manager 243  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Expansion failed: controller [number], logical drive [number]  
Explanation:  
A hardware error occurred.  
Action:  
Determine if one or more physical drives that are part of the specified logical drive  
have failed. If such a failure has occurred, restore the data from a tape backup.  
Otherwise, do the following:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
Battery has exceeded normal operating temperature: battery controller  
[number]  
Explanation:  
Battery temperature has exceeded 50 degrees Celsius.  
Action:  
Check operating environment: verify that the controller is installed properly, that  
the server has adequate ventilation, and so on. If the problem persists, the battery  
may be bad or the server may have a problem. Contact your service representative.  
Network connection was not found and/or host name was not  
resolved.  
Explanation:  
The ServeRAID Manager could not communicate with the network or establish a  
network connection.  
Action:  
v If your workstation is not connected to the network, change your workstation  
name to localhostor add an entry for your workstation to your local host file.  
v If your workstation is connected to the network, make sure that your host name  
is resolvable over DNS; for more information, contact your network  
administrator.  
One or more logical drives contain a bad stripe: controller [number],  
logical drive [number]  
Explanation:  
The Bad Stripe Table (BST) provides a means of recovering most data on a logical  
drive after multiple hardware errors prevent access to a logical drive stripe. An  
entry in the BST indicates that the data contained in a stripe has been lost.  
244 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
While many conditions can produce a Bad Stripe Table entry, the most common  
cause is an error accessing one of the stripe units within a stripe of a critical logical  
drive. A single stripe unit failure is correctable and recoverable but two or more  
failures within the same redundant RAID stripe are not.  
For example, in a critical RAID-5 array, in which one of the drives in the array is  
defunct, a stripe will be marked bad with an entry in the BST if a non-recoverable  
media error occurs when accessing one of the other drives of the array.  
Once an entry is logged in the BST, the controller will return an error code to the  
driver whenever the host system tries to access a Logical Block Address (LBA)  
within the affected stripe. This is one immediate indication that some part of the  
logical drive is unusable.  
Note: It is not possible to correlate the bad stripe with a specific file in the  
operating system.  
Action:  
v
Check the ServeRAID Manager event logs to identify the affected logical  
drive(s).  
v
Because the data has been lost, the only way to recover from this condition is to  
do the following:  
1. Delete the array.  
2. Recreate the array and its logical drives.  
3. Restore the data from backup media.  
v The alternative is to take the entire logical drive offline, thus resulting in the loss  
of all data contained on that logical drive.  
v To minimize the risk of lost data, be sure to schedule frequent periodic backups.  
Exception removing timer from active queue  
Explanation:  
v There is no configuration on any of the physical drives that are attached to the  
controller.  
v There are no physical drives attached to the controller.  
v The controller does not support one or more features of the drive configuration.  
Action:  
If you have physical drives attached to the controller and the physical drives  
contain a valid controller configuration, complete the following steps:  
1. Verify that the controller, cables, and physical drives are installed properly.  
2. Verify that there is power to the physical drives.  
3. Retry the command.  
4. If the command still fails, restart the server and retry the command.  
If the problem persists, the configuration data has been lost. Reconfigure the  
controller using the ServeRAID Manager.  
Chapter 5. Troubleshooting ServeRAID Manager 245  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Set drive to defunct: controller [number], < device location>  
Explanation:  
The specified physical drive reported an unrecoverable media error.  
Action:  
Replace the specified physical drive.  
Set drive to defunct: controller [number], < device location>  
Explanation:  
There was an error in communication between the physical drive and the  
controller.  
Action:  
1. Verify that there is power to external enclosures and connections.  
2. Verify that cables are properly seated.  
3. Check for damaged, bent, or pushed pins on the following:  
v Termination (for non-backplane systems)  
v Backplanes  
v Physical drives  
v Controller  
If you cannot identify a connection problem, the replacement order for parts is the  
following:  
1. Termination (for non-backplane systems)  
2. Cables  
3. Physical drives  
4. Backplanes  
5. Controller  
Before replacing a physical drive or controller, verify that it is updated with the  
latest firmware (microcode) and that they still fail.  
Note: If multiple physical drives are marked defunct within the same time period,  
check the cables and backplanes.  
Set drive to defunct: controller [number], < device location>  
Explanation:  
One of the following occurred:  
v The user has removed or rearranged the specified physical drive.  
v There was an error in communication between the physical drive and the  
controller.  
Action:  
1. Verify that there is power to external enclosures and connections.  
2. Verify that cables are properly seated.  
246 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3. Check for damaged, bent, or pushed pins on the following:  
v Termination (for non-backplane systems)  
v Backplanes  
v Physical drives  
v Controller  
If you cannot identify a connection problem, the replacement order for parts is the  
following:  
1. Termination (for non-backplane systems)  
2. Cables  
3. Physical drives  
4. Backplanes  
5. Controller  
Before replacing a physical drive or controller, verify that it is updated with the  
latest firmware (microcode) and that they still fail.  
Note: If multiple physical drives are marked defunct within the same time period,  
check the cables and backplanes.  
Set drive to defunct: controller [number], < device location>  
Explanation:  
One of the following occurred:  
v The user has removed or rearranged the specified physical drive.  
v A controller might be configured with unattended mode. Changes to the RAID  
configuration are accepted automatically in unattended mode.  
v There was an error in communication between the physical drive and the  
controller.  
Note: (Clustering and failover environments only) If you move a logical drive to  
another controller, these entries might be normal.  
Action:  
1. Verify that there is power to external enclosures and connections.  
2. Verify that cables are properly seated.  
3. Check for damaged, bent, or pushed pins on the following:  
v Termination (for non-backplane systems)  
v Backplanes  
v Physical drives  
v Controller  
If you cannot identify a connection problem, the replacement order for parts is the  
following:  
1. Termination (for non-backplane systems)  
2. Cables  
3. Physical drives  
4. Backplanes  
5. Controller  
Chapter 5. Troubleshooting ServeRAID Manager 247  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Before replacing a physical drive or controller, verify that it is updated with the  
latest firmware (microcode) and that they still fail.  
Note: If multiple physical drives are marked defunct within the same time period,  
check the cables and backplanes.  
Set drive to defunct: controller [number], < device location>  
Explanation:  
The specified physical drive reported an unrecoverable hardware error.  
Action:  
Replace the specified physical drive.  
Set drive to defunct: controller [number], < device location>  
Explanation:  
The controller failed.  
Action:  
Update the controller with the latest firmware (microcode). If the problem persists,  
replace the controller.  
Set drive to defunct: controller [number], < device location>  
Explanation:  
v There was an error in communication between the physical drive and the  
controller.  
v The controller failed.  
Action:  
1. Verify that there is power to external enclosures and connections.  
2. Verify that cables are properly seated.  
3. Check for damaged, bent, or pushed pins on the following:  
v Termination (for non-backplane systems)  
v Backplanes  
v Physical drives  
v Controller  
If you cannot identify a connection problem, the replacement order for parts is the  
following:  
1. Termination (for non-backplane systems)  
2. Cables  
3. Physical drives  
4. Backplanes  
5. Controller  
248 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Before replacing a physical drive or controller, verify that it is updated with the  
latest firmware (microcode) and that they still fail.  
Note: If multiple physical drives are marked defunct within the same time period,  
check the cables and backplanes.  
Set drive to defunct: controller [number], < device location>  
Explanation:  
The specified physical drive does not match the valid configuration signature after  
the configuration was imported from the physical drives.  
Action:  
Do one of the following:  
v Rebuild the critical array.  
v Remove the specified physical drive.  
Set drive to defunct: controller [number], < device location>  
Explanation:  
There was an error in communication between the physical drive and the  
controller while the controller was attempting to validate the RAID configuration  
of the physical drive.  
Action:  
1. Verify that there is power to external enclosures and connections.  
2. Verify that cables are properly seated.  
3. Check for damaged, bent, or pushed pins on the following:  
v Termination (for non-backplane systems)  
v Backplanes  
v Physical drives  
v Controller  
If you cannot identify a connection problem, the replacement order for parts is the  
following:  
1. Termination (for non-backplane systems)  
2. Cables  
3. Physical drives  
4. Backplanes  
5. Controller  
Before replacing a physical drive or controller, verify that it is updated with the  
latest firmware (microcode) and that they still fail.  
Note: If multiple physical drives are marked defunct within the same time period,  
check the cables and backplanes.  
Chapter 5. Troubleshooting ServeRAID Manager 249  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Set drive to defunct: controller [number], < device location>  
Explanation:  
A user used the operating-system utilities to mark the specified physical drive  
defunct.  
Action:  
Rebuild the critical array.  
Set drive to defunct: controller [number], < device location>  
Explanation:  
The specified physical drive is not part of a valid configuration but was found in a  
cluster setup.  
Action:  
Rebuild the specified physical drive into an array. If you cannot rebuild the  
physical drive, replace or remove the physical drive.  
Set drive to defunct: controller [number], < device location>  
Explanation:  
The specified physical drive is not part of a valid configuration but was found in a  
cluster setup.  
Action:  
Rebuild the specified physical drive into an array. If you cannot rebuild the  
physical drive, replace or remove the physical drive.  
Set drive to defunct: controller [number], < device location>  
Explanation:  
The specified physical drive is configured as part of another system.  
Action:  
Rebuild the specified physical drive into an array on this system. If you cannot  
rebuild the physical drive, replace the physical drive.  
Set drive to defunct: controller [number], < device location>  
Explanation:  
The specified channel or port is not working.  
Action:  
1. Verify that there is power to external enclosures and connections.  
2. Verify that cables are properly seated.  
250 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3. Check for damaged, bent, or pushed pins on the following:  
v Termination (for non-backplane systems)  
v Backplanes  
v Physical drives  
v Controller  
If you cannot identify a connection problem, the replacement order for parts is the  
following:  
1. Termination (for non-backplane systems)  
2. Cables  
3. Physical drives  
4. Backplanes  
5. Controller  
Before replacing a physical drive or controller, verify that it is updated with the  
latest firmware (microcode) and that they still fail.  
Note: If multiple physical drives are marked defunct within the same time period,  
check the cables and backplanes.  
This event log entry is informational.  
Explanation:  
None required.  
Action:  
None required.  
Chapter 5. Troubleshooting ServeRAID Manager 251  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
252 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix A. Accessibility features for IBM Director  
Accessibility features help users who have a physical disability, such as restricted  
mobility or limited vision, to use information technology products successfully.  
Accessibility features  
The following list includes the major accessibility features in IBM Director. These  
features support:  
v Keyboard-only operation.  
v Interfaces that are commonly used by screen readers.  
v The attachment of alternative input and output devices.  
Tip: The IBM Director Information Center, and its related publications, are  
accessibility-enabled for the IBM Home Page Reader. You can operate all  
features using the keyboard instead of the mouse.  
Keyboard navigation  
This product uses standard Microsoft Windows navigation keys. In addition, the  
following tables provide additional information that addresses the IBM Director  
Console:  
Table 4. Keyboard shortcuts for windows  
Action  
Keyboard shortcut  
Activate the default button.  
Enter  
Table 5. Keyboard shortcuts for option panes  
Action  
Keyboard shortcut  
Navigate in or out of the option pane.  
Hide a dialog.  
Alt+F6  
Esc  
Activate the default button (if defined).  
Enter  
Table 6. Keyboard shortcuts for dialogs  
Action  
Keyboard shortcut  
Navigate out of the dialog.  
Hide the dialog.  
Alt+F6  
Esc  
Activate the default button (if defined).  
Enter  
Table 7. Keyboard shortcuts for scroll panes  
Action  
Keyboard shortcut  
Tab  
Navigate forward out of the scroll pane.  
Navigate backward out of the scroll pane.  
Move up or down.  
Shift+Tab  
Up arrow or down  
arrow  
© Copyright IBM Corp. 1999, 2006  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
253  
 
Table 7. Keyboard shortcuts for scroll panes (continued)  
Action  
Keyboard shortcut  
Move left or right.  
Left arrow or right  
arrow.  
Navigate to the beginning or end of data.  
Ctrl+Home or  
Ctrl+End  
Navigate up or down one block.  
Navigate to the left or right.  
PgUp or PgDn  
Ctrl+PgUp or  
Ctrl+PgDn  
Table 8. Keyboard shortcuts for split panes  
Action  
Keyboard shortcut  
Navigate forward out of the split pane.  
Navigate backward out of the split pane.  
Tab or Ctrl+Tab  
Shift+Tab or  
Ctrl+Shift+Tab  
Navigate between split panes.  
Navigate to the splitter bar.  
Tab or F6  
F8  
F8  
Toggle the focus between two split bars (for windows with three  
split panes).  
Resize the split pane vertically.  
Up arrow or down  
arrow  
Resize the split pane horizontally.  
Left arrow or right  
arrow  
Maximize the size of the split pane .  
Minimize the size of the split pane.  
Home  
End  
Table 9. Keyboard shortcuts for notebooks (tabbed panes)  
Action  
Keyboard shortcut  
Tab  
Navigate into the tabbed pane.  
Navigate out of the tabbed pane.  
Navigate to the left or right tab.  
Ctrl+Tab  
Left arrow or right  
arrow  
Navigate to the tab above or below.  
Up arrow or down  
arrow  
Navigate from the tab to the page.  
Navigate from the page to the tab.  
Navigate to the previous or next page.  
Enter or Ctrl+Down  
Ctrl+Up  
Ctrl+PgUp or  
Ctrl+PgDn  
Table 10. Keyboard shortcuts for frames  
Action  
Keyboard shortcut  
Alt+Space bar  
Enter  
Display a window menu.  
Activate the default button (if defined).  
254 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Table 11. Keyboard shortcuts for internal frames  
Action  
Keyboard shortcut  
Open or restore the frame.  
Ctrl+F5, Alt+F5, or  
Enter  
Close the frame.  
Ctrl+F4 or Alt+F5  
Ctrl+F7 or Alt+F7  
Ctrl+F8 or Alt+F8  
Ctrl+F9 or Alt+F9  
Alt+Space bar  
Enter  
Move the frame.  
Resize the frame.  
Minimize the frame size.  
Display a window menu.  
Activate the default button (if defined).  
Table 12. Keyboard shortcuts for menu bar  
Action  
Keyboard shortcut  
Alt or F10  
Jump to the menu bar.  
Navigate out of the menu bar.  
Navigate within the menu bar.  
Select the next or previous menu item.  
Esc or Alt  
Arrow keys  
Right arrow or left  
arrow  
Activate the default or selected item.  
Display a menu.  
Enter  
Use one of these  
keyboard shortcuts:  
v Up arrow  
v Down arrow  
v Enter  
v Space bar  
v Alt+Character  
accelerator key (if  
defined)  
Hide a menu.  
Esc or Alt  
Table 13. Keyboard shortcuts for menus  
Action  
Keyboard shortcut  
Enter or F10  
Right arrow  
Down arrow  
Up arrow  
Esc  
Display a menu.  
Display a submenu.  
Navigate to the next item or wrap to the top.  
Navigate to the previous item or wrap to the bottom.  
Hide the menu.  
Hide the submenu.  
Left arrow  
Enter  
Activate the default or selected item.  
Table 14. Keyboard shortcuts for menu items  
Action  
Keyboard shortcut  
Navigate in or out of a menu.  
Arrow keys  
Appendix A. Accessibility features for IBM Director 255  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Table 14. Keyboard shortcuts for menu items (continued)  
Action  
Keyboard shortcut  
Activate an item.  
Enter, space bar, or  
Alt+Character  
accelerator key (if  
defined)  
Display a submenu.  
Hide a submenu.  
Right arrow  
Left arrow or Esc  
Table 15. Keyboard shortcuts for check-box menu items  
Action  
Keyboard shortcut  
Arrow keys  
Enter  
Navigate in or out of the check-box menu.  
Select or clear a check-box menu item.  
Hide a check-box menu.  
Enter  
Table 16. Keyboard shortcuts for radio-button menu items  
Action  
Keyboard shortcut  
Arrow keys  
Enter  
Navigate in or out of a radio-button menu.  
Select or clear a radio-button menu item.  
Hide a radio-button menu.  
Enter  
Table 17. Keyboard shortcuts for pop-up menus  
Action  
Keyboard shortcut  
Shift+F10  
Display a pop-up menu.  
Display a pop-up submenu.  
Hide a pop-up menu.  
Right arrow  
Esc  
Hide a submenu.  
Left arrow  
Navigate within a pop-up menu.  
Up arrow or down  
arrow  
Activate a pop-up menu item.  
Enter or space bar  
Table 18. Keyboard shortcuts for toolbar  
Action  
Keyboard shortcut  
Tab  
Navigate forward out of the toolbar.  
Navigate backward out of the toolbar.  
Navigate within the toolbar.  
Activate a toolbar item.  
Shift+Tab  
Arrow keys  
Enter  
Display the Customized Toolbar menu (when focus is on an icon  
on the main IBM Director Console window toolbar).  
Shift+10  
Table 19. Keyboard shortcuts for tool tips  
Action  
Keyboard shortcut  
Ctrl+F1  
Display a tool tip.  
Hide a tool tip.  
Esc or Ctrl+F1  
256 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Table 20. Keyboard shortcuts for text fields  
Action  
Keyboard shortcut  
Navigate into the text field  
Alt+Character  
accelerator key (if  
defined).  
Navigate forward out of the text field.  
Navigate backward out of the text field.  
Navigate to the previous or next character.  
Tab  
Shift+Tab  
Left arrow or right  
arrow  
Navigate to the previous or next word.  
Ctrl+Left arrow or  
Ctrl+Right arrow  
Navigate to the beginning or end of a field.  
Submit an entry.  
Home or End  
Enter  
Select all text in the field.  
Ctrl+A  
Clear the selection.  
Arrow keys  
Extend the selection to the left or right one character.  
Shift+Left arrow or  
Shift+Right arrow  
Extend the selection to the beginning or end of the field.  
Extend the selection to the next or previous word.  
Shift+Home or  
Shift+End  
Ctrl+Shift+Left arrow  
or Ctrl+Shift+Right  
arrow  
Copy the selected text.  
Ctrl+C  
Cut the selected text.  
Ctrl+X  
Paste from the clipboard.  
Delete the previous or next character  
Ctrl+V  
Backspace or Delete  
Table 21. Keyboard shortcuts for text panes  
Action  
Keyboard shortcut  
Navigate into the text pane.  
Tab or Alt+Character  
accelerator key (if  
defined).  
Navigate forward out of the text pane.  
Navigate backward out of the text pane.  
Navigate vertically up or down one block.  
Navigate up or down one line.  
Ctrl+Tab  
Ctrl+Shift+Tab  
PgUp or PgDn  
Up arrow or down  
arrow  
Navigate to the left or right one component or character.  
Left arrow or right  
arrow  
Navigate to the beginning or end of a line.  
Navigate to the previous or next word.  
Home or End  
Ctrl+Left arrow or  
Ctrl+Right arrow  
Navigate to the beginning or end of the text pane.  
Ctrl+Home or  
Ctrl+End  
Navigate up or down one block.  
PgUp or PgDn  
Navigate to the left or right one block.  
Ctrl+PgUp or  
Ctrl+PgDn  
Appendix A. Accessibility features for IBM Director 257  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Table 21. Keyboard shortcuts for text panes (continued)  
Action  
Keyboard shortcut  
Navigate to the next or previous HTML link or other element  
which can receive the focus.  
Ctrl+T or Ctrl+Shift+T  
Navigate out of a focusable element that accepts a tab.  
Ctrl+Tab or  
Ctrl+Shift+Tab  
Activate a hyperlink.  
Ctrl+Space bar  
Extend the selection up or down one block.  
Shift+PgUp or  
Shift+PgDn  
Extend the selection to the left or right one block.  
Extend the selection up or down one line.  
Ctrl+Shift+PgUp or  
Ctrl+Shift+PgDn  
Shift+Up arrow or  
Shift+Down arrow  
Extend the selection to the left or right.  
Shift+Left arrow or  
Shift+Right arrow  
Extend the selection to the beginning or end of the line.  
Extend the selection to the beginning or end of the text pane.  
Extend the selection to the previous or next word.  
Shift+Home or  
Shift+End  
Ctrl+Shift+Home or  
Ctrl+Shift+End  
Ctrl+Shift+Left arrow  
or Ctrl+Shift+Right  
arrow  
Extend the selection vertically up or down one block.  
Extend the selection to the left or right one block.  
Shift+PgUp or  
Shift+PgDn  
Ctrl+Shift+PgUp or  
Ctrl+Shift+PgDn  
Select all text in the text pane.  
Clear the selection.  
Ctrl+A  
Arrow keys  
Ctrl+C  
Copy the selected text.  
Cut the selected text.  
Ctrl+X  
Paste from the clipboard.  
Delete the previous or next component or character.  
Insert a line break.  
Ctrl+V  
Backspace or Delete  
Enter  
Insert a tab.  
Tab  
Interface information  
You can choose from a variety of high-contrast color schemes and large font sizes  
in the IBM Director Console. See the IBM Director Systems Management Guide for  
more information about configuring IBM Director Console settings.  
Related accessibility information  
You can view the publications for IBM Director in Adobe Portable Document  
Format (PDF) using the Adobe Acrobat Reader. The PDFs are provided on a CD  
that is packaged with the product, or you can access them through the IBM  
Director Information Center.  
258 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IBM and accessibility  
See the IBM Accessibility Center for more information about the commitment that  
IBM has to accessibility.  
Appendix A. Accessibility features for IBM Director 259  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
260 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix B. Glossary  
A
alien array  
A partially configured array, usually created as a result of an error during the array  
creation process, such as a power failure.  
array  
Two or more physical drives combined for increased capacity, speed, or fault  
tolerance. Once created, an array is configured as one or more logical drives. The  
operating system in the server recognizes a logical drive as a single drive.  
auto-synchronization  
Synchronization on RAID level-6, level-5, level-5E, level-50, and level-60 drives that  
is automatically initiated when the logical drives are created. This type of  
synchronization works in the background. ServeRAID SAS controllers (8i/8k/8k-l)  
and the ServeRAID-7t controller also support auto-synchronization on RAID  
level-1 and level-10 logical drives.  
B
battery-backup cache  
Buffer storage that protects data during write-back operations; in the event of a  
power failure, it preserves the data in the controller cache.  
BIOS-compatibility mapping - Extended  
An option of BIOS compatibility mapping. When the BIOS compatibility mapping  
is set to Extended, the ServeRAID controller BIOS is aware that the operating  
system supports 8 GB or smaller physical drives.  
BIOS-compatibility mapping - Limited  
An option of BIOS compatibility mapping. When the BIOS compatibility mapping  
is set to Limited, the ServeRAID controller BIOS is aware that the operating  
system supports 2 GB or smaller physical drives. This enables the user to migrate  
data from older PCI or Micro Channel adapters.  
BIOS-compatibility mapping  
A ServeRAID controller setting with two options: Limited and Extended. The  
default value is Extended.  
block  
A data unit created when data is striped across physical drives.  
blocked  
The blocked state is reserved for RAID level-0 logical drives that are part of the  
same array as one or more of the following:  
© Copyright IBM Corp. 1999, 2006  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
261  
 
v A RAID level-1 logical drive  
v A RAID level-1E logical drive  
v A RAID level-5 llogical drive  
If a physical drive in such an array fails, the RAID level-0 logical drives enter the  
offline state, while the other logical drives enter the critical state.  
After you replace the failed physical drive, a rebuild operation starts and  
reconstructs the data stored in any RAID level-1, level-1E, or level-5 logical drives;  
at the same time, the RAID level-0 logical drives enter the blocked state. RAID  
level-0 logical drives cannot be rebuilt, since they do not contain redundant data.  
After the rebuild operation is completed, you can unblock the RAID level-0 logical  
drives and access them once again. However, the logical drive might contain  
damaged data. You must re-create, reinstall, or restore the data from the most  
recent backup disk or tape to the RAID level-0 logical drive.  
C
cluster  
In ServeRAID Manager technology, two independent computer systems organized  
into a network for the purpose of sharing resources and communicating with each  
other. A cluster provides fault-tolerance at the server level.  
compaction  
The process by which a RAID level-5EE logical driveutilizes the distributed spare  
drive in the event of a physical drive failure. After the data is reconstructed, the  
original array undergoes compaction and the distributed spare drive becomes part  
of the new array.  
compression  
The process by which a RAID level-5E logical drive utilizes the distributed spare  
drive in the event of a physical drive failure. After the data is reconstructed, the  
original array undergoes compression and the distributed spare drive becomes part  
of the new array.  
controller  
A device that coordinates and controls the operation of one or more input/output  
devices, such as workstations, and synchronizes the operation of such devices with  
the operation of the system as a whole.  
controller names  
In a cluster or failover pair, the unique names that identify the members of the pair  
to one another.  
copy back  
A method of restoring a logical drive’s original configuration after replacing a  
failed drive in an array. Copy back restores the data to its original location, before  
the logical drive was rebuilt from its spare.  
262 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
critical  
The state of a RAID level-1, level-1E, level-5, level-5E, level-5EE, level-10, level-1E0,  
or level-50 logical drive that contains a defunct drive. A RAID level-6 or level-60  
logical drive with two defunct drives is also in the critical state. If a critical logical  
drive sustains another drive failure the data cannot be recovered.  
D
data mirroring  
A technique that creates a single logical drive from two physical drives. All data  
written to the logical drive is written to both physical drives, creating a pair of  
physical drives containing exactly the same data.  
data scrubbing  
A feature that provides automatic, continuous synchronization during system use.  
This features works in the background, and ensures that the redundant data  
and/or parity is correct.  
data striping  
A technique that divides a logical drive into data blocks, called stripes, which are  
then distributed over the physical drives. The layout is such that a sequential read  
of data on the logical drive results in parallel reads to each of the physical drives,  
resulting in improved performance.  
decompression  
The process by which a compressed array returns to its original striping scheme,  
after a failed drive is replaced in a RAID level-5E logical drive. Contrast with  
defunct  
A physical-drive state in which the ServeRAID controller cannot communicate  
properly with the drive.  
distributed spare drive  
In the RAID level-5E, the logical drive designated as a spare drive. Because this  
spare drive is spread over several physical drives, it is described as distributed.  
E
enclosure  
A direct-attached or network-attached storage expansion unit, such as the IBM  
Netfinity EXP300 or IBM TotalStorage DS300, that contains disk drives.  
expansion  
The process by which a compacted array returns to its original striping scheme,  
after a failed drive is replaced in a RAID level-5EE logical drive. Contrast with  
Appendix B. Glossary 263  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
F
fault tolerance  
The ability of a computer system to operate correctly even though one or more of  
its component parts are malfunctioning.  
firmware  
Proprietary code that is usually delivered as microcode as part of an operating  
system. Firmware is more efficient than software loaded from an alterable medium  
and more adaptable to change than pure hardware circuitry. An example of  
firmware is the Basic Input/Output System (BIOS) in read-only memory (ROM) on  
a PC motherboard.  
FlashCopy  
A point-in-time capture of logical drive data on a networked storage device. As  
new data are written to the original logical drive, the FlashCopy view captures the  
changes. If an error occurs in the original logical drive, you can roll-back the  
logical drive to the point when the FlashCopy was created.  
FlashCopy virtual size  
For a FlashCopy backup of logical drive data, the virtual size is the maximum size  
that the FlashCopy can grow to. The virtual size equals the size of the FlashCopy  
source drive. The actual size of a FlashCopy backup starts at 10% of the FlashCopy  
source. As new data are written to the source drive, the FlashCopy backup grows  
to the size of FlashCopy source.  
foreign array  
An array with exported data, allowing the drives and RAID configuration to be  
transferred to another enclosure.  
free space  
The space in an array currently not assigned to a logical drive.  
G
H
GB  
When referring to hard-disk-drive capacity, GB means 1 000 000 000 bytes, or 1000  
MB. Total user-accessible capacity may vary depending on operating environment.  
high availability  
A system designed and implemented with components that satisfy the system  
functional requirements, but also has hardware and software component  
redundancy to eliminate any unexpected behavior.  
hot add  
To add and configure a new ServeRAID controller while the server is operational.  
264 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
hot-pluggable  
Pertaining to a system in which components can be added while the system is  
running.  
hot-spare drive  
A physical drive that is defined for automatic use when a similar drive fails.  
hot-swap rebuild  
An operation that is started by the ServeRAID controller when it detects that a  
physical drive that is part of an array and in the defunct state has been removed  
and replaced on a SCSI cable or backplane.  
hot-swappable  
Pertaining to a component that can be removed and/or replaced while the system  
is running.  
I
Impacted  
A RAID level-6, level-5, level-5EE, level-50, or level-60 logical drive moves to the  
Impacted state if a drive fails during initialization or the initialization process is  
stopped before it completes. This may occur during auto-synchronization or data  
scrubbing (with background synchronization). In an Impacted drive, the  
striping/synchronization process has not completed and you need to  
resynchronize.  
Note: A RAID level-1, level-1E, or level-10 logical drive moves to the Impacted  
state during its initial build. When the build is complete, it returns to the  
okay state.  
integrated RAID controller  
An integrated SCSI controller with RAID capabilities, such as the LSI 1020 and LSI  
1030. Integrated RAID controllers are standard features on some IBM xSeries  
servers. They can be used to create a RAID level-1 logical drive from two physical  
drives. You can configure one additional physical drive as a hot spare drive.  
initialize logical drive  
To prepare a logical drive for use by erasing the first 1024 sectors on a drive. For  
the ServeRAID-7t and ServeRAID SAS controllers (8i/8k/8k-l), initialization clears  
the entire drive. Initialization prevents access to any data previously stored on the  
drive.  
initiator identifiers  
The SCSI initiator IDs assigned to a cluster or failover pair.  
IPSSEND command-line program  
An advanced command-line program that can be used to manage your ServeRAID  
controllers. It can be used to configure your controller, isolate and debug problems,  
recover from errors, and to copy controller configurations from one server to  
another.  
Appendix B. Glossary 265  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
L
logical drive  
A grouping of physical drives that the operating system recognizes as a single  
drive.  
logical-drive migration  
To add or remove physical drives from an existing array, to change RAID levels,  
change logical-drive size, or effect an increase in free space.  
LSI 1030 controller  
M
management station  
A system or server with a network-attached storage enclosure. After you install the  
management station software on that system, you can monitor and configure the  
enclosure from a ServeRAID Manager console.  
MB  
When referring to physical-drive capacity, MB means 1 000 000 bytes. Total  
user-accessible capacity may vary depending on operating environment.  
merge-group number  
In a clustering configuration, the numbers that identify each logical drive.  
Non-shared logical drives are assigned merge-group numbers of either 206 or 207;  
shared logical drives need unique merge-group numbers, so that they can be  
identified even if they move to the other server.  
merge-group state  
In a clustering environment, whether or not a logical drive is shared.  
migrating  
The state of a logical drive undergoing a logical-drive migration.  
mirror role  
The role assigned to the two physical drives that an integrated RAID controller  
uses to create a RAID level-1 logical drive. When the logical drive is created, data  
is copied from the primary physical drive to the secondary physical drive. Any  
data on the secondary drive is destroyed.  
N
network-attached storage  
An external storage enclosure with an embedded RAID controller, such as the IBM  
DS400. You can monitor and configure network-attached storage from a ServeRAID  
Manager console if the enclosure is connected to a management station.  
266 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Notification Manager  
A tool used to notify remote systems of events, problems, and configuration  
changes occurring on a local system.  
O
offline  
okay  
A logical drive state in which the logical drive is inaccessible.  
A logical drive state in which the logical drive is functional.  
online  
A physical-drive state in which the physical drive is functioning properly and is  
part of an array.  
P
parity  
The data stored on a RAID level-5, level-5E, level-5EE, or level-50 logical drive that  
can be used, in conjunction with the data on the remaining drives, to recreate a  
failed physical drive’s data.  
parity block  
In a RAID level-5, level-5E, or level-50 logical drive, a data unit that contains a  
representation of the data from other blocks in the same stripe.  
partner name  
In a cluster or failover pair, one of the two controller names entered during  
configuration.  
physical drive  
A hard disk drive.  
PFA  
Predictive Failure Analysis event that announces the physical drive is about to fail.  
plug-in  
A plug-in,as referred to in ServeRAID Manager Assist, specifically refers to IBM  
Director.  
POST  
Power-on self-test. During POST, the ServeRAID controller compares the stored  
configuration information to the configuration that is actually present. If a  
discrepancy exists, one or more status messages appear after the POST completes  
but before the operating system loads.  
Appendix B. Glossary 267  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
preferred owner  
In a dual controller enclosure, the controller to which an array is originally  
assigned. If the preferred owner fails (due to a hardware problem, for example),  
the array automatically moves to the other controller (fail over). The ServeRAID  
Manager allows you to restore the array to its preferred owner with fail back.  
Intentionally moving an array to different controller in the enclosure changes its  
preferred owner.  
Q
R
quorum drive  
In the Microsoft Clustering Solution, a logical drive that stores the quorum  
resource information.  
restore to factory-default settings  
An action that restores all parameters in the controller to the factory-default  
settings. If logical drives are defined, the data stored on them will be lost.  
rack enclosure  
RAID  
A technology of grouping several physical drives in a computer into an array that  
you can define as one or more logical drives. Each logical drive appears to the  
operating system as a single drive. This grouping technique greatly enhances  
logical-drive capacity and performance beyond the physical limitations of a single  
physical drive.  
RAID level-0  
A RAID level that uses data striping to distribute data evenly across physical  
drives. While it enables full utilization of physical drive capacity and performance  
acceleration, RAID level- 0 provides neither fault tolerance nor redundancy.  
RAID level-1  
A RAID level that uses data mirroring to distribute data across two physical  
drives. It provides data redundancy and performance acceleration, although the  
usable physical drive space is reduced by 50 percent.  
RAID level-1E  
A RAID level that uses both data striping and data mirroring to distribute data  
across three or more physical drives. Data is striped across each disk in the array;  
the first set of stripes are the data stripes, and the second sets of stripes are mirror  
copies of the first stripe, shifted one drive. It provides data redundancy and  
performance acceleration, although the usable physical drive space is reduced by  
50 percent.  
268 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
RAID level-5  
A RAID level that uses data striping and block interweaving to distribute data  
across three or more physical drives. It provides full data protection and  
performance acceleration, although only 67-94% of physical drive storage capacity  
can be used.  
RAID level-5E  
A RAID level that uses data striping and block interweaving to distribute data  
across four or more physical drives; it uses some space on each physical drive as a  
distributed hot-spare. It provides full data protection and performance acceleration,  
although only 50-88% of physical drive storage capacity can be used.  
RAID level-5EE  
A RAID level that uses data striping and block interweaving to distribute data  
across four or more physical drives. Like RAID level-5E, it uses a distributed  
hot-spare but offers faster rebuild times. It provides full data protection and  
performance acceleration, although only 50-88% of physical drive storage capacity  
can be used.  
RAID level-6  
A RAID level that uses data striping and block interweaving to distribute data  
across four or more physical drives. It is similar to RAID level-5 but with two sets  
of parity instead of one. The second set of parity information improves fault  
tolerance. RAID level-6 can handle two simultaneous drive failures, where other  
single RAID levels can handle, at most, only one.  
RAID level-x0  
Refers to RAID level-00, level-10, level-1E0, and level-50. These RAID levels use  
spanned arrays (array of arrays) to enable the use of up to 60 physical drives.  
RAID level-00 provides no data redundancy, but provides performance acceleration  
and allows 100% of the physical drive storage capacity to be used. RAID levels -10,  
-1E, and -50 provide full data protection, performance acceleration, and greater  
reliability, although only 67-94% of physical drive storage capacity can be used.  
RAID signature  
A small segment on each physical disk in a RAID configuration that stores  
information about drives and arrays.  
read-ahead cache mode  
A ServeRAID controller setting that determines whether the ServeRAID controller  
transfers data from disk to its local cache in increments equal to the stripe-unit size  
or the system I/O requests. The options are enabled, disabled, and adaptive; the  
default value is adaptive.  
read-ahead cache mode - Adaptive  
The default value of the read-ahead cache mode. When the read-ahead cache mode  
is set to adaptive, the ServeRAID controller continually reevaluates whether to set  
the read-ahead cache mode to enabled or disabled.  
Appendix B. Glossary 269  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
read-ahead cache mode - Disabled  
An option of the read-ahead cache mode. When the read-ahead cache mode is  
disabled, the ServeRAID controller transfers data from the logical drive to its local  
cache in increments equal to the system I/O request size. This optimizes  
performance when the workload is random or the system I/O requests are smaller  
than the stripe-unit size.  
read-ahead cache mode - Enabled  
An option of the read-ahead cache mode. When the read-ahead cache mode is  
enabled, the ServeRAID controller transfers data from the logical drive to its local  
cache in increments equal to the stripe-unit size. This optimizes performance when  
workloads are steady and sequential.  
ready  
A physical-drive state in which the drive is available for definition.  
rebuild  
An operation to reconstruct data after the problem that caused a physical drive to  
become defunct has been resolved.  
rebuild rate  
The speed (high, medium, or low) at which a rebuild operation will occur.  
rebuilding  
The state of a physical drive undergoing a rebuild operation.  
recurring task  
A scheduled task that runs periodically according to the interval you choose: the  
same time each day, each week, or each month.  
ROM Update wizard  
A program that updates the BIOS and firmware codes on ServeRAID controller.  
S
ServeRAID Manager Mini-configuration program  
A program that allows the user to display the ServeRAID controller settings, and  
to perform a limited set of configuration functions without using the IBM  
ServeRAID Support CD.  
SAF-TE  
A processor that manages small computer system interface (SCSI) accessed  
fault-tolerant enclosures (SAF-TE). An example of such an enclosure is the IBM  
Netfinity EXP15.  
scheduled task  
A technique that allows you to start a lengthy operation at a convenient time, such  
270 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
SCSI  
SCSI initiator ID  
In a failover or clustering environment, the ID assigned to a SCSI controller. Each  
ServeRAID controller and its partner must have different SCSI initiator IDS; one  
must be 6 and the other 7.  
SCSI-transfer speed  
The speed at which data can be transferred between a physical drive and the  
ServeRAID controller.  
segment  
Disk drive or portion of a disk drive used to create a logical drive. A disk can  
include RAID segments and available segments. A RAID segment is part of a  
logical drive; it can be used by only one logical drive at a time. Available segments  
can be used to define a new logical drive. If the disk is not part of any logical  
drive, the entire disk is an available segment.  
ServeRAID Manager  
A program used to configure ServeRAID controllers, view the ServeRAID Manager  
configuration, create arrays and logical drives, delete arrays, dynamically increase  
the logical-drive size, change RAID levels, and more.  
shared drives  
The physical drives controlled by a cluster or failover pair.  
small computer system interface  
A standard hardware interface that enables a variety of peripheral devices to  
communicate with one another.  
spanned array  
An array of arrays. Used in RAID level-00, level-10, level-1E0, and level-50 to  
permit the use of larger numbers of physical drives. The spanned array contains  
arrays, each of which contains a sub-logical drive, which can be RAID level-0,  
level-1, level-1E, or level-5. The RAID-level for the logical drive contained within  
the spanned array is 0.  
standby hot spare  
A hot-spare physical drive that the ServeRAID controller has spun down. If an  
online drive becomes defunct and no suitable hot-spare drive is available, a  
standby drive of the appropriate size automatically spins up and enters the rebuild  
state.  
stripe-unit size  
The granularity at which data is stored on one drive of the array before subsequent  
data is stored on the next drive of the array. The performance of a ServeRAID  
controller is maximized if the stripe-unit size is close to the size of the system  
input/output requests.  
Appendix B. Glossary 271  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
stripes  
The collection of stripe units, from the first to last drive of the array.  
sub-logical drive  
In a RAID level-x0 configuration, a logical drive contained within each array of the  
spanned array. A sub-logical drive can be RAID level-0, level-1, level-1E, or level 5.  
Synchronize  
The process of recalculating and rewriting either redundant data (RAID level-1,  
level-1E, level-10, and level-1E0 logical drives) or parity (RAID level-5, level-5E,  
and level-50 logical drives).  
T
throughput  
The speed at which data can be moved from one place to another, usually  
expressed in MB per second.  
U
unattended mode  
A ServeRAID controller setting that determines how the BIOS handles failures  
during system startup. The settings are enabled and disabled; the default value is  
disabled.  
unattended mode -- Disabled  
A setting of the unattended mode. When the unattended mode is disabled and the  
BIOS detects a failure, the system stops at the recovery option screen and waits for  
the user to respond.  
unattended mode -- Enabled  
A setting of the unattended mode. When the unattended mode is enabled and the  
BIOS detects a failure, the system waits for 30 seconds for the user to respond to  
the recovery options screen. Then, the BIOS automatically selects an appropriate  
option and continues the system startup process. Unattended mode must be  
enabled in a clustering environment.  
W
write-cache mode  
A ServeRAID controller setting that determines whether the controller writes data  
to the physical drive before or after sending a confirmation to the operating  
system. The settings are write back and write through.  
write-cache mode -- Write-back  
A setting of the write-cache mode. When the write-cache mode is set to write back  
and the operating system sends data to the controller, the controller sends a  
confirmation back to the operating system before actually writing the data to a  
272 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
storage device. This increases performance, but, if a battery-backup cache is not  
used, increases the risk of data loss in the event of a power failure.  
write-cache mode -- Write-through  
A setting of the write-cache mode. When the write-cache mode is set to write  
through and the operating system sends data to the controller, the controller writes  
the data to a storage device before sending a confirmation to the operating system.  
This mode decreases performance, but does not risk data loss.  
Appendix B. Glossary 273  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
274 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix C. Notices  
This information was developed for products and services offered in the U.S.A.  
IBM may not offer the products, services, or features discussed in this document in  
other countries. Consult your local IBM representative for information on the  
products and services currently available in your area. Any reference to an IBM  
product, program, or service is not intended to state or imply that only that IBM  
product, program, or service may be used. Any functionally equivalent product,  
program, or service that does not infringe any IBM intellectual property right may  
be used instead. However, it is the user’s responsibility to evaluate and verify the  
operation of any non-IBM product, program, or service.  
IBM may have patents or pending patent applications covering subject matter  
described in this document. The furnishing of this document does not grant you  
any license to these patents. You can send license inquiries, in writing, to:  
IBM Director of Licensing  
IBM Corporation  
North Castle Drive  
Armonk, NY 10504-1785  
U.S.A.  
For license inquiries regarding double-byte (DBCS) information, contact the IBM  
Intellectual Property Department in your country or send inquiries, in writing, to:  
IBM World Trade Asia Corporation  
Licensing  
2-31 Roppongi 3-chome, Minato-ku  
Tokyo 106-0032, Japan  
The following paragraph does not apply to the United Kingdom or any other  
country where such provisions are inconsistent with local law:  
INTERNATIONAL BUSINESS MACHINES CORPORATION PROVIDES THIS  
PUBLICATION AS ISWITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER  
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED  
WARRANTIES OF NON-INFRINGEMENT, MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS  
FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. Some states do not allow disclaimer of express or  
implied warranties in certain transactions, therefore, this statement may not apply  
to you.  
This information could include technical inaccuracies or typographical errors.  
Changes are periodically made to the information herein; these changes will be  
incorporated in new editions of the publication. IBM may make improvements  
and/or changes in the product(s) and/or the program(s) described in this  
publication at any time without notice.  
Any references in this information to non-IBM Web sites are provided for  
convenience only and do not in any manner serve as an endorsement of those Web  
sites. The materials at those Web sites are not part of the materials for this IBM  
product and use of those Web sites is at your own risk.  
© Copyright IBM Corp. 1999, 2006  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
275  
 
IBM may use or distribute any of the information you supply in any way it  
believes appropriate without incurring any obligation to you.  
Licensees of this program who wish to have information about it for the purpose  
of enabling: (i) the exchange of information between independently created  
programs and other programs (including this one) and (ii) the mutual use of the  
information which has been exchanged, should contact:  
IBM Corporation  
MW9A/050  
5600 Cottle Road  
San Jose, CA 95193  
U.S.A.  
Such information may be available, subject to appropriate terms and conditions,  
including in some cases, payment of a fee.  
The licensed program described in this document and all licensed material  
available for it are provided by IBM under terms of the IBM Customer Agreement,  
IBM International Program License Agreement or any equivalent agreement  
between us.  
Any performance data contained herein was determined in a controlled  
environment. Therefore, the results obtained in other operating environments may  
vary significantly. Some measurements may have been made on development-level  
systems and there is no guarantee that these measurements will be the same on  
generally available systems. Furthermore, some measurements may have been  
estimated through extrapolation. Actual results may vary. Users of this document  
should verify the applicable data for their specific environment.  
Information concerning non-IBM products was obtained from the suppliers of  
those products, their published announcements or other publicly available sources.  
IBM has not tested those products and cannot confirm the accuracy of  
performance, compatibility or any other claims related to non-IBM products.  
Questions on the capabilities of non-IBM products should be addressed to the  
suppliers of those products.  
This information contains examples of data and reports used in daily business  
operations. To illustrate them as completely as possible, the examples include the  
names of individuals, companies, brands, and products. All of these names are  
fictitious and any similarity to the names and addresses used by an actual business  
enterprise is entirely coincidental.  
If you are viewing this information softcopy, the photographs and color  
illustrations may not appear.  
Trademarks  
The following terms are trademarks of International Business Machines  
Corporation in the United States, other countries, or both:  
AIX  
AIX 5L  
Alert on LAN  
Asset ID  
276 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
BladeCenter  
Cloudscape  
DB2  
DB2 Universal Database  
DirMaint  
DS4000  
Electronic Service Agent  
Enterprise Storage Server  
eServer  
eServer logo  
FlashCopy  
HiperSockets  
i5/OS  
IBM  
IBM logo  
ibm.com  
IntelliStation  
Itanium  
iSeries  
Lotus Notes  
Multiprise  
Netfinity  
NetServer  
NetView  
OS/400  
PC 300  
POWER  
Predictive Failure Analysis  
pSeries  
RACF  
Redbooks  
S/390  
ServeRAID  
ServerProven  
ServicePac  
SurePOS  
System i  
System p  
System p5  
System Storage  
System z  
System x  
System z9  
Tivoli  
Tivoli Enterprise Console  
Appendix C. Notices 277  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tivoli Management Environment  
TotalStorage  
Virtualization Engine  
Wake on LAN  
xSeries  
z/VM  
zSeries  
Intel, Itanium, and Pentium are trademarks of Intel Corporation in the United  
States, other countries, or both.  
Java and all Java-based trademarks are trademarks or registered trademarks of Sun  
Microsystems, Inc. in the United States, other countries, or both.  
Linux is a registered trademark of Linus Torvalds in the United States, other  
countries, or both.  
Microsoft, Windows, and Windows NT are trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in  
the United States, other countries, or both.  
Red Hat and all Red Hat-based trademarks and logos are trademarks or registered  
trademarks of Red Hat, Inc., in the United States and other countries.  
SET is a registered trademark of SET Secure Electronic Transaction LLC in the  
United States and other countries.  
UNIX is a registered trademark of The Open Group in the United States and other  
countries.  
Other company, product, or service names may be trademarks or service marks of  
others.  
278 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Glossary  
to one service processor, thus eliminating  
the need for multiple modems,  
Glossary  
telephones, and LAN ports. It provides  
such out-of-band management functions  
as system power control,  
service-processor event-log management,  
firmware updates, alert notification, and  
user profile configuration.  
This glossary includes terms and definitions from:  
v The American National Dictionary for Information  
Systems, ANSI X3.172-1990, copyright 1990 by  
the American National Standards Institute  
(ANSI). Copies may be purchased from the  
American National Standards Institute, 1430  
Broadway, New York, New York 10018.  
Definitions are identified by the symbol (A)  
after the definition.  
Advanced System Management (ASM)  
interconnect network  
A network of IBM servers created by  
using the ASM interconnect feature. The  
servers are connected through RS-485  
ports. When servers containing integrated  
system management processors (ISMPs)  
and ASM processors are connected to an  
ASM interconnect network, IBM Director  
can manage them out-of-band.  
v The Information Technology Vocabulary developed  
by Subcommittee 1, Joint Technical Committee  
1, of the International Organization for  
Standardization and the International  
Electrotechnical Committee (ISO/IEC  
JTC1/SC1). Definitions of published parts of  
this vocabulary are identified by the symbol (I)  
after the definition; definitions taken from draft  
international standards, committee drafts, and  
working papers being developed by ISO/IEC  
JTC1/SC1 are identified by the symbol (T) after  
the definition, indicating that final agreement  
has not yet been reached among the  
Advanced System Management (ASM) PCI  
adapter  
An IBM service processor that is built into  
the Netfinity 7000 M10 and 8500R servers.  
It also was available as an option that  
could be installed in a server that  
contained an ASM processor. When an  
ASM PCI adapter is used with an ASM  
processor, the ASM PCI adapter acts as an  
Ethernet gateway, while the ASM  
processor retains control of the server.  
When used as a gateway service  
participating National Bodies of SC1.  
v The IBM Dictionary of Computing, New York:  
McGraw-Hill, 1994.  
v The IBM Glossary of Computing Terms, 1999.  
To view other IBM glossary sources, see IBM  
processor, the ASM PCI adapter can  
communicate with other ASM PCI  
adapters and ASM processors only.  
A
Advanced System Management (ASM)  
processor  
accelerator key  
In a user interface, a key or combination  
of keys that invokes an  
application-defined function.  
A service processor built into the  
mid-range Netfinity and early xSeries  
servers. IBM Director can connect  
out-of-band to an ASM processor located  
on an ASM interconnect; an ASM PCI  
adapter, a Remote Supervisor Adapter, or  
a Remote Supervisor II must serve as the  
gateway service processor.  
Advanced Encryption Setting (AES)  
A block cipher algorithm, also known as  
Rijndael, used to encrypt data transmitted  
between managed systems and the  
management server, which employs a key  
of 128, 192, or 256 bits. AES was  
alert  
A message or other indication that  
identifies a problem or an impending  
problem.  
developed as a replacement for DES.  
Advanced System Management (ASM)  
interconnect  
alert forwarding  
Alert forwarding can ensure that alerts  
are sent, even if a managed system  
A feature of IBM service processors that  
enables users to connect up to 24 servers  
© Copyright IBM Corp. 1999, 2006  
279  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
experiences a catastrophic failure, such as  
an operating-system failure.  
enclosure. This 7-U modular chassis can  
contain up to 14 blade servers. It enables  
the individual blade servers to share  
resources, such as the management,  
switch, power, and blower modules.  
alert-forwarding profile  
A profile that specifies where remote  
alerts for the service processor should be  
sent.  
bottleneck  
A place in the system where contention  
for a resource is affecting performance.  
alert standard format (ASF)  
A specification created by the Distributed  
Management Task Force (DMTF) that  
defines remote-control and alerting  
interfaces that can best serve a client  
system in an environment that does not  
have an operating system.  
C
chassis  
The metal frame in which various  
electronic components are mounted.  
anonymous command execution  
chassis detect-and-deploy profile  
A profile that IBM Director automatically  
applies to all new BladeCenter chassis  
when they are discovered. The profile  
settings include management module  
name, network protocols, and static IP  
addresses. If Remote Deployment  
Manager (RDM) is installed on the  
management server, the chassis  
Execution of commands on a target  
system as either system account (for  
managed systems running Windows) or  
root (for managed systems running  
Linux). To restrict anonymous command  
execution, disable this feature and always  
require a user ID and password.  
ASF  
ASM interconnect gateway  
See gateway service processor.  
association  
(1) A way of displaying the members of a  
See alert standard format.  
detect-and-deploy profile also can include  
deployment policies.  
CIM See Common Information Model.  
cloning  
In z/VM®, a copying technique that  
preserves the characteristics of the  
original but personalizes instance-specific  
data. The result of a cloning operation is  
new instance of an entity (for example, of  
a virtual disk, a virtual computer system,  
or an operating system) rather than a  
backup of the original.  
group in a logical ordering. For example,  
the Object Type association displays the  
managed objects in a group in folders  
based on their type. (2) A way to display  
additional information about the members  
of the group. For example, the Event  
Action Plans association displays any  
event action plans applied to the  
managed objects in the group in an Event  
Action Plan folder.  
Common Information Model (CIM)  
An implementation-neutral,  
object-oriented schema for describing  
network management information. The  
Distributed Management Task Force  
(DMTF) develops and maintains CIM  
specifications.  
B
basic input/output system (BIOS)  
The code that controls basic hardware  
operations, such as interactions with  
diskette drives, hard disk drives, and the  
keyboard.  
component association  
In the IBM Director Rack Manager task, a  
function that can make a managed system  
or device rack-mountable when the  
inventory collection feature of IBM  
Director does not recognize the managed  
system or device. The function associates  
the system or device with a predefined  
component.  
BIOS See Basic Input/Output System.  
blade server  
An IBM BladeCenter server. A  
high-throughput, two-way, Intel  
Xeon-based server on a card that supports  
symmetric multiprocessors {SMP}.  
BladeCenter chassis  
Conversational Monitor System (CMS)  
A BladeCenter unit that acts as an  
A virtual-machine operating system that  
280 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
provides general interactive time sharing,  
problem solving, and program  
development capabilities.  
an enterprise, including finding the new  
location of monitored resources that were  
moved.  
disk pool  
D
In z/VM Center, a logical grouping of  
contiguous disk spaces. A disk pool can  
include disk spaces from multiple  
physical disks. A disk pool corresponds to  
a z/VM Directory Maintenance Facility  
(DirMaint) allocation group.  
Data Encryption Standard (DES)  
A cryptographic algorithm designed to  
encrypt and decrypt data using a private  
key.  
database server  
The server on which the database  
application and database are installed.  
DMI See Desktop Management Interface.  
E
deployment policy  
A policy that associates a specific bay in a  
BladeCenter chassis with an RDM  
noninteractive task. When a blade server  
is added to or replaced in the bay, IBM  
Director automatically runs the RDM task.  
enclosure  
A unit that houses the components of a  
storage subsystem, such as a control unit,  
disk drives, and power source.  
event An occurrence of significance to a task or  
system, such as the completion or failure  
of an operation. There are two types of  
events: alert and resolution.  
DES  
See Data Encryption Standard.  
Desktop Management Interface (DMI)  
A protocol-independent set of application  
programming interfaces (APIs) that were  
defined by the Distributed Management  
Task Force (DMTF). These interfaces give  
management application programs  
event action  
The action that IBM Director takes in  
response to a specific event or events.  
event-action plan  
standardized access to information about  
hardware and software in a system.  
A user-defined plan that determines how  
IBM Director will manage certain events.  
An event action plan comprises one or  
more event filters and one or more  
customized event actions.  
Diffie-Hellman key exchange  
A public, key-exchange algorithm that is  
used for securely establishing a shared  
secret over an insecure channel. During  
Phase II negotiations, the Diffie-Hellman  
group prevents someone who intercepts  
your key from deducing future keys that  
are based on the one they have.  
event-data substitution variable  
A variable that can be used to customize  
event-specific text messages for certain  
event actions.  
event filter  
digital signature algorithm (DSA)  
A security protocol that uses a pair of  
keys (one public and one private) and a  
one-way encryption algorithm to provide  
a robust way of authenticating users and  
systems. If a public key can successfully  
decrypt a digital signature, a user can be  
sure that the signature was encrypted  
using the private key.  
A filter that specifies the event criteria for  
an event action plan. Events must meet  
the criteria specified in the event filter in  
order to be processed by the event action  
plan to which the filter is assigned.  
extension  
See IBM Director extension.  
F
directory manager  
A facility for maintaining the user  
directory of one or more z/VM systems.  
field-replaceable unit (FRU)  
An assembly that is replaced in its  
entirety when any one of its components  
fails. In some cases, a FRU may contain  
other FRUs.  
discovery  
The process of finding resources within  
Glossary 281  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
file-distribution server  
In the Software Distribution task, an  
I
IBM Director Agent  
intermediate server that is used to  
distribute a software package when the  
redirected-distribution method is used.  
A component of IBM Director software.  
When IBM Director Agent is installed on  
a system, the system can be managed by  
IBM Director. IBM Director Agent  
forecast  
A function that can provide a prediction  
of future performance of a managed  
system using past data collected on that  
managed system.  
transfers data to the management server  
using several network protocols,  
including TCP/IP, NetBIOS, and IPX.  
IBM Director Console  
FRU  
See field-replaceable unit.  
A component of IBM Director software.  
When installed on a system, it provides a  
graphical user interface (GUI) for  
accessing IBM Director Server. IBM  
Director Console transfers data to and  
from the management server using  
TCP/IP.  
G
gateway service processor  
A service processor that relays alerts from  
service processors on an Advanced  
System Management (ASM) interconnect  
network to IBM Director Server.  
IBM Director database  
The database that contains the data stored  
by IBM Director Server.  
group A logical set of managed objects. Groups  
can be dynamic, static, or task-based.  
IBM Director environment  
Guest LAN  
The complex, heterogeneous environment  
managed by IBM Director. It includes  
systems, BladeCenter chassis, software,  
SNMP devices.  
A virtual local area network (LAN)  
segment that is emulated by the z/VM  
Control Program (CP). A Guest LAN can  
be shared by guest virtual machines on  
the same z/VM system.  
IBM Director extension  
A tool that extends the functionality of  
IBM Director. Some of the IBM Director  
extensions are Capacity Manager,  
ServeRAID Manager, Remote Deployment  
Manager, Software Distribution.  
guest virtual machine  
In z/VM, the functional equivalent of a  
System z9or zSeries® system, including  
the virtual processors, virtual storage,  
virtual devices, and virtual channel  
subsystem allocated to a single user. Each  
guest virtual machine can be controlled  
by an operating system, such as CMS,  
z/VSE, z/OS®, or Linux.  
IBM Director Server  
The main component of IBM Director  
software. When installed on the  
management server, it provides basic  
functions such as discovery of the  
managed systems, persistent storage of  
configuration and management data, an  
inventory database, event listening,  
security and authentication, management  
console support, and administrative tasks.  
GUID See Universal Unique Identifier.  
H
Hyper-Threading  
A technology with which a single  
processor can function as two virtual  
processors and execute two threads  
simultaneously.  
IBM Director Server service  
A service that runs automatically on the  
management server, and provides the  
server engine and application logic for  
IBM Director.  
hypervisor  
A program or a portion of Licensed  
Internal Code (LIC) that allows multiple  
instances of operating systems to run  
simultaneously on the same hardware.  
IBM Director service account  
The Windows operating-system account  
associated with the IBM Director Server  
service.  
282 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
in-band communication  
See interprocess communication.  
Level-2 managed system  
An IBM or non-IBM server, desktop  
computer, workstation, or mobile  
computer that has IBM Director Agent  
installed. IBM Director Agent provides  
managed systems with the full  
complement of IBM Director Agent  
function that is used to communicate with  
and administer the Level-2 managed  
system. The function of a Level-2  
managed system varies depending on the  
operating system and platform.  
initial program load (IPL)  
The process that loads the system  
programs from the system auxiliary  
storage, checks the system hardware, and  
prepares the system for user operations.  
integrated system management processor  
(ISMP)  
A service processor built into some  
System x servers. ISMP is the successor to  
the Advanced System Management (ASM)  
processor.  
light path diagnostics  
A technology that provides a lighted path  
to failed or failing components to  
expedite hardware repairs.  
interprocess communication (IPC)  
1) The process by which programs  
communicate data to each other and  
synchronize their activities. Semaphores,  
signals, and internal message queues are  
common methods of interprocess  
Linux instance  
An individual realization of the Linux  
operating system with a particular  
version, configuration, physical location,  
and identifier.  
communication. 2) A mechanism of an  
operating system that allows processes to  
communicate with each other within the  
same computer or over a network.  
M
MAC address  
See media access control (MAC) address.  
inventory-software dictionary  
A file that tracks the software installed on  
managed systems in a network.  
managed group  
A group of systems or objects managed  
by IBM Director.  
IPC  
See interprocess communication.  
ISMP See integrated system management processor.  
managed object  
A resource that is subject to management,  
such as a layer entity, a connection, a line,  
or a scalable system, as viewed from a  
systems management perspective.  
J
job  
A separately executable unit of work  
defined by a user, and run by a computer.  
managed object ID  
L
A unique identifier for each managed  
object. It is the key value used by IBM  
Director database tables.  
Level-0 managed system  
An IBM or non-IBM server, desktop  
computer, workstation, or mobile  
computer, that can be managed by IBM  
Director but does not have any IBM  
Director software installed on it.  
managed system  
A system that is being controlled by a  
given system management application, for  
example, a system managed by IBM  
Director.  
Level-1 managed system  
An IBM or non-IBM server, desktop  
computer, workstation, and mobile  
computer that has IBM Director Core  
Services installed. IBM Director uses IBM  
Director Core Services to communicate  
with and administer the Level-2 managed  
system. IBM Director Core Services  
includes the SLP instrumentation, the IBM  
Director Agent SLP service type, and  
Common Information Model (CIM).  
management console  
A system (server, desktop computer,  
workstation, or mobile computer) on  
which IBM Director Console is installed.  
management module  
The BladeCenter component that handles  
system-management functions. It  
configures the chassis and switch  
modules, communicates with the blade  
Glossary 283  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
servers and all I/O modules, multiplexes  
the keyboard/video/mouse (KVM), and  
monitors critical information about the  
chassis and blade servers.  
the operating system and interprocess  
communication (IPC).  
P
management server  
partition  
See scalable partition.  
The server on which IBM Director Server  
is installed.  
PCI  
See Peripheral Component Interconnect.  
master system  
PCI-X See Peripheral Component Interconnect-X.  
In z/VM Center, an operating system  
instance that has been set up to serve  
Virtual Server Deployment as a model for  
creating operating system templates.  
Peripheral Component Interconnect (PCI)  
A standard for connecting attached  
devices to a computer.  
media access control (MAC) address  
In a local area network, the protocol that  
determines which device has access to the  
transmission medium at a given time.  
Peripheral Component Interconnect-X (PCI-X)  
An enhancement to the Peripheral  
Component Interconnect (PCI)  
architecture. PCI-X enhances the  
Peripheral Component Interconnect (PCI)  
standard by doubling the throughput  
capability and providing additional  
adapter-performance options while  
maintaining backward compatibility with  
PCI adapters.  
minidisk  
A direct access storage device (DASD) or  
a logical subdivision of a DASD that has  
its own virtual device number.  
N
PFA  
physical platform  
An IBM Director managed object that  
See Predictive Failure Analysis®.  
nonvolatile random-access memory (NVRAM)  
Random access memory (storage) that  
retains its contents after the electrical  
power to the machine is shut off.  
represents a single physical chassis or  
server that has been discovered through  
the use of the Service Location Protocol  
(SLP).  
notification  
See alert.  
NVRAM  
plug-in  
See nonvolatile random-access memory.  
A software module, often written by a  
third party, that adds function to an  
existing program or application such as a  
Web browser. See IBM Director extension.  
O
operating system instance  
An individual realization of an operating  
system with a particular version,  
configuration, physical location, and  
identifier.  
POST See power-on self-test.  
power-on self-test  
A series of internal diagnostic tests  
activated each time the system power is  
turned on.  
operating system template  
A set of installation and configuration  
data that z/VM Center uses as a source  
for creating operating system instances.  
Operating system templates are created  
from master systems.  
Predictive Failure Analysis (PFA)  
A scheduled evaluation of system data  
that detects and signals parametric  
degradation that might lead to functional  
failures.  
out-of-band communication  
Communication that occurs through a  
modem or other asynchronous  
connection, for example, service processor  
alerts sent through a modem or over a  
LAN. In an IBM Director environment,  
such communication is independent of  
private key  
1) In secure communication, an  
algorithmic pattern used to encrypt  
messages that only the corresponding  
public key can decrypt. The private key is  
also used to decrypt messages that were  
encrypted by the corresponding public  
284 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
key. The private key is kept on the user’s  
system and is protected by a password. 2)  
The secret half of a cryptographic key  
pair that is used with a public key  
algorithm. Private keys are typically used  
to digitally sign data and to decrypt data  
that has been encrypted with the  
RXE Expansion Port  
The dedicated high-speed port used to  
connect a remote I/O expansion unit,  
such as the RXE-100 Remote Expansion  
Enclosure, to a server.  
S
corresponding public key.  
scalable node  
A physical platform that has at least one  
public key  
1) In secure communication, an  
SMP Expansion Module. Additional  
attributes are assigned to a physical  
platform when it is a scalable node. These  
additional attributes record the number of  
SMP Expansion Modules, SMP Expansion  
Ports, and RXE Expansion ports on the  
physical chassis.  
algorithmic pattern used to decrypt  
messages that were encrypted by the  
corresponding private key. A public key is  
also used to encrypt messages that can be  
decrypted only by the corresponding  
private key. Users broadcast their public  
keys to everyone with whom they must  
exchange encrypted messages. 2) The  
non-secret half of a cryptographic key  
pair that is used with a public key  
algorithm. Public keys are typically used  
to verify digital signatures or decrypt  
data that has been encrypted with the  
corresponding private key.  
scalable object  
An IBM Director managed object that is  
used with Scalable Systems Manager.  
Scalable objects include scalable nodes,  
scalable systems, scalable partitions, and  
remote I/O enclosures that are attached to  
scalable nodes.  
scalable partition  
R
An IBM Director managed object that  
defines the scalable nodes that can run a  
single image of the operating system. A  
scalable partition has a single, continuous  
memory space and access to all associated  
adapters. A scalable partition is the logical  
equivalent of a physical platform. Scalable  
partitions are associated with scalable  
systems and comprise only the scalable  
nodes from their associated scalable  
systems.  
redirected distribution  
A method of software distribution that  
uses a file-distribution server.  
remote I/O enclosure  
An IBM Director managed object that  
represents an expansion enclosure of  
Peripheral Component Interconnect-X  
(PCI-X) slots, for example, an RXE-100  
Remote Expansion Enclosure. The  
enclosure consists of one or two  
expansion kits.  
scalable system  
An IBM Director managed object that  
consists of scalable nodes and the scalable  
partitions that are composed of the  
scalable nodes in the scalable system.  
When a scalable system contains two or  
more scalable nodes, the servers that they  
represent must be interconnected through  
their SMP Expansion Modules to make a  
multinode configuration, for example, a  
16-way System x 455 server made from  
four scalable nodes.  
Remote Supervisor Adapter  
An IBM service processor. It is built into  
some xSeries servers and available as an  
optional adapter for use with others.  
When used as a gateway service  
processor, the Remote Supervisor Adapter  
can communicate with all service  
processors on the Advanced System  
Management (ASM) interconnect.  
resolution  
The occurrence of a correction or solution  
to a problem.  
Secure Sockets Layer (SSL)  
A security protocol that provides  
communication privacy. SSL enables  
client/server applications to communicate  
resource-monitor threshold  
The point at which a resource monitor  
generates an event.  
Glossary 285  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
in a way that is designed to prevent  
eavesdropping, tampering, and message  
forgery.  
system also, hardware alerts can be  
forwarded as SNMP traps.  
SNMP device  
server complex  
A network device, printer, or computer  
that has an SNMP device installed or  
embedded.  
In z/VM Center, a configuration profile  
for Linux guest systems that includes  
both Linux and z/VM aspects. A server  
complex can define network settings,  
Linux configuration scripts, disk access,  
and VM Resource Manager (VMRM)  
performance goals.  
SQL  
SSL  
See Structured Query Language  
See Secure Sockets Layer.  
static partition  
A view-only scalable partition.  
Service Location Protocol (SLP)  
In the Internet suite of protocols, a  
protocol that identifies and uses network  
hosts without having to designate a  
specific network host name.  
sticky key  
An input method that enables the user to  
press and release a series of keys  
sequentially (for example, Ctrl+Alt+Del),  
yet have the keys behave as if they were  
pressed and released at the same time.  
This method can be used for those who  
require special-needs settings to make the  
keyboard easier to use.  
service machine  
In z/VM, a guest virtual machine that  
provides a system service such as  
accounting, error recording, or  
monitoring. A system service can be part  
of z/VM or a licensed program.  
Structured Query Language (SQL)  
A standardized language for defining and  
manipulating data in a relational  
database.  
service processor  
A generic term for Remote Supervisor  
Adapters, Advanced System Management  
processors, Advanced System  
Management PCI adapters, and integrated  
system management processors (ISMPs).  
These hardware-based management  
processors used in IBM Netfinity and  
System x servers work with IBM Director  
to provide hardware status and alert  
notification.  
switch module  
The BladeCenter component that provides  
network connectivity for the BladeCenter  
chassis and blade servers. It also provides  
interconnectivity between the  
management module and blade servers.  
system  
The computer and its associated devices  
and programs.  
SLP  
SMBIOS  
See systems management BIOS.  
SMP Expansion Module  
An IBM System x hardware option. It is a  
See Service Location Protocol.  
System Health Monitoring  
An IBM Director Agent feature that  
provides active monitoring of critical  
system functions, including system  
temperatures, voltages, and fan speeds. It  
also handles in-band alert notification for  
managed systems running Windows and  
some managed systems running Linux.  
single module that contains  
microprocessors, disk cache, random  
access memory, and three SMP Expansion  
Port connections. Two SMP Expansion  
Modules can fit in a chassis.  
system variable  
A user-defined keyword and value pair  
that can be used to test and track the  
status of network resources. System  
variables can be referred to wherever  
event-data substitution is allowed.  
SNMP Access and Trap Forwarding  
An IBM Director Agent feature that  
enables SNMP to access managed-system  
data. When installed on a managed  
system, this feature enables SNMP-based  
managers to poll the managed system and  
receive its alerts. If System Health  
systems management BIOS (SMBIOS)  
A key requirement of the Wired for  
Management (WfM) 2.0 specification.  
SMBIOS extends the system BIOS to  
Monitoring is installed on the managed  
286 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
support the retrieval of management data  
required by the WfM specification. To run  
IBM Director Agent, a system must  
user class  
A z/VM privilege category assigned to a  
guest virtual machine user in the user’s  
directory entry; each class specified  
allows access to a logical subset of all the  
CP commands.  
support SMBIOS, version 2.2 or later.  
T
target system  
A managed system on which an IBM  
Director task is performed.  
UUID See universal unique identifier.  
V
time to live (TTL)  
virtual device number  
A technique used by best-effort delivery  
protocols to inhibit endlessly looping  
packets. The packet is discarded if the  
TTL counter reaches 0.  
In z/VM, a device number used by a  
guest virtual machine. Real devices can be  
referred to by different virtual device  
numbers by different guest virtual  
machines.  
triple data encryption standard (DES)  
A block cipher algorithm that can be used  
to encrypt data transmitted between  
managed systems and the management  
server. Triple DES is a security  
virtual server template  
A set of z/VM virtual server definitions  
that provides configuration defaults for a  
unique z/VM virtual server instance.  
z/VM Center uses virtual server  
enhancement of DES that employs three  
successive DES block operations.  
templates to create z/VM virtual servers.  
TTL  
See time to live.  
vital product data (VPD)  
Information that uniquely defines the  
system, hardware, software, and  
microcode elements of a processing  
system.  
U
universal unique identifier (UUID)  
A 128-bit character string guaranteed to  
be globally unique and used to identify  
components under management.  
VPD See vital product data.  
W
uptime  
The time during which a system is  
working without failure.  
Wake on LAN®  
A technology that enables a user to  
remotely turn on systems for off-hours  
maintenance. A result of the Intel-IBM  
Advanced Manageability Alliance and  
part of the Wired for Management  
Baseline Specification, users of this  
technology can remotely turn on a server  
and control it across the network, thus  
saving time on automated software  
installations, upgrades, disk backups, and  
virus scans.  
upward integration  
The methods, processes and procedures  
that enable lower-level  
systems-management software, such as  
IBM Director Agent, to work with  
higher-level systems-management  
software, such as Tivoli Enterpriseor  
Microsoft SMS.  
upward integration module  
Software that enables higher-level  
systems-management software, such as  
Tivoli Enterprise or Microsoft Systems  
Manager Server (SMS), to interpret and  
display data provided by IBM Director  
Agent. This module also can provide  
enhancements that start IBM Director  
Agent from within the higher-level  
systems-management console, as well as  
collect IBM Director inventory data and  
view IBM Director alerts.  
walk An SNMP operation that is used to  
discover all object instances of  
management information implemented in  
the SNMP agent that can be accessed by  
the SNMP manager.  
Windows Management Instrumentation (WMI)  
An application programming interface  
(API) in the Windows operating system  
that enables devices and systems in a  
network to be configured and managed.  
WMI uses the Common Information  
Glossary 287  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Model (CIM) to enable network  
administrators to access and share  
management information.  
WMI See Windows Management Instrumentation.  
WMI Query Language (WQL)  
A subset of the Structured Query  
Language with minor semantic changes to  
support Windows Management  
Instrumentation.  
WQL See WMI Query Language.  
Z
z/VM virtual server  
In z/VM, a guest virtual machine that a  
user can log on to.  
z/VM A System z9 and zSeries operating system  
that acts as virtualization software. z/VM  
can virtualize all system resources,  
including processors, memory, storage  
devices, and communication devices.  
z/VM supports the concurrent operation  
of hundreds of operating system  
instances.  
288 ServeRAID Manager Installation and User's Guide  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
A
H
interface  
Hardware Status  
alerts  
ASM processor  
Inventory  
I
IBM Director Console  
ISMP  
B
BladeCenter  
K
managed objects  
C
L
D
discovery  
setting  
M
managed systems  
management server  
Message Browser  
viewing  
IBM systems-management software  
E
event action plans  
Builder  
N
notifications  
IBM Web sites  
icons  
O
operating system  
F
G
P
grouping  
groups  
illustrations  
© Copyright IBM Corp. 1999, 2006  
289  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Readers’ Comments — We’d Like to Hear from You  
IBM Systems  
ServeRAID Manager  
Installation and User's Guide  
Version 8.30  
Overall, how satisfied are you with the information in this book?  
Very Satisfied  
Satisfied  
Neutral  
Dissatisfied  
Very  
Dissatisfied  
h
Overall satisfaction  
h
h
h
h
How satisfied are you that the information in this book is:  
Very Satisfied  
Satisfied  
Neutral  
Dissatisfied  
Very  
Dissatisfied  
Accurate  
Complete  
Easy to find  
Easy to understand  
Well organized  
Applicable to your tasks  
h
h
h
h
h
h
h
h
h
h
h
h
h
h
h
h
h
h
h
h
h
h
h
h
h
h
h
h
h
h
Please tell us how we can improve this book:  
Thank you for your responses. May we contact you?  
h Yes  
h No  
When you send comments to IBM, you grant IBM a nonexclusive right to use or distribute your comments in any  
way it believes appropriate without incurring any obligation to you. IBM or any other organizations will only use  
the personal information that you supply to contact you about the issues that you state on this form.  
Name  
Address  
Company or Organization  
Phone No.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cut or Fold  
Along Line  
Readers’ Comments — We’d Like to Hear from You  
ꢀꢁꢂꢃ  
Fold and Tape  
Please do not staple  
Fold and Tape  
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _  
NO POSTAGE  
NECESSARY  
IF MAILED IN THE  
UNITED STATES  
BUSINESS REPLY MAIL  
FIRST-CLASS MAIL PERMIT NO. 40 ARMONK, NEW YORK  
POSTAGE WILL BE PAID BY ADDRESSEE  
International Business Machines Corporation  
Dept. CGFA  
PO Box 12195  
Research Triangle Park, NC 27709-9990  
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _  
Fold and Tape  
Please do not staple  
Fold and Tape  
Cut or Fold  
Along Line  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ꢀꢁꢂꢃ  
Printed in USA  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Haier Washer XPB10 LAP User Manual
Hamilton Beach Juicer 840104600 User Manual
Hamilton Beach Toaster 840157200 User Manual
Honeywell Home Security System HCD544 User Manual
Honeywell Water System EA79 User Manual
Hunter Fan Outdoor Ceiling Fan 21705 User Manual
Hyundai DVD Player H CMD4005 User Manual
IBM Computer Monitor 6332 x7x User Manual
IBM Frozen Dessert Maker AIX5L User Manual
IBM Network Card NetFlex 2 User Manual